This is only a preview of the September 2010 issue of Silicon Chip. You can view 28 of the 104 pages in the full issue, including the advertisments. For full access, purchase the issue for $10.00 or subscribe for access to the latest issues. Articles in this series:
Items relevant to "Ultrasonic Anti-Fouling Unit For Boats, Pt.1":
Items relevant to "High-Performance Microphone Preamplifier":
Items relevant to "Build A Hearing Loop Receiver":
Items relevant to "Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester, Pt.2":
Purchase a printed copy of this issue for $10.00. |
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 1
Digital Luggage Scale
Don't ruin your holiday being slugged with exorbitant excess
baggage charges. Pack one of these on your next trip and
avoid nasty surprises at the check-in counter.
• Requires 2 x AAA batteries
• Capacity: 40kg
• Tare and auto-off
• Backlit LCD
• Overload and low
battery indication
• Size: 122(L) x 85(H) x 25(W)mm
QM-7232
19 95
$
64MB Digital Voice Recorder
Happy
Father’s
Record up to 26 hours of voice or notes
in either dictation or conference mode,
manual of VOX. Play back through the
built-in 30mm speaker or download to
PC. An LCD screen keeps track of
everything and the simple intuitive
layout is easy to use.
Day!
• Requires 2 x AA batteries
• USB cable and software included
• Variable speed playback
• Date and time-stamped recordings
• Dimensions: 97(L) x 45(W) x 18(H)mm
XC-0380 WAS $69.95
Rechargeable Air Pump
From party balloons and pool toys to larger air mattresses and
rubber dinghies - this high-volume low-pressure rechargeable
air pump will have the job done in no time.
Recharged via mains power or car charger,
its portable cord-free operation
makes this a must-have
accessory for your beach
and camping
inflatables.
• Inflation and deflation port
95
$
• Includes hose and two
air nozzle fittings
• Mains adaptor (240VAC) and car charger (12VDC) included
GH-1119
39
Blue LED Wall Clock
with Alarm & Remote
Eye-catching LED wall clock with brilliant bright blue numeric
display. With easy-to-read numerals 2.5-inches tall, its fresh
design will suit contemporary homes as well as modern
offices, workshops, waiting rooms etc. Powered either by
mains adaptor or 9V
battery.
• 12/24 hour mode with
alarm clock function
• Remote control included
• Mains adaptor included
• Dimensions: 310(W) x
33(D) x 164(H)mm
AR-1759
69
$
95
World Band AM/FM/SW PLL
Radio Receiver
This is a great radio and its list of features will amaze you. It
uses a phase-locked loop (PLL) for rock solid
frequency stability and has an AM band,
FM band (stereo), and three
short-wave bands
covering 1711kHz to
29999kHz. See website
for full
00
$
details.
99
00
$
• Local/DX SAVE 40
switch
• I/F output
• Requires 4 x D Batteries
AR-1747 WAS $139.00
Perfect for
Dad’s Shed
14 95
$
Listen to your favourite tunes through the FM radio in your car dock and charge your iPod® at the same time. This nifty little
unit stays in your cup holder and is powered by your car's
cigarette lighter outlet. It's compatible with most iPod® models,
works with MP3 players, CD players and other media devices.
See website for iPod® compatibility.
• Last frequency memory
• Backlit LCD
• Size: 82(Dia) x 78(H)mm
Note: iPod® not included
AR-1869 WAS $79.95
69 95
$
Help Dad Find His Keys
Remember putting your keys down
but can’t quite pinpoint where? This
little gadget will help you with your
problem in no time. Simply press
the colour coded button allocated to
your keys on the main unit and the
matching receiver will beep so you can
find those missing keys. The base unit can
be placed on a counter top or be wall
mounted. Stand included.
• Transmits radio signal up to 25m away
• Key fobs incorporate LED flashlight
• Required 3 x AA Batteries
XC-0353
49 95
$
Comfortable and lightweight at only 48
grams for hours of gaming or podcasting.
The lead is terminated in separate mic
and speaker jacks for computer use and
is a generous 2m long.
• Frequency response: 500Hz - 20kHz
• Sensitivity: 100dB
95
AA-2033
$
14
• Requires 4 x AAA batteries
• Dimensions: 167(W) x 54(H) x 32(D)mm
XC-5177
15 Piece Micro Driver Set
For The Dad On The Go!
FM Transmitter with Dock for iPod®
SAVE $10 00
Computer Headphones with
Flexible Microphone Boom
Mini PC/MP3 Speakers
Plug in your MP3 player
or any other audio
source and the 30mm
speakers will provide
more than enough
volume to bop along to.
Powered by batteries or 6VDC plugpack
(not included).
59 95
$
This handy set will fit the bill for all those
microscopic fasteners. The ergonomic
handles are colour coded for easy
identification and they come in a
sturdy storage case.
Wireless MP3 Modulator
For In-Car Use
This lightweight portable
charger and FM Radio
Transmitter connects into your
car's cigarette lighter to
charge your iPod® or iPod® Mini.
It allows you to listen to your
iPod® tunes through your car's
stereo radio.
Note: iPod® not included
AR-3118 WAS $49.95
SAVE $10 00
39
$
95
SAVE $10 00
To order call 1800 022 888
www.jaycar.com.au
Prices valid until 23/09/2010. While stocks last. No rainchecks. Savings are based on ORRP.
The set contains:
• Slotted: 1mm, 1.4mm,
1.8mm, 2.4mm
• Phillips: #000, #00, #0, #1
• Torx: T5, T6,T7, T8
• Hex: 1.5mm, 2mm, 2.5mm
• Drivers: 105mm long
• Case size: 192(L) x 130(W) x 26(H)mm
TD-2069
24 95
$
Contents
Vol.23, No.9; September 2010
SILICON
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Features
14 Review: Fusion 600 Marine A/V Series
New Zealand-designed Fusion Audio equipment for boats is making real
waves around the world – by Kevin Poulter
LED Replacement Tubes For
Fluorescent Lamps – Page 16.
16.
16 LED Replacements For Fluorescent Lamps
Fluorescent tubes are now being challenged by LED tubes which use half the
power, last twice as long and put out lots of light – by Leo Simpson
22 Designing & Installing A Hearing Loop For The Deaf, Pt.1
Many people have a hearing impairment and hearing loops which inductively
couple an audio signal to a hearing aid are now common. Here’s how to
design and install one – by John Clarke
67 Charlieplexing: What It Is & How It works
This multiplexing technique can really cut down on the number of outputs
required to drive a LED d isplay – by Nicholas Vinen
Pro jects To Build
34 Ultrasonic Anti-Fouling Unit For Boats, Pt.1
Marine growth on the hull is the bane of all boat owners. Keep the barnacles at
bay electronically with this high-power ultrasonic unit – by John Clarke
Ultrasonic Anti-Fouling Unit For
Boats – Page 34.
42 High-Performance Microphone Preamplifier
This compact module accepts either a balanced or unbalanced microphone
input and provides a line-level output with very low noise and distortion. It runs
off 5-20V DC and consumes just 6mA – by Nicholas Vinen
62 Build A Hearing Loop Receiver
This low-cost unit picks up hearing loop signals and drives a pair of headphones. It works with commercial loops in public places or you can use it with
a loop that you install in your own home – by John Clarke
70 Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester, Pt.2
Second article shows you how to put it together and install it in a plastic case
– by Jim Rowe
High-Performance Microphone
Preamplifier – Page 42.
Special Columns
57 Serviceman’s Log
Electros with lumpy bits are not good – by the Serviceman
84 Vintage Radio
All about thermionic valves (or vacuum tubes) – by Maurie Findlay
Build A Hearing
Loop Receiver
– Page 62.
90 Circuit Notebook
(1) PICAXE Refrigerator Timer For Cafes; (2) PICAXE I/O Demonstrator
Circuit; (3) Magnetic Pole & Flux Strength Indicator; (4) Automatic Exterior
Light; (5) 6-Stage Cascaded Timer Uses SCRs
Departments
2
4
41
95
Publisher’s Letter
Mailbag
Product Showcase
Ask Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
98 Notes & Errata
99 Order Form
102 Market Centre
September 2010 1
SILICON
SILIC
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Publisher & Editor-in-Chief
Leo Simpson, B.Bus., FAICD
Production Manager
Greg Swain, B.Sc. (Hons.)
Technical Editor
John Clarke, B.E.(Elec.)
Technical Staff
Ross Tester
Jim Rowe, B.A., B.Sc
Mauro Grassi, B.Sc. (Hons), Ph.D
Nicholas Vinen
Photography
Ross Tester
Reader Services
Ann Morris
Advertising Enquiries
Glyn Smith
Phone (02) 9939 3295
Mobile 0431 792 293
glyn<at>siliconchip.com.au
Regular Contributors
Brendan Akhurst
Rodney Champness, VK3UG
Kevin Poulter
Mike Sheriff, B.Sc, VK2YFK
Stan Swan
SILICON CHIP is published 12 times
a year by Silicon Chip Publications
Pty Ltd. ACN 003 205 490. ABN 49
003 205 490. All material is copyright ©. No part of this publication
may be reproduced without the written consent of the publisher.
Printing: Hannanprint, Noble Park,
Victoria.
Distribution: Network Distribution
Company.
Subscription rates: $94.50 per year
in Australia. For overseas rates, see
the order form in this issue.
Editorial office:
Unit 1, 234 Harbord Rd,
Brookvale, NSW 2100.
Postal address: PO Box 139,
Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097.
Phone (02) 9939 3295.
Fax (02) 9939 2648.
E-mail: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
ISSN 1030-2662
Publisher’s Letter
LEDs will be the universal
light source
Back in the April 2007 issue we had a feature article
on the proposed ban on incandescent lights. Introduced
by Malcolm Turnbull, then Minister for the Environment and Water Resources, the ban was hasty and illconceived. Even then it was only predicted to produce
a negligible reduction in Australian greenhouse gas
emissions of 800,000 tonnes between 2008-2012 and
a somewhat larger reduction of 4 million tonnes per
annum by 2015. People were supposed to substitute
compact fluorescent lamps (CFLs) and it was claimed
that household lighting costs would then be reduced by up to 66 percent.
Overall, it was a very bad decision. Few householders could point to any reduction in their electricity consumption due to the installation of CFLs – they have
no precise way of measuring it. Instead, they have had to pay substantially more
for CFLs whose life has never come up to the claims made for them. Even this
month we have a couple of letters of further bad feedback for CFLs. And now, to
emphasise how stupid the ban has been, it’s possible to buy mains voltage halogen “incandescents” which are apparently permitted under the on-going ban on
incandescent lamps. How ridiculous. While no doubt halogen lamps will be more
reliable than CFLs, they are not much more efficient than incandescents. They are
considerably more expensive than equivalent incandescent lamps, as well.
To add insult to injury, electricity tariffs have since gone up by more than 60
percent (in Sydney, at least) which would completely obliterate any putative savings in household lighting costs.
The incandescent lamp ban was introduced by the then Liberal government and
maintained by the following Labor government – proof that both sides of politics
are equally capable of stupid decisions when it comes to any aspect of technology.
At the time of the ban, we commented that LED replacements were not viable
for incandescents, being “expensive and not as bright as halogens”. That situation is rapidly changing though, as this month’s article on LED replacements for
fluorescent lamps demonstrates. While still expensive in absolute terms, LED
replacements for fluorescent tubes are now a viable choice in all new buildings,
offices and factories and certainly should be considered for existing installations.
At the same time, LEDs are making inroads into virtually every lighting application. They are now standard in traffic lights and it is only a matter of time before
they become universal for street lighting as municipal authorities are already
evaluating LED replacements. These authorities will no doubt be driven by the
substantial energy savings and likely much longer life of LEDs. LED street lighting
should also have the advantage of less light pollution, with far less light scatter
into oncoming drivers’ eyes and into the sky.
LED replacements for incandescent lamps are already being produced and
again, it is only a matter of time, perhaps a couple of years, before they become the
standard light source where previously incandescents were universal. CFLs will
be quickly displaced, recognised as a product which never lived up to its claims.
12V halogen lamps are also likely to be displaced by LED equivalents but they
still have some way to go, as they are still not quite as bright, are expensive and
heat dissipation is still a significant issue. Having said that, 12V LED replacements for halogens are already making inroads where power consumption is an
important issue, particularly in boats, recreational vehicles and homes which are
not connected to the grid.
Unfortunately, due to perennial lack of government planning to provide for
electricity generation, electricity tariffs will continue to rise rapidly and that is
without any consideration of the introduction of carbon pricing or an emissions
trading scheme. LED replacements cannot come soon enough.
Leo Simpson
Recommended and maximum price only.
2 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
This is NOT a
USB Oscilloscope!
It is a 50MHz, 3-channel full-featured ’scope you can hold in the
palm of your hand! Just add a monitor and mouse (no PC needed)!
Se
Screene the
review Scope
i
SILICONn Jan 2010
CHIP!
THE A-351
SCREENSCOPE
IS A GENUINE
STAND-ALONE,
REAL-TIME
OSCILLOSCOPE:
DO NOT CONFUSE
WITH INFERIOR
USB SCOPES!
Here’s what you get:
A genuine digital scope that is ready in seconds!
50MHz 240MSPS real-time sampling
3 channels - 2x 8-bit and 1x 1-bit input
FFT in dBVrms, dBm (50, 75, 100, 300 600
Ohm termination) with selectable window
+, --, x and. -- math functions and memories
.
Auto and manual
measurements using markers
USB host - save waveforms as .txt or .csv
Save screen shots as .bmp
Easy fast uploads of new firmware revisions
Perfect with widescreen monitors (but fine
with just about any old computer monitor!)
Very easy operation - just single mouse clicks for
controls and you can easily move waveforms and
objects directly
And so much more (see our website for full specs)
NEW:
XY MODE!
Introducing ScreenScope - the new type of scope you are going
to love to take anywhere and use anywhere. All you need is a
mouse and virtually any computer monitor. You don’t need a PC
and it’s fun to use! And just look at the low, low price:
ONLY $539
(inc GST)
with a money-back guarantee!
CALL NOW: (03) 9714 8269
www.screenscopetraces.com
MAILBAG
Letters and emails should contain complete name, address and daytime phone number. Letters to
the Editor are submitted on the condition that Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd may edit and has the
right to reproduce in electronic form and communicate these letters. This also applies to submissions
to “Ask SILICON CHIP” and “Circuit Notebook”.
Candles a considerable
risk to TV sets
Last week was another where I saw
a TV with a fresh 50mm disc impression from a candle embedded in the
top of its cabinet. The lady who put
it there was surprised that the solid
looking silver cabinet was actually
moulded from highly-flammable High
Impact Polystyrene (HIPS) resin. In
1996, State Fair Trading departments,
alarmed at a dramatic rise of house
fires from modern TVs with flammable
cabinets, drew up new regulations
in consultation with manufacturers/
importers for cabinet flammability.
The manufacturers would not agree
to mandating flame retardant in the
front of CRT TV sets, as they feared
any price increase would affect sales.
Despite these objections, regulations
were drawn up to be introduced to
coincide with the 1988 C-Tick EMI
regulations. These regulations required that the material of the cabinet
back of CRT TVs be tested as selfextinguishing for each model on sale.
Concerns were put to the new Liberal federal government that manufacturers needed time to clear stock,
so the Howard Government placed a
moratorium, until 1 July 2000, on the
new regulation, allowing multina-
Let the buyer beware –
salespeople’s advice is suspect
Your Publisher’s Letter on TV
sound (July 2010) brought up issues
I totally agree with. Fortunately, the
TV I purchased does have analog
audio out, so I looked for an amplifier for top-quality sound. However,
with a budget of just $250 and not
much space, it was a tall order. In a
leading store, the salesman directed
me to a 5.1 system with speakers
everywhere and really awful sound.
Legendary brands from the past
like Sony and Yamaha were no help
either, with one of them quoting
4 Silicon Chip
tional companies to import or dump
these sub-standard sets into Australia.
Regardless, these regulations do not
stop TVs from catching fire if candles
are placed on them or on the rare occasion of a power switch “fusing” or
shorting out. I know of no regulations
in relation to fire safety of flat panel
TVs that also mostly use polystyrene
cabinets. It is best not to leave equipment unattended if switched on at
the wall and never place candles on
top of them.
Tony Backhouse,
Narraweena, NSW.
Comment: candles might be romantic
but they are always a fire risk.
Solar thermal power stations
have major challenges
Although I’m a keen solar enthusiast, the thermal slant in your informative August 2010 “Solar Power – 24/7”
article left me with mixed feelings.
Solar thermal may well seem tempting
but the article failed to mention that
it’s presently facing major challenges
(both technical and economic), especially from photovoltaic (PV) systems.
This has largely arisen as a result
of the Spanish government’s 2009
slashing of very generous (but biasing)
“green energy” subsidies. The resultfull output at 10% distortion! Heck
my 1970s amplifier in the lounge
has about 0.5% distortion at high
volume. So I looked at the bookshelf
units and settled on a Panasonic
with subwoofer for around $250. It’s
brilliant, apart from the bass sounding just a tad “plastic”, due to the
heavy plastic speaker boxes.
On CD, with the equaliser set right
and a 1950s tune playing, it sounds a
lot like the old Astor Concertmaster
we had in the family during that era.
It’s important when selecting TVs
and amplifiers that we have a checklist of items we need, then use our
ing sharp reduction in commercial demand meant a global fall in PV prices,
making simpler PV-based schemes
relatively more attractive, especially
when their increasing efficiencies are
also considered.
PVs convert sunlight directly to
electricity and essentially cease working after dark – charged battery banks
being normally then needed. However, PV-based energy schemes can
be immediately and progressively
commissioned, with extensions as circumstances allow. Servicing and upgrading usually can be done without
shutting down the entire operation.
As PV arrays do not even need to be
precisely arranged, irregular terrain or
even disconnected sites can be utilised
as well.
The fact that previously sun-baked
land under the panels will become
partially shaded may mean cropping
or animal grazing can occur. Most PV
technologies work better in cooler
conditions and many still perform
acceptably when off-angle or under
cloudy skies, meaning simpler fixed
panel mounting may be used, perhaps
on otherwise idle rooftops. As the dayeyes and ears. Also be sceptical of
salespeople’s advice. I went to three
stores looking at Panasonic plasma
TVs and staff at all three directed
me to a recently superseded model,
saying it was $200 cheaper but only
lacked a couple of sockets.
By the third store, I was absolutely
convinced their advice was flawed
– the brilliance and contrast was
less on the older model – and that
indicates it has less reserve for longterm ageing. I paid the extra for the
new model. Impulse buyers beware!
Kevin Poulter,
Dingley, Vic.
siliconchip.com.au
time energy harvesting is electrical,
energy can be promptly and efficiently
wired for immediate work (or centralised storage) – perhaps electric-vehicle
charging or water pumping at regions
quite some distance away.
In contrast to scalable PVs, solar
thermal schemes must be designed to
capacity at the outset, as they are really only economic at very large scale.
Financial, engineering and servicing
issues may then become extremely
daunting. Tracking and focusing the
changing daily and seasonal solar passage calls for complicated mechanicals
and one shudders to consider how long
it takes a tower to cool for safe access!
Extended cloud cover may also
mean molten salts need external heating to prevent solidification. Because
the sunniest regions are likely to be
the driest, even the local availability
of scarce water (to produce steam)
may become an issue for solar thermal
schemes.
Perhaps most tellingly, many energy schemes (both traditional and
green) require lengthy construction
periods before producing any output.
Political and financial uncertainties
arising during this phase may derail
the project– Mildura’s thermal tower
scheme (featured in SILICON CHIP, July
2002) perhaps being typical.
At 62MWp, Portugal’s Moura (Amareleja township) Photovoltaic Power
Station is on track to become the
world’s largest PV installation. Some
380,000 “off the shelf“ solar panels,
many of which are on fixed structures,
are arranged over 250 hectares. It’s
sited in one of the sunniest regions in
Europe and construction (budgeted at
some US$500 million) should further
benefit an economically depressed
region – see http://www.youtube.com/
watch?v=Gg-CgsQnUAU
Stan Swan,
Wellington, NZ.
Compression ain’t
compression
Next time compression in radio is
discussed, can we distinguish between
the two forms of it? Poul Kirk (Mailbag,
July 2010) certainly confuses things by
describing “all audio compression” as
the discarding of presumed unwanted
detail in the digital transmission. Unless by “detail” he includes musical
siliconchip.com.au
Our engineers needed a
faster scope.
A scope that would display
1 million waveforms per
second.
So we built one.
See for yourself
www.scope-of-the-art.com
dynamics, the compression I know
and hate – and used on all analog radio
including, sometimes ruinously, ABC
Classic FM – irons out the climaxes
and boosts the quiet passages.
I am also amused by the references
to “old fashioned analog FM”. Your
younger readers may be surprised to
know that the much older-fashioned
AM stations of the ABC decades ago
transmitted the full dynamic range –
there was only a limiter at the top to
prevent transmitter overload – with a
frequency range to 15kHz! So in terms
of vital musical dynamics, has radio
gone forwards or backwards?
Brian Wallace,
Dora Creek, NSW.
Comment: in many ways we have gone
backwards, especially in respect of the
audio quality from radio broadcasts,
flat-panel TV sets and MP3 players
(which many think have reasonable
sound quality).
High fidelity is a lost cause as far
as most people are concerned and
they simply don’t realise how good
recorded music can sound.
September 2010 5
FRONT PANELS
& ENCLOSURES
Customized front panels can be
easily designed with our free
software Front Panel Designer
• Cost-effective prototypes and
production runs
• Wide range of materials or
customization of provided material
• Automatic price calculation
• Fabrication in 1, 3 or 5 days
New Version 4.0
New functions include dxf import for
inner and outer shapes.
Linux, Windows, and Mac OS X compatible.
Sample price:
$ 50.53 plus S&H
www.frontpanelexpress.com
(206) 768 - 0602
Mailbag: continued
Thin TVs have
thin sound
I totally agree with the sentiments
expressed in the July Publisher’s
Letter. Yes, the pictures are terrific,
however the sound is something
else again. We had to change over to
a flat-screen Sony model some two
years ago when our German Loewe
model died after a severe electrical
storm (EHT system failure).
The Loewe had decent-sized speakers facing forward and the sound
quality was on a par with the picture
quality. Also the sound could be
connected to the stereo system for
even better audio performance. As
we live in an area with poor analog
TV reception, the Loewe was fed
from a set-top box and performed
extremely well.
The change to a flat-screen model
giving a similar sized picture went
well, with the picture quality on a
par with what we had previously
been used to. But the sound was
something we were unable to get
used to. Depending on the timbre
and sex of the person/s in the program, we found it almost impossible
to come up with a satisfactory tonal
and level adjustment to cope with
the various program mixes.
Headphones are
the answer
I concur with your reader who
complains of poor sound on his flat
screen LCD TV. Here in the UK, the
model I bought last year was a Samsung LE32B551 81cm LCD. The downfacing speakers give mediocre quality.
It does have analog stereo outputs
which, according to the manufacturer,
“connect to the audio input jacks on
your amplifier/home theatre”. Is this
model and larger Samsung TVs not
available in Australia?
The manufacturer’s specification
does not give the full technical details
(a common failing these days) but my
oscilloscope test shows typically 1V
peak-peak with a 47kΩ load and a
good clean analog waveform at normal
listening levels.
As I’m somewhat hard of hearing,
6 Silicon Chip
Sony does provide the facility
of permitting connection to a stereo system as well as providing a
headphone output. Connecting to
the stereo system did not produce a
dramatic improvement in the sound
quality, so in the end we opted to
buy a pair of wireless headsets, (OK
we have ageing ears, so that could
be part of our problem).
The headsets have added considerably to our enjoyment of TV and
enabled us to view programs where
the sound would otherwise be muffled or the background music tended
to dominate voices.
Now it is only occasionally that
we comment that the production
sound mix was less than optimum.
Yes headphones are isolating but the
sound can be kept at a comfortable
level to suit the individual which
is much to be preferred rather than
having the TV’s speakers blasting
out in order for us to understand
the broadcast.
A TV is an audio-visual device.
Unfortunately style and the desire to
have the thinnest screen possible has
put paid to common sense and hence
the sound becomes a compromise.
Richard Kerr,
Millfield, NSW.
there are several options. Just turning
the volume up is uncomfortable for my
wife. However, plugging high-quality
32-ohm stereo headphones into the
headphone socket, whilst producing
wonderful rich quality sound, cuts
out the loudspeaker (sorry wife!) and
trails a lead across the room.
Connecting good-quality powered
PC speakers, (must have high input
impedance, say >47kΩ inputs) to the
said audio output RCA phono sockets
is a big improvement but disables
the TV volume and mute controls.
However, if you don’t select “external
speakers” there is still the output at the
RCA sockets but the internal speakers
can then produce delay or echo effects!
A third option is to use stereo wireless headphones but can you can find
a transmitter with RCA sockets and
high input impedance?
siliconchip.com.au
Some flat panel TVs do
have analog audio outputs
The retail box details are generally
useless and manufacturer’s websites
similar. Using the volume on the
headphones is one solution but there
is no mute, as the TV Audio Out is in
the “raw” pre-conditioning circuitry.
I suppose removing the headphones
from one’s head suffices!
Robert Gott,
West Yorkshire, UK.
I read your editorial and the letter
from Bruce Piper in the July 2010
issue of SILICON CHIP regarding the
lack of analog audio outputs from
flat panel TVs. Unfortunately, Bruce
bought the wrong TV.
After a lot of research into TV
specifications, I recently purchased
a Sony KDL 40EX700 40-inch FHD
LED 100Hz set. Apart from a wonderful picture and all of the other
bells and whistles you could wish
for, it does have analog audio output (variable or fixed) as well as a
headphone jack (on the edge). I have
tried these out and they work well.
In addition, it has a digital audio
output (optical).
I agree that the rear-facing speakers leave a lot to be desired (especial-
Practical solution
to poor TV sound
Further to your reader about his
flat screen TV with terrible sound
(Mailbag, July 2010) I was in the same
position. I removed the back of my
Soniq 81cm flat panel TV and found
that the speakers are easily accessible
(10W 8Ω 120 x 40mm). No wonder the
sound is so poor.
I disconnected the speakers and
soldered on longer leads which I
bought out the rear of the set through
existing ventilation slits in the rear
cover and connected them to a pair of
6-inch speakers in sealed boxes. The
sound was much improved. I now
have the TV directly connected to my
old-fashioned hifi speakers (90-litre
sealed boxes with 12-inch woofers,
midrange and two tweeters) and the
sound is terrific.
Frank Chapman,
via email.
LCD TV sets
are too bright
Your latest Publisher’s Letter “To-
day’s TV – Brilliant Pictures, Mediocre
Sound” is of interest, however, my
wife has a very different problem. We
have two Samsung LCD TV sets and
she complains of glare to the extent
that she cannot watch either set for
an extended period. In fact, one set is
back in its box having had only one
week’s use.
I have tried task lighting near the
screen, leaving the main room lights
on and turning down the brightness,
contrast, backlighting and picture
sharpness to varying degrees in the onscreen menus. No joy from Samsung
ly on the high notes if any curtains
are behind) but the option is there
to do something about it on this TV.
I do not know if all Sony models have these outputs but I can
certainly recommend this model. I
am delighted with it except for the
fact that it does not have a printed
User Manual – opting instead for
an i-MANUAL. Nothing is easier to
use than a printed manual – I guess
this is a sign of the times in pennypinching.
Earlier this year I bought a Panasonic DVD Recorder (DMR-XW450).
The large 119-page user manual is
a great example as to what should
be supplied with an expensive
and complex consumer electrical
product.
Ron Mills, VK5XW,
Rosslyn Park, SA.
either. Seems that the softness of CRT
monitors has gone forever. Would it be
possible to flash the firmware perhaps
or insert some in-line attenuators to
degrade the picture?
I have just about given up. My wife
did have an eye test. All was OK except
for very minor cataracts. The optometrist could only suggest yellow tinted
glasses but these didn’t help either.
I should mention that she doesn’t
complain about her laptop screen. It
seems to be an inherent problem that
I can’t find an answer for. I wonder
whether anyone else has come across
Digital Storage Oscilloscopes
ADS1022C
• 25MHz Bandwidth, 2Ch
• 500MSa/s
• USB Host & PictBridge
$399
ADS1062CA • 60MHz Bandwidth, 2Ch
$627
25MHz
60MHz
• 1GSa/s
• USB Host & PictBridge
Inc GST
Inc GST
ADS1102CA • 100MHz Bandwidth, 2Ch
• 1GSa/s
100MHz • USB Host & PictBridge $836
Inc GST
For full spec sheets and to buy now online, visit
36 Years Quality Service
siliconchip.com.au
www.wiltronics.com.au
Ph: (03) 5334 2513
Email: sales<at>wiltronics.com.au
September 2010 7
Mailbag: continued
Google Earth images are
often out of date
I feel I have to answer to Bruce
Wilson’s Letter in the August Issue
regarding his accusations of Photo
shop manipulation of boat show
aerial photos.
Firstly, I would sincerely doubt
that SILICON CHIP would have the
financial resources to secure realtime satellite images of Sanctuary
Cove and even if they did, most of
those resources are looking at more
important things (like terrorists,
nuclear heat blooms etc).
Secondly, the images in Google
Earth are so old and out-dated that I
prefer to use Neo Earth. At least the
images there are a lot more recent,
even if they do not yet have the
the problem and perhaps can suggest
an answer?
Alan Greaves,
St Clair, NSW.
UHF remote control extender
has design flaws
With regards to a circuit that appeared in Circuit Notebook for July,
namely the UHF link for a remote
control extender, it should not be used
due to two design flaws.
First, the output of the TSOP 4136,
as with most IR receiver/decoder
chips, is high when not receiving an
IR signal. With some brands of UHF
Tx module, a high of more than about
0.8V will cause the unit to constantly
down to ground resolution.
I lived in a small town in rural
Queensland for over four years with
a very distinctive work vehicle and
in that time, that vehicle was parked
outside my home every day. As yet,
that vehicle has yet to appear in any
of the available images! I also built
an extensive workshop onto that
property and it has also yet to appear
in the Google Earth images.
Like the TV, don’t believe everything you see on the internet and
never make accusations you cannot
back up. Good on yer Kevin. The
majority of us were very impressed
with your informative article, keep
up the great work.
Dave Sargent,
Maryborough, Qld.
send out a 433MHz carrier signal. This
constant signal will cause interference
to all other UHF devices within range.
This interference will effectively
“jam” these devices. Some 90% of
vehicle keyless entry units work on
433MHz. Wireless alarm systems use
this frequency as do the new wireless
energy monitoring systems.
Remote garage doors and gates also
use 433MHz along with many other
devices and all could be rendered
non-operational if within range of this
circuit. Some UHF transmitter units
can have ranges in excess of 1km.
Flaw 2 is in the receiver. If a constant 433MHz signal is received by
the receiver, its on-board AGC system
will be attempting to compensate for
the steady signal. This will mean that
when a wanted pulse train is received,
the AGC will stop the receiver from
working correctly until it settles on
the now correct signal.
Although the general idea has merit,
this circuit should not be used for this
application.
Jeff Monegal,
North Maclean, Qld.
Substitute Sanyo transistors
In the Ask SILICON CHIP pages of your
July edition a reader, S. M., was asking for advice on alternatives for two
Sanyo transistors. If we give the devices their full part number then they
would read 2SD330E and 2SB514E
and data sheets in PDF format for
2SD330 and 2SB514 are available at
www.alldatasheets.com
Entering these latter two numbers
into the NTE Electronics crossreference database gives NTE152 and
NTE153 respectively. Farnell Electronics carry NTE products and the
NTE152 has a part number of 4428043
and the NTE153 a part number of
4524238. Both items are reasonably
priced and are currently in stock.
My thanks for the content of your
magazine. As a sole service technician,
it helps me to keep up to date with new
trends and devices.
Murrey Gedye,
Christchurch, NZ.
Other replacements for
Sanyo transistors
In regards to S. M. of Tea Gardens,
NSW and his note about Sanyo power
transistor substitutes, the transistors he is referring to are 2SD330E &
2SB514E. These are a complementary
The "Real Australian" manufacturer of Australia's largest range of process instrumentation
8 Silicon Chip
ALIAN OW
TR
ST
DE
AU
Certified System
Quality
Endorsed
Company
AU
Large digit displays (up to 200mm)
Panel mount displays/controllers
DIN rail mount monitors/controllers
Multi channel scanning monitors
Hand held meters
Wide variety of retransmission and
setpoint relay options available
TM
D
NE
S
The Digital Display People
RA L N M A
IA
ISO9001:2008
SAI GLOBAL
AMALGAMATED INSTRUMENT CO PTY LTD
8 2 # 5 8
1
2
3
4
Unit 5, 28 Leighton Place, Hornsby, NSW 2077
Phone: (02) 9476 2244 Fax: (02) 9476 2902
e-mail: sales<at>aicpl.com.au
Website: http://www.aicpl.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
push-pull pair in TO-220 packages.
These can easily be replaced by TIP31A & TIP32A transistors respectively. They have the same TO-220 package
and the same pin-out. Both devices are cheap and readily
available at Jaycar Electronics.
Kent Martin,
West Footscray, Vic.
Audio quality on commercial
long-distance flights
Having flown recently from Heathrow to Brisbane return
with Singapore Airlines on the A380 via Changi airport, I
initially looked forward to the experience. Over the years
I’ve flown on 707, 747 and 777s with varied experiences of
the entertainment systems. While the A380 was considerably quieter and the audio/video system greatly improved,
using the airline’s standard headsets degraded the audio
quality. Engine noise still intruded, especially towards the
rear of the aircraft; obviously tourist class.
I took the liberty of “borrowing” a headphone set (fear
not, they will get them back!) to trace out the circuit. The
plugs of the twin stereo connector go separately to each
moving-coil headphone measuring 300Ω, therefore one
assumes about the same impedance. There is no common
connection or series resistor. Unlike high-impedance headphones of 10kΩ for valve amplifiers or 8Ω for transistor
circuitry, the aircraft unit could be described as medium
impedance.
Why the fully isolated circuits? Are they commoned at
the seat sockets? The question is asked because if one uses
one’s own headphones, noise cancelling (NC) or not, the
supplied “aircraft adaptor” and/or headphones invariably
commons the output. It has to because retail headphones
have three poles; left, right and common using a standard
miniature jack plug.
More unanswered questions! Using the said adaptor,
what happens if a reasonable quality 8Ω headset is plugged
into the seat socket? Will it damage or overload the aircraft
system? What will be the sound level and quality? Trawling
the Internet, it appears that most NC headsets which use
an internal battery are of 32Ω impedance; roughly a tenth
of the impedance of those supplied on-board. Again, does
this impedance mismatch affect or degrade the system?
What about the common connection?
Cleaning
Hopefully, when flying the same route in 2011, I’m
intending to purchase a reasonably-priced NC headset.
Fujikon NC-2 (32Ω) look modestly priced and are wellrecommended.
Alternatively, I could use existing high-quality stereo
8Ω headphones and build a simple impedance matching/
isolating “plastic box.” The latter would incorporate two
typical miniature Jaycar MM2530 transformers, 500Ω
centre-tapped primary, 8Ω secondary, 450mW. Two suitable
short flying leads with mono plugs to the primaries plus
a miniature stereo socket with commoned secondaries as
output would also be required.
Conformal Coating
HPA- High performance
flexible acrylic clear coating
SWAS - water based PCB cleaning
Suitable for removing very stubborn
flux residue and no-clean fluxes.
Very effective with an ultrasonic tank.
See the Safewash range for all types of
cleaning applications
Conformal Coating
WBP- Water based conformal coating
Applied by dipping or spraying onto PCBs
Coating properties, excellent solvent
resistance & wide operating temp range.
Approved to US MIL-1-46058C
UV trace for inspection
Excellent dielectric properties and with
a wide temperature range
Resistant to mould growth
3/98 Old Pittwater Rd, Brookvale NSW 2100 Tel (02) 9938 1566 www.electrolube.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 9
Mechanical Design
Mechanical engineering is so complex it’s more like an art form
RSDC: Rolling Stock Design Consult; rsdc_industrial<at>yahoo.co.uk
Case History No.71
Even though we spend a lot time designing railway carriages, we also supply Mechanical Design
consulting service to the military, electronics, process and vehicle engineering markets. Going
back into our archives I hope to be able to help you understand the subtle issues that make your
use of mechanical design more of a success then it might otherwise have been.
We were called in by an old client who had bought some (120) stainless cabinets off an importer
because they were “cheap”. His company manufactured monitoring equipment to the process
industry and he saw these cabinets as ideal for some of his standard monitoring equipment.
One of his regular clients owned a variety of plants all over the country and he had sold all
120 cabinets as a job lot after fitting them out with his equipment. Unfortunately about 60 of
these cabinets had experienced severe corrosion after 3 months service and my old friend was
looking down the barrel of a very expensive warranty claim.
The stainless shelf had corroded around the inside shelf area and to make matters worse about
half of these also experienced very severe corrosion of some aluminium brackets which tied
some of my clients equipment together. Working with stainless as we have with almost all of
Sydney’s double deckers, our company’s expertise in the use of Stainless is considerable. I
inspected one those cheap cabinets and immediately saw the flaw.
Stainless steel uses oxygen as part of its “built in” protection system. Some forms of sheet metal
configuration starve some areas of oxygen and the metal simply falls apart. My client’s only
option was to replace all 120 cabinets with a design that suited the application. We talked him
out of using stainless in favour of a zinc-coated mild steel which, in our opinion, best suited the
environment that his client was experiencing in his plants and it was also cheaper.
We jumped a domestic flight to visit the 60 units that had internal alloy corrosion. It transpired
that this big multi-national had fitted my clients monitoring equipment near some of their
equipment which contained a microswitch which contained mercury. Due a faulty design,
their switches had fractured and were leaking mercury vapour into the air, causing my clients
alloy to literally “turn to powder” because mercury actually “melts” aluminium. My client
made a warranty claim against the multi national, based on our report. All 120 units were
returned to “have the alloy replaced” . . . but also managed to replace the stainless cabinets
in the process. He structured his claim against them to cover some of his costs but threw in
his profit on the original deal. That way he wasn’t bankrupt but had forgone his profit which
he considered a safer option.
At least he didn’t have to foot the complete bill to replace all the stainless units because that
would have cleaned him out completely and this allowed him to live to fight another day.
Peter Walker: 0450 117 360
rsdc _industrial <at> yahoo.co.uk
NATO supplier code: KD3TF
Mailbag: continued
Is it worth going to this trouble? I’m travelling Qantas
next year. Any advice much appreciated.
Robert Gott,
Normanton, West Yorkshire, UK.
Comment: we don’t know the answers, Robert. Perhaps a
reader can comment.
Digital scopes don’t give a realistic
picture of analog signals
I have a comment regarding your editorial and the Air
Quality Meter article in the June 2010 issue. The console
style gas space heater which we have had in our lounge
room for over 20 years has a “concentric” powered flue.
As well as the exhaust gasses being vented outside, the
intake air for the combustion process is drawn in from
outside through the same flue. This keeps the combustion
cycle completely separate from the room, with only the
heat generated being conducted to the room via a heat
exchanger and fan. I find it a bit strange (with the exception of the “plug-in” style portable gas heaters), that all
gas heaters are not required to have the same flue system
as our heater has.
The glowing review of the LeCroy WaveAce digital
scope has goaded me into commenting on this and digital
scopes in general. Despite all the wonderful features these
10 Silicon Chip
More bad feedback on
compact fluoros
I was interested in Ray Hudson’s letter, Mailbag
April 2010, as his observations are similar to mine.
None of our CFLs have given their claimed life. They
are mainly used in oyster fittings to reduce the fittings’
internal temperature which was very high using conventional incandescent globes. I suspect that higher
internal temperatures in the fittings may contribute
to their shortened life.
The failure of his 18W fluorescent lights (assuming
they are hot-cathode types) in his bathroom would
most likely be due to constant on/off switching.
Fluorescent lights have a finite number of switch-on
cycles and will quickly fail if used in this way. Also,
when used in bathrooms, the time for them to start can
be a nuisance, particularly in cold weather. Another
thing against bathroom use is poor colour rendition,
important if a vanity unit is incorporated.
Fluorescent lights are best used when they are
only switched occasionally, with a long “on period”.
Because of this characteristic, they give their longest
life when used in say kitchens or in commercial and
similar premises.
As some people seem displeased with the life from
their CFLs, I wonder if CFLs also suffer from this
switching characteristic.
Brian Coulson,
Balcolyn, NSW.
scopes have, I regard the trace displayed on the screen as
being so poor as to be almost useless. Looking at the pics
you have published, I ask how can anything really useful
be gathered from the pathetic fuzzy jagged waveforms
displayed on the screen? Are those, I presume, sinewaves
in your pictures, really pure sinewaves?
If you suspected, for example, that an audio power
amplifier had crossover distortion, it would be impossible
to see it on the screen. If there was a small “bubble” of
parasitic oscillation on a waveform, it would be virtually
impossible to see it just by examining the display. Could
you accurately calibrate the HF compensation on a x10
probe? I don’t think so. The “corner” of the square wave
used to adjust for no undershoot or overshoot would be
too fuzzy and unstable to make reliable adjustments.
At my work recently, I was commenting to a colleague
about how the sine shapers in many function generators
have noticeable distortion on the waveform peak, resulting
in a small point instead of a smooth rounding. To demonstrate this I hooked the output of a FG to a CRO. Ooh, it
was a digital scope. After spending some minutes trying
to discern the point on the waveform top, I gave up! The
noise and garbage completely masked what I was trying
to show. I later dragged an old cheap analog CRO in and
was able to show the distortion perfectly!
On another occasion, I had the output of a sinewave
generator feeding into a digital scope and I was slowly
increasing the amplitude. At one point, the display on
the scope started to clip. There was no reason why the
siliconchip.com.au
input signal would be clipping and as
I increased the amplitude further, the
clipping disappeared. Winding the
amplitude up and down showed that
this “clipping” was not signal clipping
at all but just one of the bad quantising
characteristics of the digital scope.
The scope was a comparatively
cheap one, so I went and got a better
Tektronix model. Although it wasn’t
as bad, the flattening of the waveform
peak was still noticeable at various
amplitude levels. Can these scopes
be trusted to give an accurate display?
Definitely NOT!
I was talking some time ago with
a couple of technical officers who
worked for a company which specialises in reconditioning and recalibrating high-end, secondhand test and
measurement equipment. When I
mentioned digital scopes, these two
fellows said that their company gets
phone calls every week from people
wanting high-end reconditioned
analog CROs because the digital
scopes, even top-quality ones are just
too poor in what they display!
Cost breakdown
on CFLs
Last year I decided to replace
some of my household light bulbs
with compact fluorescent types to
compare the durability. One of the
bulbs was installed in a fixture that
is on approximately six hours a day.
The existing bulb was 75W and to
achieve a compatible light output, I
installed a 23W compact fluorescent,
with a life rating of three years.
Six months after being installed
it failed. I thought I had a dud unit,
so replaced it with another 23W unit
but a different brand. Nine months
Perhaps it’s time you reviewed some
good analog CROs, showing just how
pure and clean the display is even if
they don’t have all the bells and whistles that the digital ones have.
Ray Chapman,
Senior Technical Officer,
Pakenham, Vic.
Comment: as always, there are two
sides to the story and those noisy
later it also failed. The fine print on
the package states that three years
is calculated at 5.5 hours/day, ie,
about 6000 hours. So, my two bulbs
lasted 6 hours x 183 days (or about
1100 hours) and 6 hours x 274 days
(or 1645 hours) – nowhere near the
supposed life of these units. These
bulbs may use less energy but they
are expensive, don’t fit many light
fittings and it seems, are not as durable as quoted.
I think Halogen replacement is
the way to go.
Rob Leplaw,
Oatley, NSW.
traces you are complaining about may
actually be a truer representation of
the signal. In other words, maybe that
noise is really there. Analog scopes
effectively “average out” that noise to
display a clean waveform.
You can often get the same result on
a digital scope by using the “averaging” mode.
However, where there are lots of
Custom Battery Packs,
Power Electronics & Chargers
For more information, contact
Phone (08) 9302 5444 or email mark<at>siomar.com
www.batter ybook.com
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 11
Mailbag: continued
Making your own
3D movies
The recent articles on 3D TV
and in particular, the article on the
SpeedWedge in the June 2010 issue,
prompted me to write.
Nearly 30 years ago, I made my
own 3D movies to wow friends and
family. The principle was simple
and should transfer to modern digital technology as is.
Two mirrors split the same image
into two, side by side on film (see
the filming diagram and the Vertical
Aspect diagram). The film was then
developed. With two similar mirrors
(see the projection diagram), these
two images were projected on top of
one another onto a silvered screen.
Each image was projected through
an oppositely polarised Polaroid
filter.
The audience then viewed the
movie through oppositely polarised
Polaroid spectacles. The silvered
screen ensured that the polarisation
of the two images was not lost.
The aspect ratio of the final 3D
picture was vertical (again, see
the Vertical Aspect diagram), as a
horizontal aspect ratio would have
glitches and irregular waveforms, averaging cannot be used and you have
to put up with apparently noisy traces.
On the other hand, the analog scope
will just not be in the hunt.
12 Silicon Chip
required a more complex system of
mirrors to fit two panoramic views
on standard film (see the Horizontal
Aspect diagram) and then to project
them on top of one another on the
silvered screen.
In fact, if the audience is willing to
squint, all this could be done without the silvered screen, without the
polarised filters and without the secIs the heavily noise-filtered trace on
an analog scope actually a true picture
of the signal you are looking at? Digital
scopes may indicate that it is not.
Some years ago we felt the same
ond set of mirrors. As an example,
you can try it with the above photos
that I took of a Church’s bell-tower
in Laaiplek, a town 160km north
of Cape Town in South Africa. One
needs to go cross-eyed and when
the two images snap together, bring
them into focus.
Rev. Thomas Scarborough,
Cape Town, South Africa.
way about digital scopes but as you
become more familiar with today’s
high-performance units, you will realise that going back to an analog scope
SC
is a retrograde step.
siliconchip.com.au
ACTUAL SIZE
ANOTHER
QUANTUM LEAP IN
MARINE ENTERTAINMENT
PALM SIZED, MASSIVE PERFORMANCE
»
»
»
»
»
BUILT FOR THE HARSH MARINE ENVIRONMENT
FUSIONS INDUSTRY-LEADING USER INTERFACE
iPod CONNECTIVITY AND INTEGRATION
WORKS WITH iPhone
HIGH QUALITY AM/FM TUNER
siliconchip.com.au
» LISTEN TO VHF CHANNELS
» USB COMPATIBILITY
» ADD THE MS-DKIPUSB MARINE DOCK TO ENABLE
VIDEO PLAYBACK FROM YOUR iPod/iPhone
*
» FIVE YEAR LIMITED WARRANTY
MARINE STEREO
MS-RA200
September 2010 13
FUSION Electronics Australia Ph: +61 1300 736 012 | FUSION Electronics New Zealand Ph: +64 9 369 2997 | www.fusionelectronics.com
© Copyright 2010 by FUSION Electronics Limited. All rights reserved. Specifications & design are subject to change without notice. *Five Year Limited Consumer Warranty consists of a three year warranty plus an additional two year fixed repair cost warranty extension. Visit www.fusionelectronics.com for full warranty terms & conditions.
audio/visual
equipment
for boats
Boaties like to have access to radio, music and on larger vessels,
video. Whether they are cranking the music up on the long run to
fish the continental shelf, relaxing at anchor or keeping track of
weather reports, they want performance and state-of-the-art gear.
T
oday, most boat-builders have receiver/amplifiers as original
equipment or as an option. In fact a $4.6 million motor yacht
at the recent Sanctuary Cove boat show had a FUSION sound
system in every cabin, the flybridge and transom area for totally
independent listening.
Marine systems with an integrated DVD player are relatively new,
however FUSION’s 600 DVD model also offers iPod control and
replay, plus FUSION has a world’s-first unit with weatherproof iPod
dock and controls built-in.
We saw the FUSION 600 DVD model at the recent Sydney Boat
Show – and like many boaties, we liked what we saw.
But it was only when we “lifted the lid”, so to speak, that we were
impressed enough to tell SILICON CHIP readers about it too!
With an in-built iPod dock, it handles programs from any conceivable audio source: DVD, CD, MP3 and all audio units with a headphone socket or RCA line-out. If an iPod is plugged into the dock,
the MS-IP600 takes over the controls of the iPod and also charges it.
Designed for marine use
FUSION’s 600 series audio/visual entertain14 Silicon Chip
by Kevin
ment unit, examined here, is designed specifically for marine use;
it’s not just re-badged car equipment. They are probably the only
company in the world who design true marine entertainment systems
from the ground up.
FUSION gear is designed in Auckland, NZ for worldwide distribution – and is taking off in Australia and the United States.
Class-D for efficiency
One problem with entertainment systems on most boats is that
mains power is not available.
Instead, power comes from batteries and to keep batteries charged,
you either need solar panels and/or you have to run the engines or
a genset.
For the batteries to last as long as possible, the current drain of
audio equipment needs to be as low as possible.
FUSION were one of the first marine entertainment manufacturers
to employ Class-D amplifiers, which have typical efficiencies of 85% or
more – a great improvement on that achieved
by Class-AB amplifiers. Incidentally, that’s one
Poulter
reason that the vast majority of portable audio
siliconchip.com.au
equipment and cheap home theatre sound systems now use ClassD. Class-D amplifiers also mean much more compact construction,
which is why the small FUSION range can produce lots of power.
Another big advantage of Class-D is that it doesn’t need a lot of
cooling. Some brands using class AB amplifiers provide cooling
with a large hole in the rear and a computer fan. This inevitably
draws in salt air.
True 360° waterproof design
No other environment is as unforgiving as the marine enviroment. Predominantly moisture-laden salt-concentrate (also
called ‘fog’ in the marine certification tests), is a relentless
invader attacking metal parts with gusto.
This can be combatted by sealing all entry points, which is
only possible if you have used class-D amplifiers.
The 600D series has a die-cast clamshell construction, with
a single lid and a rubber gasket, plus two sealed compartments
to totally seal it from the elements.
FUSION’s 600 complies with IP-x5 splashproof standards.
The rugged diecast ‘clamshell’ construction withstands the
harsh marine environment, including the pounding and vibration
a vessel normally experiences.
Dropdown
door
Multi-zone technology
Zone control is particularly important in larger motor yachts as it
makes it easy to access and direct audio all over the boat at the level
required in that particular area.
Flash memory
It is normal safe practice when a boat is unused (eg, tied up at a
mooring or berth) for all batteries to be isolated, via master switches
or circuit breakers.
Therefore no power is available to maintain memory settings, as
it would be in a car, for example.
FUSION get around this by storing all last-used parameters in
non-volatile memory. Even if the boat is not used from one year
to the next, when the FUSION 600 is turned on all settings will be
exactly as they were before.
ARM processor.
The user interface has been designed to be as simple as possible to
operate. To achieve this, the heart of operations is an ARM processor
with a 32-bit Reduced Instruction Set Computer (RISC).
One benefit of the ARM processor is that it is very suitable for low
power applications.
More intelligence
When you adjust the backlight
of the LCD for night use, all the
keys are mapped, so they also
change brightness proportional
to the screen illumination setting. The display digits are large
and the digital clock is about
25mm high.
siliconchip.com.au
Class-D
output
filters
IF
transformers
Input
choke
Sirius
satellite
reception
Voltage
regulator
What makes it tick?
Taking the cover off and removing the DVD player reveals a digital
tuner, audio processors enabling zone control, plus a number of
building blocks making up the product.
As already noted, the 600 platform is quite powerful, delivering 4
x 70W (peak) into 2-ohm loudspeakers from its bridged amplifiers.
Jtag
debug
port
CD / DVD
shockmounted
transport
Input cap
(4,700F)
Apple iPod interface
Through the iPOD interface which FUSION developed, it communicates with the iPod and can interrogate it, read files and track
information, plus search it.
Since Apple do not usually give away the technical ability to search
for music, FUSION developed their own alpha-search technology.
It means you can find music in a vast array of songs or albums
effectively.
In order to be Apple-approved equipment, FUSION submits their
prototype hardware to Apple for extensive testing and ultimate approval, before it can be released to the market.
No manual required!
In the FUSION there is no multiple-lines-of-text-on-screen that
require a user manual that’s the size of a book; in fact, it’s so intuitive
that a user manual is obsolete. Inspired by the way Apple do things,
FUSION makes their products very user-friendly, through icons and
simple key-presses.
Sirius satellite reception ready
In addition to AM/FM reception, this model can receive Sirius Satellite Radio in USA and Canada via optional equipment – important to
skippers of larger vessels who travel to North America. Sirius Satellite
Radio provides 69 streams (channels) of music and 65 streams of
sports, news and entertainment to listeners.
Specifications:
Conclusion
4 x 70W max; 4 x 43W RMS into 2Ω
AM/FM Tuner; Sirius radio ready
DVD/CD, MP3 and iPod
(also available with internal iPod dock)
Outputs:
1 x RCA stereo, 2 x subwoofer, video & S-video
Inputs: iPod, RCA auxiliary, Sirius, wired remote
Display:
2.7-inch backlit LCD
Waterproofing: IPX5 (includes full behind-dash water protection)
Dimensions:
80 x 217 x 36mm (mounting 53 x 181 x 160mm)
Further details:
Fusion, Ph: 1300 736 012
www.fusionelectronics.com
Power Output:
Media:
If the response by visitors to
the boat show is any indication,
FUSION, a small NZ company, is
leading the world in marine AV
entertainment.
September 2010 15
LED replacements for
fluorescent lamps:
are they any good?
Half the power – lots of light – more than twice
36W fluorescent tubes are the main source of light in supermarkets
& retail stores, offices and many factories. There are hundreds of
millions of them in use around Australia and many billions in use
around the world. But while they are the most efficient light source
in offices and the home, they are now being challenged by LED tubes
which can directly replace them.
By LEO SIMPSON
B
ACK IN THE MAY 2010 issue we
had a feature article on how to
slash office lighting bills by using quad
phosphor fluorescent tubes made by
NEC. In our own office, we substituted
one quad phosphor tube for the two
existing tubes in each twin-lamp luminaire. The result was a much brighter
office and a cut in electricity consumption due to lighting of about 50%.
Since then we have heard from readers who are delighted with the results
of using quad phosphor fluorescent
tubes. In one industrial warehouse
complex, they replaced all the tubes in
what was a dingy and dangerous un-
derground section and the increase in
lighting was a revelation. In that case
they did not save power but the improvement in illumination, especially
at night, made the complex much safer
and less prone to graffiti and vandalism. As a bonus, the improved lighting
also made their CCTV security system
much more effective.
At the end of the above article, we
made a brief reference to the existence
of LED replacements for fluorescent
tubes but discounted them at the time
because they were very expensive
and the units that we knew of apparently did not comply with Australian
This close-up shot of the end of a LED replacement tube shows the different
LEDs used in the Cool White model. It is apparently powered as four sets of
63 LEDs.
16 Silicon Chip
standards. We concluded with the
remark that “In the next few years that
is bound to change.”
Well, the future has a habit of arriving quickly these days. In the very
next issue (June 2010), local company
Tenrod Australia introduced a range of
ecoLED replacement tubes. Naturally,
we had to obtain some samples and
put them to some comparative tests.
The first point to make about these
LED replacements is that they are
exactly that. They can be fitted in
place of conventional fluorescent
tubes since they have the same length
and the same 2-pin connector at each
end. There are a number of provisos
though. First, while they can be used
in standard 36W fluorescent fittings
which have a conventional ballast,
the starter MUST be removed. If the
starter is left in place, it is immediate
death to the LED replacement tube.
Ideally, the fitting should be rewired
so that the ballast, starter and power
factor correction capacitor (if fitted)
are all removed, to provide maximum
efficiency. In effect, the full mains
supply is applied across the LED replacement tube.
siliconchip.com.au
the life
The tubular extruded aluminum housing provides rigidity and acts as a
heatsink. It barely gets warm.
If the existing iron ballast is left in
place, there is a small loss in efficiency
but since the extra power consumption amounts to less than one watt,
we think that most users will leave the
ballast in place. It is too much trouble
to remove it.
LED replacement tubes cannot be
fitted in fluorescent fittings with elec-
tronic ballasts, unless of course, the
fitting is rewired to remove the ballast.
How many LEDs?
The ecoLED T8 replacement is
housed in a tubular aluminium extrusion with a clear polycarbonate lens
section. It has three rows of 84 LEDs
each, making a total of 252. The LEDs
are surface-mount types, on a long narrow PC board. The driving electronics
is in the tube housing.
Switch on a LED replacement tube
and there is a short delay of about
two seconds and then it lights up at
full brilliance. There is no flick-flickflickering and no gradual build-up
in light output. There is no strobing
which can be evident with conventional fluorescent tubes and nor is
there any buzz, hum or whistle. Radio
interference is also very low.
And they are really bright. Looked at
directly from less than a metre away,
they are almost painful to behold. The
aluminium tubular housing barely
gets warm and that is what you would
expect since the power consumption
for the tube is around 20W or less –
less than half the consumption of a
fluorescent tube running with a conventional ballast.
Looked at from further away, their
apparent surface brightness is also
higher than any conventional fluorescent tube. However, that is not the
whole story. While, the LED replacement type radiates mainly in one
direction, set by the individual LED
lenses, a conventional fluorescent
tube radiates evenly in all directions
around its main axis and so puts out
more light. This may or may not be
useful, depending on whether the
luminaire has a reflector behind the
tube and maybe a prismatic diffuser
in front of it.
For example, we did some comparisons between a Daylight White
LED replacement and an NEC quad
phosphor 36W fluorescent tube. The
JOIN the teChNOLOgy age NOW WIth
PICaXe
Developed as a teaching tool, the PICAXE is a low-cost “brain” for almost any project.
Easy to use and understand, professionals & hobbyists can be productive within minutes.
Free software development system and low-cost in-circuit programming.
Variety of hardware, project boards and kits to suit your application.
Digital, analog, RS232, 1-Wire™, SPI and I2C.PC connectivity.
Applications
include:
Distributed in
Australia by
1[Datalogging 1[Robotics 1[Measurement & instruments 1[Motor & lighting control
1[Farming & agriculture 1[Internet server 1[Wireless links 1[Colour sensing 1[Fun games
Microzed Computers Pty Ltd
Phone 1300 735 420
Fax 1300 735 421
www.microzed.com.au
www.siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
NEW X2
HIPS
now in sC
tock!
ovember 2010 17
2009 67
SNeptember
These LED replacement tubes are exactly the same overall length and use the
same 2-pin connector as on standard T8 fluorescent tubes.
This is the Daylight model in which the surface-mount LEDs are all the same
type and colour.
light fitting was a single 36W batten
with a conventional iron ballast and
no reflector, mounted on the ceiling
of a small study measuring about 2.5 x
3.5 metres. Comparative light outputs
were measured by a Digitech multimeter with a Lux scale. It was sited on
a desk 2.2 metres below the light fitting.
Brightness
When first turned on, the LED replacement produced a reading of about
138 Lux which was certainly adequate
for general tasks such as reading or
using a computer. However, since
most of the light is projected straight
down, it was noticeable that the ceiling itself was quite dark, as you might
expect from the tube’s 120° viewing
angle. The overall room illumination
improved when the prismatic diffuser
was fitted, as this bounced some light
onto the ceiling. It did not make any
difference to the Lux reading though.
The second test was with the NEC
quad phosphor tube and this produced
a reading of 215 Lux. Not only was this
55% brighter but the illumination was
more even, with considerable bounce
of light from the sides of the tube off
the ceiling. Fitting the prismatic diffuser made a slight difference, increasing the reading to 220 Lux.
On the face of it, the NEC quad
phosphor tube wins the light output
race by a mile but there is a lot more
to the story. On the other hand, if we
18 Silicon Chip
had used a single phosphor tube the
comparison would have been in favour
of the LED replacement. However, we
did not see much point in that. Since
the LED replacement has a premium
price it should be compared with a
premium fluorescent tube – the NEC
quad phosphor.
As an aside, the LED replacement
comes on with full brilliance and then
dims very slightly as it warms up over
a period of (say) 30 minutes. The dimming is so slight that you only know
about it if you are measuring Lux –
otherwise it is not apparent. This is in
line with normal LED behaviour – the
warmer they are, the less light they
emit but it is not a large effect.
By contrast, the quad phosphor tube
started off with a relatively low output (it was a cold July evening with a
room temperature of about 12°C) and
came up to full brilliance in a period
of about 30 minutes.
As far as power consumption is
concerned, the LED replacement wins
hands down, with less than half the
power use of a conventional fluorescent fitting.
By the way, when installed in a fitting with a prismatic diffuser, these
tubes appear little different to ordinary
fluorescents, at least to the casual
observer.
How it works
The Tenrod LED replacements are
powered by an internal switchmode
supply. It can accept a mains input
supply from 80-265V AC. It has an EMI
(electromagnetic interference) filter at
the input followed by a bridge rectifier and capacitor filter. The supply
is based on a PFM (pulse frequency
modulation) chip and a Mosfet which
regulate the current though the LEDs
to within 5%. Hence the LED brightness is essentially constant for that full
range of mains input voltage.
In fact, we measured the brightness
over the range 70-250V and there was
virtually no variation at all. One thing’s
for sure, with these tubes “brownouts” will be a thing of the past.
The LEDs in the Tenrod tubes appear to be run in groups of 63 (4 x
63 = 252), possibly further split into
three paralleled strings of 21 LEDs.
This would give an operating voltage
in the region of 70V and is in line with
the minimum input supply of 80VAC.
Mind you, we are hypothesising here
because we were not able (unwilling,
actually) to break into the package to
find out the details.
Power consumption was virtually
constant over a fairly wide range of
mains input voltages. For one of the
sample tubes we tested, in a fitting
without a ballast, it was 19.6W at 210250VAC. Power consumption drops
very slightly after the unit has been
running for 30 minutes or so.
The Tenrod LED tubes come in
three colours: Daylight White (5600
- 6300K), Cool White (3800 - 4200K)
and Warm White (3200 - 3500K). Their
brightness ratings were 400, 375 and
360 Lux, respectively (measured at a
distance of one metre). Total light output, measured in Lumens, was 1500,
1400 and 1350, respectively.
For the Daylight tube, that is equiv
alent to 75 lumens/watt which compares very favourably with the NEC
quad phosphor tubes at 100 lumens/
watt.
Interestingly, on a Lux/watt basis,
the ecoLED Daylight tube easily beats
the NEC quad phosphor, especially
if it is fitted in a ballasted luminaire.
siliconchip.com.au
ecoLED Tube
For our money, we would go for the Daylight model for
most applications. The different colours are obtained by
mixing the LEDs in the rows but for the Daylight White
the LEDs all appear to be the same – white.
OK, so we have talked about light output and power
consumption. A number of points remain to be discussed.
The first is expected life. Typical fluorescent tubes have
a stated life of 16,000 hours and can be expected to last
four or five years in a typical office installation. This is
far in excess of compact fluorescent lamps which often
don’t last any longer than the much-maligned incandescent lamps.
The above-mentioned NEC quad phosphor tubes have
a 20,000 hour life but these ecoLED replacements have
a stated life of 50,000 hours!
Such a long life makes them ideal for installations
where they are on permanently, such as in parking stations and railway stations. They could be expected to last
almost six years. In practice, no-one really knows how
long LEDs last so they could have an even longer life.
As an aside, the fact that they work well at low temperatures means that they can be used where conventional
fluorescent tubes don’t function efficiently and have
difficulty starting, such as in freezer and cool-rooms
and in glass-fronted refrigerators (as in supermarkets
and convenience stores).
Saving Energy & the Environment
No mercury Friendlier alternative
to fluorescent lamps
Install in
its place
How much are they?
The final point is the price. As you might expect, these
ecoLED tubes are significantly more expensive than even
the NEC quad phosphor tubes we cited as a benchmark.
But with less than half the power consumption and very
long life, many building owners will be looking very
closely at installing these tubes.
Pricing for the Daylight T8 tube is $80 + GST on a
one-off basis, dropping to $60 + GST for 100-off quantities. With electricity prices rising inexorably, they are
certainly attractive, especially in installations where
they run 24 hours a day. At 24c/kilowatt hour (the Energy Australia commercial rate) it costs $100.92 to run
one 36W ballasted fluorescent fitting (drawing around
48W total) for a year. By using an ecoLED tube drawing
20W instead, that drops to $42.00. You don’t have to be
a chartered accountant to work out that an installation
of these tubes into a parking station would have a very
short payback period.
Oh and we should mention that these LED replacement tubes have no mercury and no lead content. Our
impression is that these LED replacement tubes will
make very quick inroads into the Australian market and
around the world.
For further information, contact Tenrod Australia Pty
Ltd, 1/24 Vore St, Silverwater, NSW 2128. Phone (02)
9748 0655. Their website is at www.tenrod.com.au SC
siliconchip.com.au
Half your energy bills
18W for 4ft (120cm)
9W for 2ft (60cm)
No flickering, no noise - No irritation
No glass to break (robustly built)
No starters to change
50,000 hours of lifetime
Daylight White, Cool White, Warm White
CRI > 75; 76.7 Lm per W (off the wall)
500gm net
IES Data available
Website: www.tenrod.com.au
E-mail: sales<at>tenrod.com.au
Sydney:
Melbourne:
Brisbane:
Auckland:
Tel. 02 9748 0655
Tel. 03 9886 7800
Tel. 07 3879 2133
Tel 09 298 4346
Fax. 02 9748 0258
Fax. 03 9886 7799
Fax. 07 3879 2188
Fax. 09 353 1317
September 2010 19
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
dicksmith.com.au
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
dicksmith.com.au
Designing and
Installing a
HEARING LOOP
For the deaf
Many people have hearing impairment. Whether they are watching
TV, listening to radio or music, attending a concert, meeting or
religious service, they have difficulty hearing, or understanding,
what is going on – and that may be in spite of using a hearing aid.
Hearing loops, which inductively couple an audio signal to a hearing
aid, are an increasingly common method of helping ease that difficulty.
J
ust because you have a hearing aid does not mean that ship which older people frequent. In fact, many modern
your hearing problems are solved. When you have nor- buildings are so equipped these days.
In the home, of course, the problem can be just as difmal hearing, your ears are very good at discriminating
between noise and the sounds you want to hear. Not so ficult, especially when shared with those without hearing
with a hearing aid, particularly if you are wearing only one. impairment. But it is unusual for hearing loops to be inThe hearing aid is basically a microphone, amplifier and stalled in the home.
Until now, that is: in this article we describe how to set
earpiece. Unfortunately the microphone picks up all sounds
and noise then amplifies all by the same amount. The wearer up a basic hearing loop for the home or for small to quite
large meeting rooms, to Australian, New Zealand and IEC
often has great difficulty discerning what is going on.
In many situations this problem can be largely overcome (International Electrotechnical Commission) standards –
by a hearing loop, fed by an audio amplifier. The loop is and how to drive it.
This could be done using a commercially made ampliplaced around the room or hall and the radiated signal
is then picked up by a hearing aid fitted with a T-coil (or fier specifically intended for hearing loop applications but
equally could be a standard commercial amplifier or even
Telecoil; see the sidebar, “The origin of the Telecoil”).
Alternatively, the signal can be picked up via a Cochlea one of the many amplifier designs published by SILICON CHIP.
Professional hearing loop installations can cost many
implant or even a loop receiver, as described elsewhere
thousands of dollars, especially when retro-fitted (most
in this issue, driving conventional headphones/earbuds.
new public buildings these days have
Hearing loss increases with age so it
them installed during construction in
is common for hearing loops to be used,
Part 1: By JOHN CLARKE appropriate areas as a matter of course).
for example, in halls and places of wor22 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
LOOP RECEIVER
& HEADPHONES
HEARING AID
WITH T-COIL
SIGNAL
SOURCE
MICROPHONE
AMPLIFIER
AMPLIFIER
M
LOUDSPEAKER
T
SWITCH
T-COIL
VOLUME CONTROL,
RESPONSE SHAPING
AUDIO INDUCTION LOOP
1
Fig.1: the basic arrangement for a hearing loop. Signal
from the room PA is amplified and coupled into the
loop. The resulting magnetic field is detected by suitably
equipped hearing aids or receivers.
OUTPUT
T-COIL
However, a do-it-yourself installationVOLTAGE
along the lines set
out in this article can provide excellent results and save a
heap of dollars. It is relatively easy to fit and can be made
small or quite large, depending on the area needed to be
covered.
What’s a hearing loop?
MAGNETIC
In its simplest form, a hearing loop system comprises
FIELD a
signal source, an amplifier and a large loop of wire around
the room or hall. As this loop forms a coil with an
AC curAUDIO
rent flowing through it, it radiates an electro-magnetic
wave
INDUCTION
which
is in sympathy with the signal source. LOOP
3
This radiated signal can be detected by a hearing aid
equipped with a T-coil or indeed, a loop receiver (with
headphones) designed for the purpose. Fig.1 shows the arrangement but we will explain just how this works shortly.
If you want to set up a hearing loop in your home you
should be able to get satisfactory results without any special
equipment. For larger setups in halls, the magnetic field
produced by the signal in the loop needs to be set to the
required level, so that all hearing aids with T-coils will
operate correctly.
In a later article in this series we will show how to build
and calibrate a signal level meter to measure signal levels
from the installed loop.
Our hearing loop is suitable for use in a home, office,
hall, church or similar building. We include design graphs
2
Fig.2: a hearing aid equipped with both T-coil and
microphone to cover both signal sources. Many hearing
aids will have a switch to select both. Obviously, the
loudspeaker is tiny enough to fit in the ear.
and tables to make it easy to select the wire size and its
L
length, along with the amplifier power requirements for a
particular installation.
For large loops, say in a community hall or church, you
H
will need a signal pre-conditioner. In a later issue we will
present a suitable design to allow a standard amplifier to
be employed. The pre-conditioner provides stereo signal
mixing, audio compression, treble boost to provide compensation for loop inductance and treble rolloff
I above 5kHz.
Other articles will provide circuit and construction details for an induction loop receiver (see p62 of this issue)
and
5 a microphone loop driver.
Now let’s describe the basics of a hearing aid.
How does a hearing aid work?
As we mentioned earlier, in its simplest form a hearing
Pulpit
Centre Aisle
Steps
Pew
Pew
Listening
Area
Archway
pillars
Archway
pillars
Sound
Desk
Centre Aisle
HEARING
LOOP
FITTED
Pews
Service
table
To use this facility, sit within
the listening area shown shaded
and switch your hearing aid to
the T-coil position.
Kitchen
A Hearing Loop is installed
in this building.
Front Entrance
Plan View
Where a hearing loop is fitted, it doesn’t usually cover the
entire area. Hence a “map” is needed, such as this one in a
church, to show deaf people with hearing aids where to sit.
siliconchip.com.au
The hearing loop (white figure-8) is laid out here for testing
before permanent installation under the floor.
September 2010 23
A commercial hearing loop amplifier, in this case the model 1077 from Auditec. It’s a current amplifier,
which has some advantages in hearing loop use but standard voltage amplifiers are certainly usable as well.
aid comprises a microphone, an amplifier and a miniature
loudspeaker. In normal use the sound picked up by the
microphone is amplified and processed, depending on the
complexity of the hearing aid. The amplified signal is then
reproduced via the loudspeaker which is closely coupled
to the wearer’s eardrum at a level which compensates for
the loss of hearing. Fig.2 shows the general internal arrangement.
Better, modern hearing aids also include signal processing to try to present the clearest audio to the wearer. And
the best also include a Telecoil (or T-coil), which comprises
a coil of wire on a ferrite core. A switch on the hearing aid
selects the T-coil or microphone as the input source.
Originally used to couple the electromagnetic energy
from a specially equipped telephone into the hearing aid
(hence the name), their use has now expanded to be able
to detect an electromagnetic signal from a hearing loop,
where fitted. Not all hearing aids have a T-coil and obviously, without one, there is absolutely no advantage from
either telephones or hearing loops.
Fig.3 shows the magnetic field produced by the hearing
loop (sometimes referred to as an audio induction loop) and
how this couples into the T-coil. Normally the induction
loop is horizontal and the T-coil is vertical (for a person
who is sitting or standing). Any variation of the T-coil from
its vertical position will reduce the received signal.
There is nothing to stop the orientation of the hearing
loop being vertical, allowing hearing aid wearers to use the
Here’s a commercial
hearing loop receiver
which drives standard
headphones. Or you can
build your own: see the
article on page 62!
24 Silicon Chip
loop when lying horizontal.
One disadvantage of the T-coil inductor is that it produces
a signal which rises in level with increasing frequency. This
is because the induced voltage is proportional to the rate
of change of the magnetic field and so higher frequencies
will give a higher voltage. This rising response is normally
compensated for within the hearing aid to produce a flatter
frequency response.
So why would a person with a hearing aid prefer to listen via the T-coil instead of listening directly to the sound
from a public address or similar sound system? After all,
a hearing aid is designed to pick up sound, amplify it and
tailor the frequency response to suit the individual user.
As already noted, people with normal hearing have little trouble discriminating between unwanted noise and
the sounds they want to hear. By contrast, the wearer of
the hearing aid finds that in a room full of people or in a
noisy environment, all they hear is a whole lot of noise
and it prevents them from following any one sound or
conversation. To that you can add natural reverberation in
a large room, the noise of people moving about and maybe
background music.
The room, especially if it’s reasonably sized, may well
have some form of public address system fitted. That’s
fine for those with normal hearing but ironically, a PA can
introduce more reverberation, cause hearing aid overload
(distortion) and can raise bass levels to further muddy the
sound clarity.
The solution is to channel signal directly from the public
address system into an audio induction loop to be picked
by the hearing aid T-coil. The resulting sound is clearer
because it only contains that broadcast by the sound system
and extraneous sounds from other people and reverberation are absent.
As good as it is, listening via a T-coil is not perfect: the
hearing aid user can feel isolated from the rest of the group
of people in the building because they do not hear the
ambient sounds of the people around them.
To overcome this, some hearing aids include switching
to select three options: T-coil, T-coil plus microphone and
microphone only. The T-coil plus microphone setting mixes
the signals to allow ambient sounds and the broadcast (PA)
signal to be heard but even this can be a compromise.
There is no perfect electronic cure for deafness! Protect
your hearing while you have it.
As an aside, it is widely and reliably forecast that the
siliconchip.com.au
1
2
T-COIL
The origin of the Telecoil
OUTPUT
VOLTAGE
L
MAGNETIC
FIELD
3Fig.3:
AUDIO
INDUCTION
LOOP
Current flowing in the hearing
loop produces a magnetic field that couples into the
T-coil. Voltage is produced across the T-coil terminals.
next ten to twenty years or so will see an explosion in the
number of younger people with irreversible hearing damage, caused (in particular) by years of exposure to loud rock
music (why do bands have to play so loud?) and more importantly, the massive use of ear-buds at excessive volume
from cassette players, then CD players and most recently
MP3/MP4 players and mobile phones.
Designing a hearing loop system
Before embarking on designing and installing a hearing
loop, you need to decide whether the building is suitable
for installing a loop. For many buildings the loop can be
installed beneath the floor, especially if it is timber construction and there is access to the underside of the flooring.
Where there is a concrete floor, the loop could be placed
around the floor under carpet or behind skirting boards.
Alternatively, the loop could be placed in the ceiling,
provided it is not too high above normal listening level.
Installing a hearing loop in buildings made with steel
frames or reinforced concrete is more difficult. This is because the steel tends to reduce the magnetic field strength.
The solution may be to provide more current drive in the
loop with a larger amplifier and/or by using more complex
loop designs.
For most installations, a single loop is all that is needed.
Loop performance can be checked before it is permanently
installed by simply running the loop wire temporarily
around the area (eg, on the floor) where required.
An important factor to consider when deciding on the
positioning of a loop is interference from the mains power
lines. In particular, phase-controlled light dimmers for
stage and auditorium lighting often cause a buzzing sound,
predominantly at 100Hz. The interference will be highest
when the lamps are dimmed.
Fluorescent lamps can cause interference when they are
switching on but do not usually cause problems once lit.
Another source of interference is close proximity to
computers and monitors; in fact anything with a “switchmode” power supply.
We’ll be describing a Hearing Loop Level Meter in a future
article, which can be used to check the background interference levels down to 21dB below a 100mA/m reference.
What level?
According to the Australian standards (AS60118.4-2007),
environmental audio frequency background field levels
siliconchip.com.au
5
Hearing aids installed with a Telecoil or T-coil began as
a solution to a problem that occurs when using a hearing
aid with a telephone. The Hname Telecoil originates from
the words telephone and coil.
To understand the problem you need to be aware that
there is coupling between the telephone mouthpiece
and the telephone earpiece, so as you speak some of
the sound is heard through the earpiece.IThe coupling is
called side tone and is deliberately introduced to prevent
the telephone sounding dead when speaking.
This can cause a problem when using a hearing aid.
When it is brought close to the earpiece of a telephone,
the hearing aid often produces a loud-pitched squeal, or
feedback. This is caused by the microphone on the hearing aid picking up sound that is amplified and reproduced
by the hearing aid loudspeaker, which is then received
by the telephone handpiece and then further re-amplified
by the hearing aid and so on.
To allow a hearing aid wearer to use a telephone,
without this problem occuring, the telephone is modified
to include a wire loop that is driven by the same signal as
the telephone loudspeaker. The loop produces a small
magnetic field that varies in sympathy with the signal.
To utilise this feature, the hearing aid needs to include
a Telecoil (T-coil) that detects signal from the phone’s
magnetic field. When required to be used in this way, the
hearing aid is switched to the “T-coil” position, disabling
the hearing aid microphone and thus avoiding the audio
feedback.
Some telephones include a Telecoil already installed
within the handpiece; some may need one fitted as an
accessory. More information is available from your telephone supplier or via The Independent Living Centres
Australia (www.ilcaustralia.com/home)
Some hearing aids are designed to automatically
switch over to the T-coil position in the presence of a
strong DC magnetic field. The magnet in the telephone
earpiece provides this field.
Due to the success of the T-coil in hearing aids with
telephones, its application has broadened to where
hearing loops are now commonly used wherever sound
needs to be available for the hearing impaired.
A “behind the ear”
hearing aid. The
tube at the top
feeds into the
ear canal, fed
by the miniature
loudspeaker at
the top of the unit.
Controls on the
back of the unit
include a volume
control, power
switch and the allimportant T-coil/
microphone switch.
September 2010 25
1
2
should be below –20dB ‘A-weighted’ with respect to a
100mA/m reference field (or –40dB below 1A/m) using a
OUTPUT
T-COIL
slow (S) time weighting of 1 second.
VOLTAGE
We do have reservations about whether this level is sufficiently low for satisfactory hearing loop performance. The
Hearing Loop Level Meter will also measure noise using a
wider frequency response than the A-weighting provides.
This can give a more realistic indication of whether noise
will be intrusive.
MAGNETIC
Another consideration is whether the loop wire will
be
FIELD
running close and parallel to signal wires in a public address
system, such as for microphones. This has the potential to
cause instability in the sound system although it INDUCTION
isAUDIO
usually
LOOP
no more
wiring
3 severe than feedback caused by loudspeaker
running close to the microphone cables.
Further problems may occur with dynamic, electret and
UHF radio microphones and guitars with magnetic pickups.
It is wise to test for these problems with a temporary loop
installation. Problems will be evident if the sound seems
distorted or has a “metallic” quality. An oscilloscope can
also be used to monitor the sound system signal for any
instability.
Note that an audio induction loop setup will not cause
direct acoustic feedback, ie, the squeal associated with
audio coupling of microphones and guitars to loudspeakers.
Spill
Generally, the area where a hearing aid will receive the
signal is within the loop itself. Outside the loop, the signal
level drops off. Fig.4 shows the measured field strength of
a 10m x 10m square loop at a height of 1m above the loop.
The signal is reasonably constant (to within 3dB) within
the loop area but drops off just outside the loop. Any signal
outside the loop is called the “spill”.
Spill means that the signal is not secure and might be
intercepted from outside the building, simply by using a
T-coil-equipped hearing aid. If security is important, that
is a consideration.
Spill also means that if more than one
Field strength over loop area for a 10m square loop <at> 1m
loop is installed in a building
above loop measures are required to
prevent interference between them.
0
-5
-10
Field Strength (dB)
H
I
Fig.5:
for a magnetic
5
field strength (H) of 100mA/m at the centre of the square
loop, the current required through the loop of side
length L is I=L/9n amps, where n is the number of turns.
More than one loop will be required where a very large
area needs to be covered. If each loop broadcasts the same
signal, then using out-of-phase adjacent loops can minimise
signal loss at the loop junction.
Where the signal in each loop is different (eg, in a multicinema theatre) the loop design must prevent any signal
spill into adjacent loops. Special loop designs enable spill
to be minimised. For more information on spill control, see
Ampetronic’s website: www.ampetronic.com
Coverage area
In many cases it is only necessary to provide loop coverage for part of a room or hall rather than attempt to provide
for the full area.
For example, where a hall has seating for say 500 people,
you may only need to provide hearing loop coverage for
50 seats or perhaps even less. This would mean that a map
would be required to show potential users the designated
listening area and/or any booking system would need to
provide priority for hearing impaired within that area.
A smaller loop also means that a lower-powered amplifier can be used.
Amplifiers for Hearing Loops
5
)
B
d
(
h
tg
n
re
tS
ld
ie
F
L
-15
-20
-25
-30
-35
-7
-6
-5
-4
-3
-2
-1
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Distance from centre (m)
Distance from centre (m)
Fig.4: field strength over loop area for a 10m square loop at
a height of 1m above loop.
26 Silicon Chip
As noted, an audio amplifier is required to “drive” the
loop. You have three choices: using a commercial hearing
loop amplifier, using a standard commercially-made amplifier . . . or you build your own!
Most commercial amplifiers specifically made for hearing loop use are “current” amplifiers, whereas “ordinary”
amplifiers, including ones you would build yourself, are
“voltage” amplifiers.
Current amplifiers have the advantage that the loop
current does not vary with frequency, which would normally occur due to the inductance of the loop. However,
standard voltage amplifiers can be used as well although
it is true that they provide reduced current to the loop as
the frequency rises. This is easily fixed, in most cases, with
some judicious treble boost.
And with our signal pre-conditioner for power amplifiers
to be described in a future issue, using a voltage amplifier
becomes very practical.
Minimum load for a voltage amplifier
One requirement when using a voltage amplifier is that the
siliconchip.com.au
Vout
9k
SIGNAL
Vin
1k
Vout
R
R
L
LOAD
(INDUCTION
LOOP)
SIGNAL
Vin
L
LOAD
(INDUCTION
LOOP)
R/10
B CURRENT AMPLIFIER
A VOLTAGE AMPLIFIER
Fig.6 (left): a voltage amplifier driving a hearing aid loop load will produce less current in the loop with rising load
impedance. Fig.7 (right) : a current amplifier driving a hearing aid loop load will maintain current in the loop with
rising loop impedance. More on this subject next month.
loop must be designed to suit its minimum load, typically 4Ω.
Hence, the design is based on the size of the loop and
wire gauge required to provide a 4Ω DC resistance. Once
you have decided on the hearing loop dimensions, you add
up the length of wire sides (almost invariably the “loops”
are rectangular or square) required to make up the loop
(don’t forget the wire between the loop and the amplifier).
Then the gauge of wire to provide a 4Ω load is selected
from Table 1.
But that is not the full story because the wire must be
able to carry the current needed to produce the required
magnetic field strength of 100mA/m (millamps/metre). This
100mA/m field strength is the standard level long term
average signal level. With normal program material, peak
signals can be 12dB higher or up to 400mA/m.
To allow for this we have set a large factor of safety for
the wire current rating by restricting average wire current
to 5A/square mm when the wire could easily accept 8-10A
continuously.
Calculation of the current requirements to produce the
100mA/m field strength (H) at the centre of a square loop
and along the same plane as the loop uses the equation:
Current (A) = L(m)/9n, where L(m) is the length of the
side in metres and n is the number of turns.
For the purposes of loop design, a rectangular loop can
use the same equation with L as the smaller of the rectangle sides.
As an example, when using the equation for a single-turn
9m square loop, a current of 1A is required to produce the
100mA/m field. For a 2-turn loop the current requirement
to produce that same field is halved, to 0.5A.
How much amplifier power?
The amplifier power needed must allow for the signal to
be +12dB over the base signal level, without overload (ie,
clipping). So the required amplifier power requirement will
be (current required for 400mA/m field strength) squared
multiplied by the 4Ω load.
As an example, if the current required is 1A, the power
will only be 4W. If it is 4A, the power required will be 64W.
Listener’s height
Another factor to consider is that the maximum field
strength lies in the same plane as the loop and will be
lower at a distance above (or below) the plane of the loop.
So a design for monitoring signal in the same plane of the
Table 1: Loop wire and current calculator
Wire cross
section area
(mm2)
Wire current
capacity
(based on
5A/mm2)
(A)
Ohms per metre
(Ω/m) (based
on 0.017241Ω
mm2/m at 20°C)
Wire length
required for 4Ω
(For figure-8
wire use half
this length)
Maximum
square loop
size
(two turns)
Current for
100mA/m for
max. loop
size (A)
Current
required for
1.7m above or
below loop
(A)
1 x 0.25mm
1 x 0.315mm
1 x 0.5mm
0.049
0.07793
0.1963
0.245
0.389
0.982
0.351
0.2212
0.0878
5.7m
18m
45m
0.7m square
2.25m square
5.63m square
0.078
0.25
0.63
1.50
1.01
14 x 0.14mm
14 x 0.18mm
14 x 0.20mm
19 x 0.18mm
20 x 0.18mm
24 x 0.20mm
41 x 0.20mm
0.21555
0.3626
0.43982
0.48349
0.50894
0.75398
1.28805
1.077
1.81
2.20
2.42
2.54
3.77
6.44
0.080
0.0484
0.039
0.03566
0.03388
0.02287
0.013387
50m
84m
104m
112m
118m
176m
298m
6.25m square
10.5m square
13m square
14m square
14.75m square
22m square
37.5m square
0.70
1.17
1.44
1.56
1.64
2.44
4.17
1.05
1.40
1.58
1.64
1.71
2.45
4.18
Wire size
When you’ve decided on a loop dimension, use this to read off the nearest wire size and length required to make a 4Ω load.
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 27
1400
Loop current and power multiplier versus height
above loop
1300
That is because the current is directly proportional to field
strength. If the listening height is changed so that more
current is required in the loop to maintain field strength,
then that means that the field strength will be lower at that
height if the current is not increased to compensate.
25
24
1200
23
22
1100
21
20
Height comparison
1000
19
So let’s compare the variation in field strength between
when
a person is standing and when seated. We choose
1 Turn
Current
1.7m as the expected highest listening point above the loop
2 Turns plane noting that hearing aids are at ear level rather than
Power
the height of the person. We choose 0.5m as the lowest
expected listening height above the loop plane. For a 6.8m
loop, a 1.7m height gives a 0.25 height to loop dimension
ratio and the current multiplier is about 1.4. For the 0.5m
height, the ratio against the loop dimension is very close
to 0.1 and the multiplier is very close to 1.
A 1.4 variation in field strength corresponds to a 3dB
change. Taking the log of 1.4 and multiplying by 20 calculates this. So for the 6.8m square loop; if the loop current is
set so the signal strength is correct at the 1.7m height, then
the field strength will increase by 3dB at the 0.5m height
due to the closer proximity to the loop. If the loop field
strength is set for correct level at 0.5m, then the strength
will drop by 3dB at 1.7m in height.
The calculation shows that a 6.8m square loop is the
smallest sized loop that will provide only a 3dB change
in field strength level between the two expected minimum
Height above (or below) loop/shortest side length
and maximum heights above the loop.
Smaller loops will have a wider variation while larger
Fig.8:
extra
current
and
power
are
required
for
height
offsets
1
2
3
5
7 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45
loops will have less variation. If you are after minimal
above or below the loop plane to maintain field strength.
variation in field strength with height changes, use a larger
square loop side dimension (m)
loop. A 10m loop, for example, will show less than 3dB
loop will not deliver that field strength at a higher level variation with a 2m change in listening height.
above the plane.
Note that the extra power requirements for the amplifier
For most hearing loop installations the loop is either are very high when the listening height above or below the
placed just below the floor, at floor level or in the ceiling. loop is significant compared to loop size. For example if
Typically, this means that the listener’s hearing aid is about you are using a 2m loop and are 1m above the loop, the
1.7m above or below the plane of the loop.
0.5 height to loop size ratio shows a loop current requireFig.8 shows a graph of the extra current and power
required for height offsets above or below the loop plane.
To use the graph, divide the distance that the hearing aid
will be above or below the loop plane by the shorter side
length of the loop. So if the loop has a 5m shorter side
and the height is 2m above the loop, the division gives us
0.4. Comparing 0.4 on the graph gives us a multiplier of
FIGURE-8
about 2.1 times more current that must be applied to the
CABLE
loop to maintain the field strength at 2m above (or below)
the loop plane.
While the current needs to be 2.1 times greater, power
requirements must be 4.4 times greater. This is where larger
loops are better in this respect because the height above or
below the loop plane is relatively small compared to the
loop side dimension.
This fact is important to consider because users of the
induction loop are seldom all the same height, nor do they
always remain at the same height. They might stand some
of the time and sit for other times or they could be in a
wheel chair. Ideally the loop should be sized so that the
field strength does not vary by more than 3dB between the
Fig.9: this shows how
lowest and highest listening heights.
to form a 2-turn loop
The graph of Fig.8 can also be used to determine the
using figure-8 wire.
TO
variation in field strength with changes in listening height.
AMPLIFIER
18
900
17
16
800
700
600
15
Multiplier
)
H
m
(
ec
n
tac
u
d
In
r
ie
l
ip
t
l
u
M
14
13
Current
12
Power
11
10
9
500
8
7
400
6
5
300
4
3
200
2
1
100
0
0
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1
Height above (or below) loop
shortest side length
28 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
2-turns 4W
Power requirements versus loop size
2-turns 4W
siliconchip.com.au
)
(W
r
e
) w
o
W
( P
r
e
w
o
P
Power (W)
ment of 2.8 times higher compared to directly along the
loop plane. Power requirements are eight times more. This
also means that a 2m square loop is impractical because
the listener must remain fixed at the one height otherwise
the signal level will vary too much.
When you have decided on a loop dimension, use Table.1
to read off the nearest wire size and length requirement to
make a 4Ω load. You might require extra wire if the amplifier is not located close to the loop. Note that the table
only shows figure-8 wire length. Figure-8 wire comprises
two insulated and parallel running wires and when connected to make a single length of wire will form a 2-turn
loop (see Fig.9).
We show only figure-8 wire in the table because interestingly, a 2-turn loop is the only practical option for an
induction loop that is driven using a voltage amplifier. It
works out that a 2-turn loop that provides a 4Ω load will
have the correct current rating to prevent overheating the
loop wire.
This applies even with the extra current requirement
for loop monitoring at 1.7m above or below the loop. Using a single turn loop requires twice the current for the
100mA/m field strength and is likely to overheat the loop
wire, making it impractical.
Using more than two turns is not recommended because
of loop inductance which increases by the square of the
number of turns. So while two turns produces four times
the inductance of a single turn loop, a four turn loop will
have 16 times the inductance.
Higher inductance means that the amplifier (whether a
current or voltage type) needs to be able to provide much
more voltage drive at higher frequencies. More details about
this inductance effect are provided later.
The table has values of wire resistance calculated based
on copper resistance at 0.017241Ω mm2/m at 20°C. The
cross sectional area is the radius of the wire squared times
pi(). For wire with more than one strand, the area for one
strand is multiplied by the number of strands. The ohms/
metre value was obtained by dividing the total cross sectional area into the 0.017241Ω mm2/m.
Power requirements for a given loop size is calculated
using the required current to produce the 100mA/m field
and multiplying this by four to get the current for the 400mA
peak. For a 2-turn loop, divide this value by two. Overall,
this simplifies to multiplying the current for the 100mA/m
field by two. The value is then squared and multiplied by
the resistance (4Ω) to obtain the power requirement.
Chances are that the loop you are using will not be
exactly one of the loop sizes listed in the table. For an inbetween value loop size, use the next lowest listed loop
size wire gauge. This will mean that the resistance will be
higher than 4Ω due to the extra length for the larger loop.
Amplifier power requirements may need to be higher if the
rated power of the amplifier you are using is close to the
amount of power required.
To simplify calculations, Fig.10 shows amplifier power
requirements for a 2-turn 4Ω loop of various sizes. One
graph shows power required for directly at the loop plane
and the second for 1.7m above (or below) the plane. The
power requirements take into consideration the 400mA/m
field strength produced during signal peaks. As mentioned
if the loop is more than 4Ω, power requirements will need
to be increased by the same ratio. So an 8Ω loop will require
400
390
380
400
370
390
360
380
350
370
340
360
330
350
320
340
310
330
300
320
290
310
280
300
270
290
260
280
250
270
240
260
230
250
220
240
210
230
200
220
190
210
180
200
170
190
160
180
150
170
140
160
130
150
120
140
110
130
100
120
90
110
80
100
70
90
60
80
50
70
40
60
30
50
20
40
10
30
0
20
1
10
0
Loop plane
Loop plane
1.7m above (or be
Loop plane
loop
1.7m above (or belo
1.7m above
loop
(or below)
loop
2
3
5
7
10 15
20 25 30
35 40 45
Square loop side dimensions (m)
Square loop side dimension (m)
2 3 5 power
7 10 requirements
15 20 25 30 when
35 40 driving
45
Fig.10:1 amplifier
a 2-turn
4Ω loop of various sizes. Power is shown for directly along
side1.7m
dimension
(m) (or below) the plane.
the loopSquare
planeloop
and
above
double the power. There is no problem using an amplifier
that has more power than is required.
For a loop of 15m and larger, the power requirements for
along the plane and 1.7m are almost the same. This means
that the field strength in the loop effectively does not vary
over a 1.7m range.
As a consequence any change in listening height above
the plane of the loop will not be subject to variation in signal level. In practice 10m square loops also do not appear
to have any noticeable signal level change with normal
variations in height.
What voltage amplifiers are suitable?
As mentioned, a voltage amplifier for the loop designs
described here needs to be able to drive a 4Ω load and it must
be unconditionally stable. This is important because we do
not want the amplifier oscillating at a very high frequency
and radiating radio frequencies. In addition, the amplifier
would produce lots of distortion if it is prone to oscillation.
While many commercially made amplifiers could be
used, Table 2 shows some of the more recent and suitable amplifiers that SILICON CHIP has published. The table
September 2010 29
Loop Inductance
We mentioned that loop inductance was a concern because it reduces the amount of current that is applied to the
loop as frequency increases. Hence, treble boost is needed.
Australian Standard AS60118.4-2007 recommends that
the frequency response of the magnetic field be 100Hz
to 5kHz within ±3dB. Naturally, the response can cover
a wider range of frequencies. In practice though, having
rolloff above 5kHz is ideal because it removes the need for
excessive treble boost.
We plotted loop inductance versus loop size and this
can be seen in the graph of Fig.12. Inductance of a square,
rectangular or circular loop can be calculated using an
inductance calculator.
We used the calculator at www.technick.net/public/
code/cp_dpage.php?aiocp_dp=util_inductance_calculator
For the purpose of this exercise, inductance calculation
was based on 1mm diameter wire (0.5mm radius). The µ
value for air is 1. Inductance is shown for both a single
turn loop and using figure-8 wire that forms two turns.
Note how the inductance for two turns is four times that
of one turn. The inductance values are based on a square
loop shape. Rectangular loop inductance can be calculated
using the rectangular shape option in the above mentioned
inductance calculator.
Typically, a rectangular loop will have the same inductance as a square loop that has the same wire length. For
example a 10m square loop has the same inductance as a
15 x 5m rectangular loop.
From the inductance we can calculate the 3dB down
rolloff for a 4Ω loop. How this is calculated is described
in the section entitled ‘Inductance of the loop’. A simplified calculation for 4Ω loops is that the -3dB frequency =
0.6366/inductance in Henries. Multiply the -3dB frequency
by two for 8Ω loops.
The graph in Fig.13 shows the –3dB rolloff frequency
against loop side length. The graph reveals that for a 2-turn
loop, the frequency response is no more than 3dB down at
5kHz for square loops up to almost 5m. Larger loops will
require treble boost to compensate for the rolloff.
Actual rolloff against frequency for various sized loops is
shown in the Fig.14 graph. For the 5m square loop, rolloff
is just over 3dB down at 5kHz, but for a 20m square loop
i
R
V
L
Z
XL
R (4 )
12
Fig.11: the total impedance of a series-connected
resistor and inductor is calculated using a phasor
diagram. Impedance of the resistor is R and reactance
of the inductor is XL. Total impedance is Z.
30 Silicon Chip
Inductance (H)
indicates the recommended sized loop that could be used
with each.
The amplifier power requirement for the loop size takes
into account the fact that the loop will be about 1.7m away
from the listening position. See www.jaycar.com.au and
www.altronics.com.au for kits.
390
Inductance versus loop size
380
370
1700 360
350
1600
340
330
1500
320
1400 310
300
1300
290
280
1200
270
1100 260
250
1000 240
)
H
m
(
230
e
c
) 900
n
a
1T
t
220
c
W
Loop plan
(
u
d
r
1 turn
n
I
2T
e 800 210
w
o
200
P
700 190
1.7m abov
2 turns
180
loop
600
170
160
500
150
400 140
130
300
120
110
200
100
100 90
80
0
70
1
2
3
5
7
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
60
square loop
sideloop
dimension
(m)
Square
side
dimensions
(m)
50
40
Fig.12: the
plot of loop inductance versus loop size. The
30
graph shows
inductance for both 1-turn and 2-turn loops.
20
Note how
10 inductance is four times greater in the 2-turn
loop. Typically,
a rectangular loop will have the same
0
inductance1 as2a square
loop
that has the same wire length.
3 5
7 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45
Square loop side dimension (m)
rolloff is –14dB down.
The Hearing Loop amplifier signal pre-conditioner that
we will describe in a later issue has treble boost compensation to correct for these rolloffs.
Note that adding treble boost to an amplifier’s signal input
might appear to mean that extra power will be required
from the amplifier.
However, extra amplifier power is not normally required
because the power requirement for reproducing naturally
occurring sounds becomes less at higher frequencies. Typically, natural sounds have the same energy per octave. And
so while there are four octaves between 100Hz and 1600Hz
there are less than two octaves between 1600Hz and 5kHz.
Treble boost is only applied from about 1600Hz through
to 6kHz.
However for large loops (15m square and over), a fair
degree of treble boost is necessary. In these cases it may
be best to use a slightly higher powered amplifier than one
selected from the design graph and tables, especially if the
power available from the amplifier is only just sufficient
for the size of the loop. It is not practical to compensate for
treble loss for loops larger than 20m square.
Impedance of the loop
A hearing loop generally comprises a wire length in the
shape of a rectangle or square. The impedance of the loop
comprises the resistance of the wire plus the reactance
due to the inductance of the loop. These two components
are effectively in series. The loop resistance will remain
siliconchip.com.au
Loop Frequency Response
(4W, 2 turns)
(4W, 2 turns)
-3dB upper rolloff frequency versus loop size
based on a 4W 2-turn loop
0
20
0
19
-1
-1
18
-2
17
-2
16
-3
-3
-4
-4
-5
-5
-6
-6
15
14
LOOP SIZE
13
Frequency (kHz)
12
)
B
d
(l
e
v
Le
11
10
)
B
-7(d
l
e
v
e
L
-8
Level (dB)
3m square loop
3m square loo
z)
H
k
(
y
c
n
e
u
q
e
rF
3m square
5m square loop
5m square loo
5m square
10 square loop
10 square loop
-7
10m square
15m square15m
loopsquare lo
15m square
-8
9
20m square loop
20m square lo
20m square
-9
8
7
-9
-10
-10
6
-11
-11
5
-12
4
-12
-13
3
-13
2
-14
-14
1
-15
0.25
0
1
2
3
5
7
10
15
length
SideSide
length
(m)
20
25
30
35
40
45
0.5
-15
0.25
1
2
0.5
3
1
4
5
2
3
Frequency (kHz)
6
4
7
5
8
6
9
7
10
8
9
10
Frequ ency (kHz)
(m)
Frequency (kHz)
Fig.13: this shows the –3dB rolloff frequency with various
loop side lengths (4Ω, two turns). Frequency response
varies by no more than 3dB up to 5kHz for loops no larger
than 5m square. Larger loops will require treble boost to
compensate for the rolloff before 5kHz.
Fig.14: frequency response for various sized loops (4Ω, two
turns). For a 5m square loop, rolloff is just over 3dB down
at 5kHz but for a 20m square loop rolloff is –14dB down.
Typically, a rectangular loop will have the same response
and –3dB rolloff as a square loop with the same wire length.
reasonably constant although it will vary with temperature.
The main variation in the loop will be due to the reactance
that rises with frequency.
A pure resistance without inductance has a current that
is in phase with the voltage. For a pure inductor, which
has no resistance, the current lags the voltage by 90°. Its
reactance is 2 x x the frequency x the inductance (L). To
find the total impedance effect of both the resistance and
the reactance of the inductor we need to consider the two
quantities as shown in the phasor diagram of Fig.11.
Resistance is shown as R and the reactance (XL) is 90°
difference in phase. To add the two values we square both
the R value and the XL value, add the two squared values
and then take the square root. This gives the value of the
(Z) impedance. Mathematically, this is just using Pythagoras’ theorem to calculate the length of the hypotenuse in
a right-angled triangle.
Assuming the resistance R is 4Ω, at low frequencies the
impedance of the inductor is low and so the overall impedance is close to 4Ω. As frequency rises, the impedance
of the inductor rises and begins to have a greater effect on
the overall impedance of the loop.
Table 2: SILICON CHIP Amplifier Data
Power into 4Ω
Loop size
Amplifier Name
Silicon Chip publication date
Kit supplier No.
20W
3-8m square
Compact High Performance
12V Stereo Amplifier
May 2010
Jaycar KC5495,
Altronics K5136
30W
2.5-11m square
Schoolies Amplifier
December 2004
Altronics K5116
55W
2-16m square
50W Audio Amplifier Module
March 1994
Jaycar KC5150,
Altronics K5114
70W
2-18m square
SC480
January 2003
Altronics K5120
200W
1.5-33m square
Ultra-LD Mk2
August 2008
Jaycar KC5470,
Altronics K5151
350W
Up to 42m square
Studio 350 Power Amplifier
January 2004
Jaycar KC5372
This shows some of the more recent and suitable loop driving amplifiers published in SILICON CHIP, ranging from 20W
through to 350W. The table also shows the recommended size of loop that could be used with each.
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 31
The rising impedance has an effect on the current flow
within the loop. So if an amplifier is fed with a constant
voltage level, the current will reduce as frequency rises as
the impedance increases. The loop current is the voltage
divided by the impedance.
At low frequencies, the reactance XL is close to zero and
so the 4Ω resistance mainly sets loop current. As the frequency rises, the reactance increases, the total impedance
rises and so current drops. The –3dB down frequency is
when the resistance R is equal to the reactance XL. Then
the current is 0.7071 of the DC current.
As an example (and using simple numbers) lets say R
is 1Ω and voltage is 1VAC. Current I at a low frequency
is 1A. When the AC frequency is higher the reactance of
the inductor will be 1Ω at a specific frequency depending
on the inductance. The impedance Z becomes the square
root of 2 or 1.414Ω. So the current is 1/1.414 or 0.7071 in
value. This reduction to 0.7071A compared to the original
1A is the –3dB level.
A hearing loop does not use radio!
A common misconception with hearing loops is that they
operate using radio waves. In other words, it is assumed
that the loop acts as a radio antenna and the hearing aid
includes a wireless receiver for reception. This is not true.
The magnetic field from the loop is simply modulated at
the audio signal frequency at up to around 5kHz.
While the magnetic field produced by the loop is a part
of the electromagnetic spectrum its properties are unlike
radio waves: for example, the wavelength at 3kHz is so
long at around 100km compared to radio waves that start
at around 300m.
In the same way, the electromagnetic fields produced
by 50Hz power lines are not considered to be radio waves.
Other examples of waves that are also part of the electromagnetic field spectrum include Infrared radiation (heat),
visible light, ultra-violet light (UV) and X-rays. These too
are not considered radio.
Health effects using a hearing loop?
While it is certain that some electromagnetic fields can
cause detrimental health effects (eg, UV and X rays), it is
unclear whether the low frequency and low level magnetic field from a hearing aid will have any detrimental
effect. Most research concerning the effects on cells with
electromagnetic radiation is concentrated on 50Hz power
transmission along with the higher frequencies such as
microwaves, X rays, ultra-violet radiation etc.
Mobile phones come under the microwave category
and operate at around 3GHz. The microwave energy from
a mobile phone is vastly higher than that from a hearing
loop and its frequency is at least 1 million times greater
and with much higher energy.
There is no correlation between the effects of microwave
energy causing cell damage in the body and any effects
caused by hearing loops.
If we consider the 50Hz power line frequency as being
the closest studied radiation compared to the hearing loop,
the recommended maximum continuous exposure to magnetic field is 0.1mT (milliTesla). This data was obtained
from the Australian Radiation Protection and Nuclear
Safety Agency. (www.arpansa.gov.au/radiationprotection/
facsheets/is_emf.cfm).
The recommended magnetic field strength in audiofrequency induction loops for hearing aid purposes is
100mA/m at 1kHz rising to 400mA/m during peaks, which
equates to 0.126µT and 0.5µT respectively – more than
1000 times less than the 0.1mT level.
Magnetic field strength
For the hearing loop specifications, magnetic field
strength is expressed using the units of A/m or amperes
per meter. The letter H is used to label this field. The field
represents the total amount of field strength provided by
the loop.
Another way of expressing a magnetic field is with the
letter B, which is the magnetic field density and describes
how the field is concentrated due to the medium within the
field. Its units are in Tesla (T). The field medium can be free
space (usually air) or it can be other material such as iron
or ferrite. These latter mediums distort the magnetic field
with higher concentrations found within the iron or ferrite.
Where a hearing loop is installed and there is significant
steel in the field, then available field strength in the free
space (air) will be reduced because the field will
be concentrated through the steel. The hearing
loop needs to be driven with more power to
counteract the loss within the steel.
The B field strength values and the H magnetic field density values are easily converted
from one to the other using the equation B=µH.
B is the magnetic flux density (T) and µ is the
permeability of the magnetic field medium. This
is 4 x x 10-7 for air and free space.
For a hearing loop, the 100mA/m field
strength produces a field density of 0.126µT.
The 400mA/m level is 0.5µT.
By the way, if you prefer to use Gauss (G) units
instead of Tesla, the conversion is 0.1µT=1mG.
So 0.126µT is 1.26mG.
Next month
An under-floor hearing loop installation. Unfortunately, under-floor
access is rarely this good. Special considerations also apply if the floor is
steel-reinforced concrete; indeed under-floor loops may not be possible.
32 Silicon Chip
We’ll continue our look at Hearing Loops,
examining at some of the commercial equipment available.
SC
siliconchip.com.au
Ultrasonic
anti-fouling
for boats
Build it & keep
at bay
Marine growth on the hull is the bane of all boat owners. Left
unchecked, marine growth slows the boat down considerably
and if it’s a power boat, leads to large increases in fuel
consumption. If it’s a yacht, marine growth will also slow it
down and make it less manoeuvrable, to the point where it
becomes very sluggish. The cure is to haul the boat out of the
water every year and water-blast and scrape away all the
growth and then coat the hull in toxic anti-fouling paint.
Pt.1: By LEO SIMPSON & JOHN CLARKE
E
VERYONE KNOWS that owning
and maintaining a boat is expensive; the bigger the boat, the more
expensive it is.
Many readers will be familiar with
trailer sail-boats and power boats.
These are relatively cheap to run and
since they are not left in the water, they
should never have problems with marine growth. However, once you have
a boat on a swing mooring or tied up
to a berth in salt water, marine growth
is endemic and the warmer the water,
the more severe the problem.
The vast majority of larger boats
in Australia and New Zealand are
moored in warm, salty waters and so
marine growth is a big problem. In
years past, the solution was to coat the
34 Silicon Chip
hull in an arsenic-based anti-fouling
compound but these were highly toxic
to all marine life and have now been
banned. This means that the antifouling compounds used now, while
still toxic to marine growth, are far
less effective.
The problem is even more severe for
boats that are moored in canal developments. There, because the water is
much warmer and there is little water
movement, marine growth can be so
rapid that anti-fouling needs to done
as often as every six months.
If a boat is not being used, marine
growth can still rapidly take hold and
there can be significant growth after
only a few months. This is because
anti-fouling coatings are “ablative”
which means that they depend for
their operation on the boat moving
through the water to literally wear off
the surface and thereby expose fresh
(and toxic) anti-fouling compound.
So anti-fouling needs to be done at
least once a year and in some cases,
more frequently if the boat is seldom
used or moored in a canal. If you do
this work on your own boat, it is tedious, dirty and expensive (even hauling
the boat out of water is expensive). If
you pay someone else to do it, it is
much more expensive. All boat owners
would love to avoid this cost.
Now there is ultrasonic anti-fouling
for boats. This electronic method
means the end of chemical anti-fouling
and a big reduction in cost for boat
siliconchip.com.au
the barnacles
electronically
The driver circuit is housed in an IP65 ABS box with a clear lid. It produces the
high-voltage pulsed waveform that’s used to drive the ultrasonic transducer.
owners. It involves installing a high
power piezoelectric transducer inside
the boat’s hull and then ultrasonic
energy keeps marine growth at bay.
How it works
The way that this works is that
the ultrasonic vibration of the hull
disrupts the cell structure of algae
and this stops algal growth adhering
to the hull. And because there is no
algal food source on the hull, larger
marine organisms have no reason to
attach themselves to the hull – no
food, no lodgers.
The principles of ultrasonic antifouling have been known for a long
time. The effect was discovered 80
years ago by French scientist Paul Lansiliconchip.com.au
gevin who was developing sonar for
submarines. By accident, he found that
ultrasonic energy killed algae. He was
working with high power transducers
and it was assumed that cavitation was
causing algal death. In recent times
though, it has been found that high
ultrasonic power and cavitation is not
required to kill algae.
Instead, it has been found that ultrasonic frequencies can cause resonance
effects within algal cell structures and
relatively low powers are still enough
to cause cell death. So if the boat’s
hull can be vibrated over a range of
ultrasonic frequencies, algae will not
be able to attach to it and other marine
growth will similarly be discouraged.
Commercial ultrasonic anti-fouling
systems have been available for the
last few years but they are very expensive, costing thousands of dollars
to install. There is still a cost benefit
though and these systems are gradually becoming more popular as news
of their effectiveness grows. However,
we should state at the outset that the
manufacturers do not make blanket
guarantees that ultrasonic anti-fouling
systems work in every situation. We
WARNING!
This circuit produces an output
voltage of up to 800V peak-peak
to drive the ultrasonic transducer
and is capable of delivering a
severe (or even fatal) electric
shock. DO NOT touch the output
terminals at CON2, the PC tracks
leading to CON2 or the transducer
terminals when power is applied.
To ensure safety, the PC board
must be housed in the recommended plastic case, while the
transducer must be correctly
housed and fully encapsulated in
resin as described in Pt.2.
can understand that.
It’s this lack of a blanket guarantee
that’s probably holding back market
acceptance. Most boat owners will be
very cautious about investing several
thousand dollars in a system that may
not work in their case. That is where
the SILICON CHIP design will be a gamechanger. It will cost a fraction of the
price of equivalent commercial sysSeptember 2010 35
Specifications
Overall output frequency range: from 19.08kHz to 41.66kHz in 14 bands;
frequency overlapping included between each band
Frequency sweep in each band: 12 frequencies ranging from approximately
80Hz steps at 20kHz to 344Hz steps at 40kHz
Signal burst period: 600ms at 20kHz, 300ms at 40kHz (1000 cycles/ burst)
Pause between each band: 500ms
Dead-time for push-pull driver: 5µs
Output drive: 250VAC (up to 800V peak-peak)
Low voltage threshold: 11.5V (switch-on voltage = 12V)
Supply Voltage: 11.5 - 16V maximum
Current drain: 220mA average at 12V driving a 3.6nF load
Peak current at transducer resonance: 3A
Quiescent current below 11.5V: 6.7mA
tems yet should have the same effects.
Our system works along the same
lines as commercial systems. It uses
a high-power piezoelectric transducer
which is attached inside the hull. It is
driven with bursts of ultrasonic signal
ranging between about 20kHz and
40kHz. The reason for using a range of
frequencies is two-fold. First, we want
to drive the transducer over a range of
frequencies so that various resonance
modes of the hull are excited. Second,
this range of frequencies is required to
kill the various types of algae.
While a high-power transducer is
used and we do drive it with very high
voltages, the actual power used is not
very great so that the typical current
consumption from a 12V battery is
around 220mA (3A peak).
Since the ultrasonic anti-fouling
system should ideally run continuously, the 12V battery will need to
be permanently on charge. This is no
problem for boats in berths which have
shore power (ie, 230VAC mains). For
boats on swing moorings, a solar panel
and battery charge controller will be
required. We will describe a suitable
system in a future issue.
So let’s have a look at the SILICON
CHIP ultrasonic anti-fouling driver.
This is housed in a compact sealed
plastic IP65 case with a transparent
lid. There are two cable glands on
one side of the case for the power
supply cable and for the cable to the
piezoelectric transducer which is
itself encapsulated in a high-pressure
plumbing fitting.
The driver module is based on a
PIC12F675-I/P microcontroller, two
power Mosfets and a step-up transformer. It can be powered from a 12V
battery or a 12V 3A (or greater) power
supply, if shore power is available.
Ultrasonic bursts
The large ultrasonic transducer is
driven with high-frequency signal
bursts ranging from 19.08kHz up
to 41.66kHz.
36 Silicon Chip
In more detail, the piezoelectric
transducer is driven with bursts of
high-frequency signal ranging from
19.08kHz through to 41.66kHz. This
is done over 14 bands with each band
sweeping over a small frequency
range.
The first band is from 19.08kHz to
20.0kHz and comprises 12 frequencies
with approximate 83Hz steps between
each frequency. The other bands also
have 12 frequencies but with larger
frequency steps. For the middle band
at 24.75kHz to 26.31kHz, the steps
are about 141Hz. For the top band
between 37.87kHz and 41.66kHz, the
steps are 344Hz.
Each band overlaps the following
band by a few hundred Hertz. This
overlap ensures that the whole range of
frequencies is covered from 19.08kHz
to 41.66kHz.
Each burst of signal comprises two
separate frequency bands each of 500
cycles. The burst period for the total
1000 cycles depends on the actual
frequency bands that are in the burst
– from 300-600ms. There is a 500ms
no-signal gap between each burst.
The two frequency bands for each
burst are varied in a pseudo-random
way so that the entire range of frequencies is covered within 16s. This
sequence is repeated after about 64s.
Note that there is a concentration of
signal about the resonant frequency of
the transducer between 35.21kHz and
41.66kHz.
Circuit description
Now let’s have a look at the circuit
of Fig.1. The PIC microcontroller IC2
drives step-up transformer T1 via two
Mosfets, Q1 & Q2. In addition, the microcontroller provides a low-voltage
shutdown to prevent the battery from
discharging below 11.5V.
The microcontroller runs at 20MHz
(as set by crystal X1) and this allows
it to provide the small ultrasonic frequency shifts listed above.
Pins 6 & 7 of IC2 drive Mosfets Q1 &
Q2 which in turn drive transformer T1.
Since these outputs only swing from
0V to +5V we have specified logic-level
Mosfets, type RFP30N06LE. Their
“on”resistance (between the drain and
source) is a mere 75mΩ for a gate voltage of 3V and it drops even lower to
around 23mΩ at a gate voltage of 4.5V.
Their current rating is 30A continuous.
Mosfets Q1 and Q2 are driven alternately and in turn drive separate
halves of the transformer primary
winding. The centre tap of the primary
is connected to the +12V supply rail.
When Q1 is switched on, current
flows through its section of the primary
winding for less than 50µs, depending on the frequency, after which Q1
is switched off. After 5µs, Q2 is then
switched on for less than 50µs. Then,
when Q2 switches off, there is another
gap of about 5µs before Q1 is switched
on again and so on.
The 5µs period during which both
Mosfets are off is “dead time” and it
allows one Mosfet to fully switch off
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
A
D
D
G
LED
K
SC
2010
4
A
TP0
5
2
CON1
0V
ZD1, ZD2
4.7k
10nF
IC1
TL499A
100 µF
16V
+12V
ULTRASONIC ANTI-FOULING DRIVER
K
A
10k
D1,D2: 1N5819
D3: 1N4004
10 µF
16V
22pF
22pF
VR1
20k
20k
8
1
A
K
8
Vss
AN2
5
3
X1 20MHz
2
IN
OUT
Vdd
IC2
PIC12F675I/P
GP0
MCLR
6
GP1
7
D2
4
1
100Ω
K
S
RFP30N06LE
10Ω
ZD2
5.1V
1W
K
A
K
ZD1
5.1V
1W
10Ω
A
A
K
K
1k
100nF
100 µF
16V
TP1
D3
A
S1
POWER
Fig.1: the circuit uses PIC microcontroller IC2 to drive step-up transformer T1 in push-pull fashion via Mosfets Q1 & Q2. IC1 is a switchmode controller
IC and is used to provide the +5V supply rail for IC2, while ZD1 & ZD2 provide overvoltage protection for the gates of the Mosfets.
WARNING
Q2
RFP30N06LE
G
S
D
The output of this circuit operates at
high voltage (up to 800V p-p). Avoid
contact with the output terminals
(CON2) and the transducer terminals
otherwise you could receive a fatal
electric shock. The transducer must be
fully encapsulated to ensure safety.
F3
S2
S1
F2
FTD29 FERRITE
TRANSFORMER
S3
T1
F1
Q1
RFP30NS 06LE
D
G
4.7k
D1
K
+5V
Battery voltage monitoring
The incoming 12V supply is monitored via a voltage divider consisting
of 10kΩ and 20kΩ resistors and the
resulting voltage is filtered and monitored by IC2 at pin 5, the AN2 input.
IC2 converts this voltage into a digital
value and this is compared against a
reference value in the software. With
an 11.5V supply, the voltage at pin 5 is
3.83V and below this threshold voltage
IC2 cuts off the drive for Mosfets Q1
& Q2. This prevents over-discharge of
the boat battery.
Once IC2 is in low-voltage shutdown mode, the supply voltage needs
to rise to 12V before the Mosfet drive
is resumed. This 0.5V hysteresis prevents the shutdown switching being
on and off repetitively at the 11.5V
threshold.
The 5V supply rail for IC2 is provided by a TL499A regulator, IC1. This is
a low quiescent current regulator that
can run in linear stepdown or switchmode step-up modes. We are using it
in linear stepdown mode. Its output
voltage is trimmed to exactly 5V using trimpot VR1. This is done to set
the low-voltage shutdown threshold.
CON2
TO
ULTRASONIC
TRANSDUCER
2200 µF
25V
LOW ESR
RUNNING
λ LED1
A
F1 3A
before the other is switched on.
The alternate switching of the Mosfets generates an AC square-wave in
the primary and this is stepped up
in the secondary winding to provide
a voltage of about 250VAC, depending on the particular frequency being
switched and the resonance of the
piezoelectric transducer load.
Mosfets Q1 & Q2 include over-voltage protection to clamp drain voltages
which exceed 60V. This clamping is
required since a high-voltage transient
is generated each time the Mosfets
switch off.
Protection for the gates of the Mos
fets is provided using 5.1V zener
diodes ZD1 & ZD2. This might seem
unnecessary since the Mosfets are only
driven from a 5V signal but the high
transient voltages at the drains can be
coupled into the gate via capacitance.
These 5.1V zener diodes also help
prevent damage to the GP0 and GP1
outputs of IC2.
Further protection is provided for
the GP0 and GP1 outputs of IC2 using Schottky diodes D1 & D2. These
clamp the voltages at these pins to
about +5.3V. They are in parallel with
the internal protection diodes at GP0
and GP1.
September 2010 37
VR1 10k
100nF
TP0
100 F
TP1
2200 F
25V
LOW ESR
5V1
S3
5819
D2
5819
D1
F3
DANGER!
HIGH
VOLTAGE
F1
10190140
X1
10 F
22pF
10k
22pF
CON2
S2
5V1
10
IC2
12F675
1k
20k
LED1
T1
S1
F2
ZD1 Q1
+ –
12V
DC
A
4.7k
ZD2 Q2
10
LK1
100 F
+12V 0V
–
IC1
TL499A
100
4004
S1
4.7k
D3
10nF
CON1
+
F1
E GATL OV H GI H !RE G NAD
TO
SWITCH
S1
TO
ULTRASONIC
TRANSDUCER
REVIRD CI N OSARTLU
NOTE: 100 F CAPACITORS = LOW ESR
Fig.2: install the parts on the PC board as shown in this layout diagram and the photo. Be sure to use a socket for
the PIC microcontroller (IC2) but do not install this IC until after the setting-up adjustment has been completed.
The circuit includes reverse polarity
protection. IC1 is protected by diode
D3 and in turn protects IC2. The Mosfets are protected via their substrate
diodes and fuse F1. If the supply is
reversed, the diodes conduct via the
transformer’s primary until the fuse
blows. Before that happens, the supply is effectively clamped at around
-1V and thereby protects the 2200µF
electrolytic capacitor from excessive
reverse voltage.
The fuse prevents the PC board
tracks from fusing should the transformer be wound incorrectly or if one
of the Mosfets fails as a short circuit.
Assembly details
The Ultrasonic Driver is constructed
on a PC board coded 04109101 and
measuring 104 x 78mm. It has corner
cutouts to allow it to be mounted in an
IP65 ABS box with a clear lid, measuring 115 x 90 x 55mm.
Begin by checking the PC board for
breaks in the tracks or shorts between
them. Check also that the hole sizes
are correct for each component to fit
neatly. The screw terminal holes and
transformer pin holes are 1.25mm,
while larger holes again are used for
the fuse clips.
Assembly can begin by installing the
resistors and PC stakes. Table 1 shows
the resistor colour codes but you
should also check each resistor using
a DMM. The PC stakes are installed at
TP0 & TP1 and at the external wiring
points for switch S1.
Follow these with the diodes which
must be orientated as shown. Note that
there are three different diode types:
1N5819s (Schottky) for D1 and D2,
1N4004 for D3 and 5.1V zener diodes
for ZD1 & ZD2.
IC2 is mounted on a DIP8 socket so
install this socket now, taking care to
orientate it correctly. Leave IC2 out for
the time being though. IC1 can also be
socket mounted or it can be directly
Table 1: Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
No.
1
1
2
1
1
2
38 Silicon Chip
Value
20kΩ
10kΩ
4.7kΩ
1kΩ
100Ω
10Ω
4-Band Code (1%)
red black orange brown
brown black orange brown
yellow violet red brown
brown black red brown
brown black brown brown
brown black black brown
soldered into place. Again ensure the
orientation is correct.
Crystal X1 and the two 2-way screw
terminal blocks can be installed next.
Make sure the screw terminals are
oriented with the opening toward the
outside edge of the PC board. Q1 and
Q2 can then be mounted so that their
tabs are 25mm above the PC board.
Their metal tabs face transformer T1.
LED1 is mounted with its top 30mm
above the PC board (its anode has the
longer lead). The capacitors can then
go in, followed by trimpot VR1. Make
sure that the electrolytic capacitors are
oriented correctly.
Transformer details
Fig.3 shows the transformer wind-
Table 2: Capacitor Codes
Value
100nF
10nF
22pF
µF Value
0.1µF
0.01µF
NA
IEC Code EIA Code
100n
104
10n
103
22p
22
5-Band Code (1%)
red black black red brown
brown black black red brown
yellow violet black brown brown
brown black black brown brown
brown black black black brown
brown black black gold brown
siliconchip.com.au
1
FIRST WIND THE SECONDARY,
USING 0.25mm ENAMELLED
COPPER WIRE: TWO 45-TURN
LAYERS, STARTING FROM PIN 4
AND ENDING AT PIN 3.
PLACE ONE LAYER OF PLASTIC
INSULATING TAPE OVER
EACH LAYER.
6
45 TURNS
5
45 TURNS
4 S3
7
8
9
10
3 F3
11
2
12
1
13
ETD29 FORMER
UNDERSIDE (PIN SIDE) VIEW
4 TURNS
6
2
THEN WIND THE PRIMARY,
USING 14 x 0.20mm FIGURE-8
CABLE IN TWO LAYERS EACH OF
4 TURNS. TERMINATE THE START
WIRES AT PINS 7 & 10 AND THE
FINISH WIRES AT PINS 7 & 12.
NOTE THE STRIPE WIRE
TERMINATIONS.
4 TURNS
S1, 7
F2
5
8
4 S3
9
S2 10
3 F3
11
2
F1 12
1
13
Fig.3: winding the transformer. The secondary is wound
using 0.25mm enamelled copper wire, while the primary
is wound using the specified figure-8 cable – see text.
ing details. The primary winding uses
eight turns of figure-8 14 x 0.20mm
wire, wound in two layers, to give
a bifilar winding. The secondary
uses 0.25mm enamelled copper wire
wound in two layers of 45 turns each,
with insulation tape between the two
layers.
While this may seem confusing, the
secondary winding is done first. To do
this, first strip the enamel from one
end of the 0.25mm enamelled copper
wire using some fine emery paper or a
hobby knife to scrape it off. Pre-tin the
wire end and wrap it around pin 4 on
the underside of the transformer bobbin and solder it close to the bobbin.
Now wind on 45 turns side-by-side
to make the first layer. The direction
of winding (whether clockwise or anticlockwise) doesn’t matter. Cover this
winding layer with a single layer of
plastic insulation tape. Now continue
winding in the same direction back
across the insulation tape to complete
90 turns. Terminate the wire onto
terminal 3, then cover the secondary
winding in a layer of insulation tape.
The primary winding, made from
the figure-8 cable, is first stripped of
10mm of insulation at one end and the
two wires are soldered to the bobbin
at pins 7 & 10, with the grey polarity
stripe to pin 7. Now wind on four turns
making sure the wire lies flat without
twists, so that the striped wire stays to
the left. The four turns should fully fill
siliconchip.com.au
the bobbin and the next four turns will
be on the next layer (there’s no need
for insulation tape between them).
Terminate the striped wire end onto
pin 12 and the other wire to pin 7.
Once wound, slide the cores into
the former and secure with the clips.
These clips push onto the core ends
and clip into lugs on the side of the
bobbin.
The transformer can now be installed on the PC board. Note that
its primary side has seven pins
and the secondary side has six
pins, so it can only go in one way.
That completes the PC board assembly.
The front panel label can now be
downloaded from our website as a PDF
file. You can print it out onto paper
or clear overhead projector film. That
done, mark out and drill the hole in
the lid of the case for switch S1.
When mounting the switch, make
sure that it is firmly seated in the clear
lid. If it tends to pop out of place, you
will need to use some silicone sealant
to ensure it is firmly anchored (and
waterproof).
The label is mounted inside the lid
so it is protected. It can be attached to
the lid with clear tape or clear silicone
sealant. The hole for switch S1 is cut
out of the panel label using a sharp
hobby knife.
Two holes are required in one side
of the box for the power lead cable
gland and for the cable to the ultra-
Parts List
1 PC board, code 04109101,
104 x 78mm
1 IP65 ABS box with clear lid,
115 x 90 x 55mm (Jaycar
HB6246 or equivalent)
1 ETD29 transformer with 2 x
3C85 cores, a 13-pin former &
2 retaining clips (T1)
1 IP65 10A push-on/push-off
switch (S1) (Jaycar SP-0758)
1 300mm length of 14 x 0.20mm
figure-8 wire
1 3m length of 0.25mm enamelled copper wire
1 100mm length medium-duty
hookup wire
1 3A M205 fuse
2 M205 PC fuse clips
2 2-way screw terminals with
5mm or 5.08mm pin spacing
1 DIP8 socket
2 IP65 6.5mm cable glands
1 20MHz crystal (X1)
1 20kΩ horizontal trimpot (Code
203) (VR1)
4 PC stakes
4 M3 x 6mm screws
2 6.4mm female spade lugs
1 20mm length 3mm-diameter
heatshrink
Semiconductors
1 TL499A switchmode controller
(IC1)
1 PIC12F675-I/P programmed
with 0410910A (IC1)
2 RFP30N06LE Mosfets (Q1,Q2)
2 1N4733 5.1V 1W zener diodes
(ZD1,ZD2)
2 1N5819 1A Schottky diodes
(D1,D2)
1 1N4004 1A diode (D3)
1 3mm LED (LED1)
Capacitors
1 2200µF 25V low ESR electrolytic
2 100µF 16V low ESR electrolytic
1 10µF 16V electrolytic
1 100nF MKT polyester
1 10nF MKT polyester
2 22pF ceramic
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
1 20kΩ
1 1kΩ
1 10kΩ
1 100Ω
2 4.7kΩ
2 10Ω
sonic transducer. These cable gland
holes are located 27mm up from the
bottom of the case and are positioned
September 2010 39
Fig.4: the yellow and the green waveforms in each of these scope grabs show the alternate gate signals for Mosfets Q1 &
Q2, while the lower (blue) trace shows the resulting high-voltage waveform in the secondary of the transformer. Four
scope grabs are shown here to show the range of frequencies covered and these are varied in a pseudo-random sequence.
This view shows the driver board
mounted inside the case. Do not
apply power to the completed
unit unless the transducer (which
must be fully encapsulated) is
connected – see text.
40 Silicon Chip
as shown in the photos. They are both 12mm
in diameter.
Adjustment
Before going further, remove fuse F1 and
check that IC2 has NOT been fitted to its
socket. This ensures that no high voltages
appear at the output during adjustment.
That done, secure the board in the case using four M3 x 6mm machine screws into the
integral supports, then connect a DMM set
to read DC volts between TP1 & TP0. Apply
power and adjust VR1 for a reading of 5V.
Now disconnect the power and install IC2
and the fuse. Once this has been done, do not
apply power again unless the transducer is
connected and then only after the latter has
been fully encapsulated – see warning panel.
Next month, we will describe how to encapsulate the piezoelectric transducer in a standard high-pressure 50mm male adaptor. We
will also show you how to install the finished
transducer assembly and driver module in
SC
the hull of a fibreglass cruiser.
siliconchip.com.au
PRODUCT SHOWCASE
Electrical installation & socket outlet tester
The Metrel InstalTest
Combi MI-3125 multifunction installation tester
from Emona Instruments
provides all of the functions normally found on
multi-function installation
testers such as insulation
resistance, continuity, RCD
test, fault loop impedance,
phase rotation, voltage and
frequency measurement.
In addition, it offers a
unique “Socket Outlet Test”,
which allows users to quickly and easily test the electrical safety of a socket outlet.
It eliminates the need for
a trailing lead connection from the PE terminal
on the socket outlet to the PE bar in the switchboard for the earth resistance test, conducts
the 3 polarity tests between active, neutral
and earth between the socket outlet and the
switchboard and indicates a Pass/Fail test
result. It tests the active-earth, neutral-earth,
active-neutral connections and compares the
results to the 10Ω, 5Ω and 150Ω values from
the connected Resistor Box.
It also allows users
to set Pass/Fail limits,
offering a quick and
simple way to carry
out compliance testing
across any electrical
installation, from insulation resistance and
RCD testing through to
fault loop impedance.
The MI-3125 offers
electrical contractors a
next generation installation testing tool that
will guarantee faster
faultfinding and provide
more accountability,
when compliance testing new circuits and installations according
to state electricity safety regulations and AS/
NZS3000 Wiring Rules.
Contact:
Emona Instruments
PO Box 15 Camperdown NSW 1450
Tel: (02) 9519 3933 Fax: (02) 9550 1378
Website: www.emona.com.au
XY mode
for
Screenscope
Screenscope now supports XY mode
function, where channel 1 is plotted
against channel 2.
The drawing is done at the hardware
level with dot joining to give fast real-time
performance. Unlike on an analog scope
the other channels can also be displayed
at the same time, allowing easier setting
up and triggering for best displayed
waveform.
The screenshot above shows the trace
doing several circuits of a rotating Lissajous figure from the comparison of two
sine waves. XY mode is also useful for
parametric measurements and studying
dynamical systems.
Screenscope’s measurement markers can also be used on the XY trace to
directly read the voltage values at any
point in both X and Y directions.
XY mode is available to existing users
as a flash download. Visit www.screenscopetraces.com
This month’s “Electronex” expo headed for a sellout
– and SILICON CHIP will be there!*
“Electronex” – The Electronics Design and Assembly Expo –
being held this month at Australian Technology Park in Sydney
has been welcomed by electronics suppliers, excited about the
opportunity to have their own dedicated trade event in Australia.
Electronex is organised by Australasian Exhibitions and Events
(AEE) in association with The Surface Mount and Circuit Board
Association (SMCBA) and will include a dedicated industry trade
show and technical conference.
The expo features all the market leaders and will provide visitors with an opportunity to see all the major companies together
at the one show. Many of the exhibitors will be showcasing new
releases and new technology that has not been seen before and
will provide trade visitors with an excellent opportunity to keep up
to date with the latest products and innovations.
Electronics Engineers and decision makers throughout Australia,
New Zealand and SE Asia are invited to attend and will be able to
see an extensive range of products and services as well as seek
advice and find solutions for their specific needs and applications.
The expo will cover all aspects of electronics assembly, design,
test, measurement and repair for OEMs, PCB assemblers, aviation & defence, R&D, scientific & medical, education, contract
manufacturing and service & repair.
Australian Technology Park is ideally located only 5 minutes
siliconchip.com.au
south of the Sydney CBD and 15
minutes from the
Airport. There is ample parking on site for visitors and there is a
wide selection of accommodation close-by for visitors.
The venue also encourages exhibitors and visitors to network
in a more relaxed environment and to spend more time with oneon-one discussions as often at large general shows visitors are
in a hurry to get through the entire event and do not get to spend
quality time with exhibitors.
Running concurrently with the industry trade show will be the
“Surface Mount 2010 Conference” for electronics design and
manufacture.
The show will be open from 10am-6pm on Wednesday 8
September and 9am-6pm on Thursday 9 September. Visitors can
pre-register at the expo website www.electronex.com.au
Enquiries about the Electronex exhibition should be directed
to AEE on (03) 9676 2133; email info<at>auexhibitions.com.au
and enquiries regarding the Surface Mount 2010 Conference
should be directed to Andrew Pollock on (03) 9568 0599; or email
pollocka<at>smcba.asn.au
* Call in and say “Hi” to SILICON CHIP on stand A28.
SC
September 2010 41
High-performance
microphone preamplifier
Some recording devices, especially computer sound cards, have
poor sound quality or insufficient gain when used with certain
microphones. This tiny module provides a line level output from
an unbalanced or balanced microphone and has very low noise
and distortion. It runs off 5-20V DC, consuming just 6mA.
By NICHOLAS VINEN
T
HE REASON THAT a microphone preamplifier is necessary
is that most microphones, especially
unpowered types, have a low output
signal level. A typical microphone
will deliver 10-200mV RMS at maximum volume. Audio “line level” is
around 775mV RMS (0dBu) or higher
but a great deal of audio equipment
can actually handle 1V RMS or more.
Higher signal levels usually mean
more dynamic range.
So to interface a microphone to a
mixer, computer sound card, amplifier
etc, we need to insert a preamplifier
in-between to boost the signal level.
Otherwise it may be impossible to get
enough volume.
Some such devices contain internal
amplifiers but they don’t always perform well. Their internal microphone
preamplifiers can be noisy and may not
42 Silicon Chip
provide enough gain for some microphones (ie, those with very low output
levels). Many, if not most, computer
sound cards do not use high-quality
analog components.
Adding a microphone preamplifier
does not guarantee good results, as the
line level circuitry can still introduce
noise and distortion but it certainly
improves your chances of getting acceptable sound quality. On the other
hand, a preamplifier is a necessity for
connecting a microphone to any gear
which only has line level inputs.
Performance
As can be seen from the specifications and graphs, this preamplifier
has very good performance despite
its low supply requirements. Signals
below 50mV RMS will result in worse
performance while higher level signals
will provide better performance. For a
25mV RMS input, the signal-to-noise
ratio will be reduced by 6dB, for
12.5mV by 12dB and so on. With a
100mV RMS input, the S/N ratio goes
up to 94dB and THD+N improves to
below 0.002%.
The performance doesn’t vary with
signal frequency. The frequency response is very flat with -3dB points at
around 1Hz and 1MHz (see Fig.1). The
total harmonic distortion plus noise
(THD+N) level is the same across the
audible band (see Fig.2) and at typical
microphone levels consists mostly of
noise.
Under our test conditions with
50mV RMS input and 775mV RMS
output, harmonic distortion accounts
for just 12% of the total distortion
measurement and is primarily second
harmonic.
siliconchip.com.au
+0.1
Frequency Response: 50mV in, 1V out, 6V supply
07/20/10 15:47:03
0.1
THD+N vs Frequency: 20x gain, 10Hz-80kHz BW
07/20/10 15:42:15
+.08
Total Harmonic Distortion + Noise (%)
0.05
Amplitude Variation (dBr)
+.06
+.04
+.02
+0
-.02
-.04
-.06
0.02
0.01
.005
.002
-.08
-0.1
20
50
100
200
500
1k
2k
5k
10k
20k
.001
20
50
100
Frequency (Hz)
CMRR
The Common Mode Rejection Ratio
(CMRR) is a measure of how well a
500
1k
2k
5k
10k
20k
Frequency (Hz)
Fig.1: this graph plots the frequency response of the Mini
Microphone Preamplifier. Note that the vertical scale is
greatly magnified, as the frequency variation is within just
±0.01dB. This figure is at the limit of our Audio Precision
System One test gear’s resolution – the response is about
as flat as it gets.
Such a wide frequency response is
not necessary but is the result of making this project as small and simple as
possible. There is no low-pass filter
except for the internal compensation
of the op amps. We are assuming that
most devices which accept line level
signals will have their own bandpass
filters to remove frequencies outside
the audio spectrum.
200
Fig.2: this graph shows the total harmonic distortion
(THD) with respect to frequency. Distortion levels are
higher than quoted because this is measured over a wider
bandwidth (10Hz-80kHz), so more noise is registered.
The slight drop at high frequencies is due to the 80kHz
cut-off. Again this is essentially a flat measurement.
device with a balanced or differential
input is able to reject a signal that
is common to both inputs. In other
words, if the same amount of 50/100Hz
hum is coupled into both signal conductors in the cable, this is the amount
by which that hum is attenuated.
For our first prototype, we used
standard 1% resistors throughout
and measured a CMRR of -55dB. Our
second prototype used more expensive
0.1% resistors in the differential amplifier which improved the CMRR to
-88dB. In practice, -55dB is perfectly
adequate unless you have a very long
microphone cable run.
To get the best performance, either
the power supply ground or signal
ground should to be connected to
earth. This reduces the possibility
of mains 50/100Hz hum entering the
circuit. However, you should avoid
earthing both so that an earth loop
cannot be created.
In other words, earth the supply
ground but only if neither the input
nor output signal grounds are already
earthed. The diecast aluminium box
Main Features
•
Unbalanced or balanced mono input
(3.5mm mono/stereo socket)
•
Unbalanced mono output (3.5mm mono
socket)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Very low distortion and noise
Small and easy to build
Runs off a 5-20V DC plugpack or battery
Adjustable gain over a wide range
Line level output to at least 1.5V RMS
Provision for electret microphone bias
(approx. 390µA)
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 43
REG1 LM2931
+5-20V DC
IN
GND
10k
CON1
+5V
OUT
100 F
LOW
ESR
100nF
A
LED1
10k
4
12
100nF
14
IC1d
100 F 13
10k
K
+2.5V
MIC
BIAS
LK1
100k
IC1: AD8648ARZ
100k
5
6
10k
10k
4.7 F NP
MIC INPUT
4.7 F NP
CON2
3.5mm
STEREO
7
10k*
10k*
* USE 0.1% RESISTORS FOR
IMPROVED CMRR
10k*
GAIN
VR1
10k
LIN
9
10
180
100k
IC1b
IC1c
100
8
100k
100k
3
IC1a
1
10k*
MINI MICROPHONE PREAMP
CON3
3.5mm
STEREO
10k*
LED
SC
LINE OUT
11
10k*
2
2010
10 F
LM2931
GND
K
A
IN
AD8648ARZ
14
OUT
7
1
Fig.3: the circuit is based on quad op amp IC1, with IC1a & IC1b forming a balanced amplifier stage. This provides
the gain and drives differential amplifier stage IC1c which converts from a balanced to an unbalanced output signal.
Regulator REG1 provides a +5V supply rail to power the circuit, while IC1d and the 10kΩ divider resistors on its pin
12 input provide a +2.5V half-supply rail to bias IC1a-IC1c.
is connected to ground (and therefore
earth) to improve its magnetic shielding properties.
It is also very important to use
shielded cables. Most of the distortion
we encountered while testing the preamplifier’s unbalanced performance
was in the form of hum entering via the
input lead. This changed depending
on how the lead was routed.
We tested both the AD8648ARZ
and AD8694ARZ quad op amps and
found the overall performance to be
the same. Use whichever one is easiest
or cheapest to obtain.
Balanced input
While this circuit was designed
with cheap, unbalanced microphones
in mind, it is able to handle balanced
signals too. These have the advantage
of good noise cancellation, eliminating
hum, especially with long cable runs.
However, because the unit is so small
we cannot fit the standard XLR type
connectors. Instead, we are using the
44 Silicon Chip
tip and ring of a 3.5mm stereo connector for the positive and negative
balanced signals respectively.
If you intend using unbalanced microphones, we assume that they will
be fitted with a mono 3.5mm jack plug.
Inserting this into the 3.5mm stereo
socket will ground one side of the
balanced input, to give unbalanced
operation.
To test its balanced capabilities,
we used an XLR to 6.5mm Tip-RingSleeve (TRS) cable with a 6.5mm-to3.5mm stereo adaptor on the end. Both
XLR and 6.5mm TRS connectors are
used for balanced audio connections
on professional gear, so getting such
cables is easy enough. Unfortunately,
professional gear does not come cheap.
The cable probably cost more than the
preamplifier!
Using a balanced input cable isn’t
strictly necessary but our tests showed
that it is by far the best way to eliminate
mains hum from the equation. With an
unbalanced input cable, we could only
eliminate the hum by watching the
signal on the oscilloscope and moving the cable around until the 50Hz
component disappeared. In practice,
hum will always be a problem when
using unbalanced microphones. Substituting a balanced cable (and signal)
completely eliminates it, regardless of
the cable routing.
Note that the metal enclosure is
less critical if you are using a balanced microphone. This is because
the low-level signals on the PC board
are all differential – by the time the
signal is converted to unbalanced, it
has already been amplified so mains
interference is less of a problem. With
a balanced signal, even if the PC board
is mounted in a plastic enclosure,
performance should be good. Tests at
our office show no loss in performance
running the bare board with a balanced
input signal.
Op amps
The AD8646/7/8 and AD8691/2/4
siliconchip.com.au
op amps we have used in this project
provide excellent performance from a
low supply voltage. They both feature
a low input noise of 8nV/√Hz – the
same as an OPA2132/4. This is not
quite as good as an NE5532, NE5534 or
LM4562 but it is impressive nonetheless, especially as they operate from
such low supply voltages.
The AD8648 has a gain bandwidth
(GBW) of 24MHz while the AD8694
has a GBW of 10MHz. The AD8694
features a THD+N figure of 0.0006%
and a low input offset voltage of 400µV
(with low drift), while the AD8648
can deliver 120mA from its outputs
and handles 600Ω loads gracefully.
Both have very low input bias current
(<1pA) and low quiescent supply current (<2mA per amplifier).
Both op amp series are only available in surface-mount packages – Small
Outline Integrated Circuit (SOIC) or
the finer-pitched Thin Shrink Small
Outline Package (TSSOP) or Mini
Small Outline Package (MSOP). That
is the trend these days and many
modern, high-performance ICs are
no longer available in through-hole
packages. Having said that, these SMD
packages are reasonably easy to solder.
These op amps are ideal for highquality audio processing in batteryoperated equipment. The AD8646/7/8
(single/dual/quad version) can even
do a decent job of driving a headphone
load. In this application, we have
chosen them primarily for their low
noise and distortion, as well as their
reasonable price.
Circuit description
Refer now to Fig.3 for the circuit details. As shown, power is supplied via
PC-mount DC socket CON1, with green
LED1 indicating operation. The 10kΩ
current-limiting resistor is a much
higher value than usual and as a result,
the LED glows dimly. This is done to
conserve power if the preamplifier is
being run from a battery. If you don’t
plan to use a battery or don’t mind a
few milliamps of extra current drain,
then you can change the 10kΩ resistor to 1kΩ so that the LED is brighter.
Since the LED runs off the unregulated supply, its brightness will
depend on the supply voltage. This
means that it can also be used as a
crude battery level meter.
Regulator REG1 is an LM2931 lowdropout (LDO) type, so its output voltage is stable with an input as low as
siliconchip.com.au
Specifications
Supply voltage: 5-20V DC (operates at 2.8-5V with reduced performance)
Supply current: typically below 6mA
Voltage gain: 3-111
Input sensitivity (line level output): 14mV RMS
Input sensitivity (1V RMS output): 18mV RMS
Input impedance: 50kΩ (8.3kΩ with bias enabled)
THD+N ratio: 0.0035%
THD+N ratio (10mV RMS in): 0.014%
Signal-to-noise ratio: -90dB (-93dB A-weighted)
CMRR* (1% resistors): -55dB
CMRR* (0.1% resistors): -88dB
Frequency response: 20Hz-20kHz ±0.01dB
Signal handling: >1.5V RMS output
Signal handling (3.0V supply): >1.0V RMS output
Note 1: CMRR = Common Mode Rejection Ratio
Note 2: all specifications relative to 50mV RMS input, 775mV RMS output,
20Hz-22kHz bandwidth and a 6V supply, unless otherwise stated.
5.1V. Its quiescent current is typically
below 1mA, again contributing to good
battery life. Below 5.1V, REG1 ceases
regulating but the circuit can still run,
as long as the input supply is at least
2.8V. However, the maximum output
signal level is lower with a supply
below 5.1V. With a 2.8V supply, the
maximum output level is 950mV RMS,
which is still above line level.
There is no supply polarity protection diode as REG1 can withstand
negative voltages and its input filter
capacitor is a non-polarised type. The
100µF capacitor at its output filters
the regulated voltage and is necessary
for stability. Because REG1 is an LDO
type, the output capacitor must be at
least 100µF and its Equivalent Series
Resistance (ESR) has to be between
0.03Ω and 1Ω. That is why we have
specified a low-ESR type (listed as
0.22Ω).
In reality, many other 100µF capacitors are probably suitable but they
would need to be tested using an ESR
meter before installation to ensure that
they are within the acceptable range.
The two 10kΩ resistors between
REG1’s output and ground form a
voltage divider, the junction of which
is at half the supply voltage (normally
+2.5V). This is necessary because the
op amps use ground as their negative
rail. Their input and output AC signals
must be biased to this virtual ground
potential so that the signals always
stay between the two supply rails (5V
and 0V).
The second 100µF capacitor filters
this virtual ground. This is important
as otherwise supply noise could couple into it and noise on the virtual
ground will couple directly into the
signal path. The half-supply voltage is
fed into op amp IC1d which is configured as a voltage follower. Its output
is the same voltage as its input but
has a much lower impedance, so any
current fed into the virtual ground has
no effect on its level.
The two input signals at 3.5mm
socket CON2 (one of which is grounded with an unbalanced microphone)
are DC-biased with 100kΩ resistors in
case the signal source is floating. If a
jumper link is placed across LK1, these
signal lines are pulled up via 10kΩ
resistors to provide a 390µA bias current for an electret microphone – see
panel. Regardless of the DC biasing,
the signals pass through the two 4.7µF
non-polar AC-coupling capacitors.
Next, the signals are biased to a DC
level of 2.5V by two 100kΩ resistors
and then enter the differential amplifier. Op amps IC1a, IC1b and IC1c are
configured in the classic instrumentation amplifier layout. IC1a and IC1b
have a high impedance input and
September 2010 45
R
IC1
AD8648
100nF
10k
10k
T
S
T
10k
100k
10k
100 F
10k
100k
R
S
+
NP
10k*
10k*
10k*
100k
5V BIAS
LK1
1
+
+
T
4.7 F
180
S
NP
(UNDER)
R
CON2
+
+
IC1
VR1
4.7 F
100 F
L/ESR
100nF
S
100k
100k
100
T
10 F
R
CON3
REG1
10k*
10k*
10k*
+
LED1 CON1
A
* USE 0.1% RESISTORS
FOR BEST CMRR
TOP OF BOARD (COMPONENT SIDE)
UNDERSIDE OF BOARD (COPPER SIDE)
Fig.4: here’s how to install the parts on the PC board. IC1 should be installed first – it goes on the copper side of the board
and must be orientated with pin 1 at bottom right (see photo). The jumper is installed for LK1 only if you intend using an
electret microphone – see panel. Note that prototype board shown in the photo differs slightly from the final version.
provide the gain which is varied by
potentiometer VR1.
VR1 and its series 180Ω resistor
form a voltage divider, along with the
10kΩ resistors to the outputs of IC1a
(pin 1) and IC1b (pin 7). As a result,
when VR1 is turned clockwise and its
resistance decreases, the gain of both
IC1a and IC1b increases.
Note that, in each case, the “bottom
end” of the divider network is not
connected to ground but rather to the
output of the opposite op amp. This
provides much better common-mode
rejection. That’s because the gain of
each op amp can vary due to resistor
tolerances but since the gain is differential, it does not matter.
The buffered and amplified signals
are now passed to IC1c which is connected as a differential amplifier. It
converts the balanced signals from
IC1a & IC1b to an unbalanced signal. The resulting waveform is then
AC-coupled via a 10µF electrolytic
capacitor to CON3, the 3.5mm stereo
output socket.
Note, however, CON3’s ring termi-
nal is grounded which means you must
use a mono jack plug. The associated
100kΩ resistor references the output
signal to ground while the 100Ω series resistor isolates the output from
capacitive loads to ensure stability.
Construction
All the parts are mounted on a PC
board coded 01109101 and measuring
56 x 49.5mm. This board has corner
cutouts to clear the corner pillars in
the specified diecast metal case.
Fig.4 shows the parts layout. Begin
by checking the copper side of the
board for any defects (cracks, short
circuits, etc). Check also that it is the
correct shape to fit in the box. If necessary, make the corner cut-outs using a
small hacksaw and file.
Make sure that the board goes all the
way down into the box. The inside of
the box tapers slightly and it may be
necessary to file the edges of the board
so that it fits.
The next step is to solder the surface-mount IC (IC1) into place. This is a
14-pin SOIC package and is fairly easy
to solder provided due care is taken.
You will need a soldering iron with a
fine tip and a good light (preferably a
magnifying lamp).
First, orientate the PC board copper
side up and with the SMD pads posi-
This view shows the
completed PC board
mounted inside its
diecast metal case.
This case makes for
a rugged assembly
and provides the
necessary shielding.
Table 1: Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
No.
5
11
1
1
46 Silicon Chip
Value
100kΩ
10kΩ
180Ω
100Ω
4-Band Code (1%)
brown black yellow brown
brown black orange brown
brown grey brown brown
brown black brown brown
5-Band Code (1%)
brown black black orange brown
brown black black red brown
brown grey black black brown
brown black black black brown
siliconchip.com.au
Biasing Electret Microphones
Parts List
Electret microphones have an internal Field Effect Transistor (FET) which
amplifies the very low level signal they generate. This FET requires a source of
current to operate. Some such microphones contain an internal battery, in which
case they can be treated like any other microphone. However others require
power to be sent along the input cable, in a similar manner to “phantom power”.
If you have an unbalanced electret microphone which requires external power,
this unit can deliver it. A jumper shunt placed on the 2-pin header (LK1) enables
the bias current. Assuming the microphone’s bias voltage is 1V, it will receive
390µA. Some electrets require more current – up to 800µA – but others can
be damaged if more than 400µA is supplied.
If your microphone needs more current then you can change the two 10kΩ
resistors near the non-polarised capacitors to 5.1kΩ. In this case the bias
current will increase to 775µA with a bias voltage of 1V.
This unit will also provide power for balanced condenser microphones, using
the same 2-pin header.
1 PC board, 56 x 49.5mm,
coded 01109101
1 die-cast sealed aluminium
box, 64 x 58 x 35mm (Jaycar
HB5030)
1 2.5mm PC-mount DC power
socket (Jaycar PS0520, Altronics P0621A)
2 3.5mm PC-mount stereo
switched socket (Jaycar
PS0133, Altronics P0092)
1 2-pin header (2.54mm pitch)
1 10kΩ linear 9mm vertical PCmount potentiometer (Altronics R1946)
1 jumper/shorting block
1 50mm length of tinned copper
wire or 0Ω resistor
tioned as shown in Fig.4. That done,
apply a small amount of solder to one
of the pads – eg, the upper-right pad if
you are righthanded or the upper-left
pad if you are lefthanded.
Now place the IC alongside the
pads with the bevelled edge on the
righthand side and the pin 1 dot at the
bottom-right. Check that it is correctly
orientated, then melt the solder on the
pad (taking care not to spread it to
adjacent pads) and gently slide the IC
into place. Do not apply heat for more
than a few seconds.
Next, press down gently on the IC
and re-heat the pad, allowing the solder to melt. This ensures that the IC
is sitting flat on the board. Now check
that the pins are all aligned with the
pads. If not, re-heat the soldered pad
and slide the IC until all the pins are
lined up, then apply solder to the
diagonally opposite pin.
It’s now simply a matter of flowing
a small amount of solder onto the remaining pads. Ensure that it adheres to
both the pad and the pin in each case.
Generally, this is achieved by ensuring that the soldering iron remains
in contact with the pad for about one
second after the solder is applied. If
you accidentally join any of the adjacent pads or pins together, remove
the excess solder using solder wick.
Finally, apply a small amount of
additional solder to the first two pads
you soldered to hold the IC in place, to
ensure the solder has flowed correctly.
Once it’s finished, use a magnifying
glass to check that all the pins have
been correctly soldered and that there
are no bridges.
siliconchip.com.au
With the IC secured, the parts can
now be installed on the top of the
board. Begin by fitting the single wire
link using 0.71mm tinned copper wire
or a 0Ω resistor, then install the resistors. Table 1 shows the resistor colour
codes but you should also check each
one using a DMM before installing it.
If you are using 0.1% 10kΩ resistors to get the improved CMRR figure
then be sure to install them in the
locations marked with asterisks on
Fig.4. The remaining 10kΩ resistors
can be 1% types without affecting the
performance.
Now mount the two 3.5mm stereo
sockets. First, remove the nuts from
both and discard them then press the
sockets down so that they sit flat on the
PC board. Check that they are aligned
with the edge of the board before soldering all the pins.
Follow these with the two multilayer ceramic capacitors. They are the
same value and can go in either way.
The LM2931 regulator in the plastic
TO-92 package can then go in. Use
small pliers to bend its legs out by 45°
and then back down parallel again so
that they will fit through the holes in
the PC board. Make sure its flat face
is orientated as shown on the overlay.
The 2-pin header is next on the list,
followed by the polarised electrolytic
capacitors. Check that the 100µF low
ESR type goes in next to the regulator
and check that they are all orientated
correctly. Don’t get the 10µF and 100µF
capacitors mixed up.
The two 4.7µF non-polar electrolytics can be fitted either way around.
Install these now, then fit the DC power
Semiconductors
1 AD8648ARZ or AD8694ARZ
quad low noise rail-to-rail op
amp (IC1)
1 LM2931Z-5.0 or LM2931AZ-5.0
low dropout 5V regulator
(REG1)
1 5mm green LED (LED1)
Capacitors
1 100µF 16V low-ESR electrolytic (Jaycar RE6310)
1 100µF 16V electrolytic
1 10µF electrolytic
2 4.7µF non-polar electrolytic
2 100nF multilayer ceramic
(code 100n or 104)
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
5 100kΩ
1 180Ω
11 10kΩ
1 100Ω
Optional: use 6 x 10kΩ 0.1% for
improved CMRR – see Fig.4
socket. The latter should sit flush with
the board and its pins soldered using
generous amounts of solder.
Finally, install the 5mm green LED.
This goes in with the bottom of its
plastic body 19mm above the PC board
and its flat edge towards CON1 – see
Fig.4. A strip of cardboard cut to 19mm
can be inserted between its pins when
soldering it in to set the correct height.
Testing
It is a good idea to test the board
before installing it in the box. Once it’s
installed, it can be difficult to remove.
The first step is to install the shorting jumper on the 2-pin header if your
September 2010 47
5-20V DC
HOLES A: 7.0mm DIA.
HOLE B: 5.0mm DIA.
HOLE C: 6.5mm DIA.
HOLE D: 8.0mm DIA.
Power
D
CL
Output
1.5
(ALL DIMENSIONS
IN MILLIMETRES)
(TOP)
UPPER LONG SIDE
CL
CL
(TOP)
A
9.5
7
C
CL
A
9.5
1.5
LEFT END
TOP (LID)
Fig.5: these are the drilling templates for the case. Use a small pilot drill to
drill the centre of each hole initially, then carefully enlarge them to full size
using a tapered reamer.
microphone requires a bias current (ie,
if it is an electret – see panel). That
done, apply power (a plugpack is the
easiest) and check that the LED lights.
If it doesn’t, then either the supply
polarity is reversed or you have a short
circuit between two tracks.
Once it has power, turn the gain all
the way down and connect a signal
source to the input socket. You can use
a microphone or some other mono or
balanced signal source. A stereo signal
will not work very well however, as the
two channels will be subtracted from
each other by the differential amplifier.
Next, connect the output socket to
an amplifier or use some other method
to monitor the output signal (eg, a
scope). Now slowly increase the gain
control on the preamplifier and check
that the input signal is being correctly
fed through to the amplifier. If you
are using a microphone for this test,
be careful to avoid feedback between
the monitoring speakers and the microphone.
Final assembly
Assuming all is well, use the drilling
templates shown in Fig.5 (also available on the SILICON CHIP website) to
48 Silicon Chip
Gain
SILICON
CHIP
Input
Mini Mic Preamplifier
B
18
+
make the five holes in the diecast box.
It’s best to initially drill the centre of
each hole with a small-diameter bit (eg,
3mm) and then carefully enlarge them
to full size using a tapered reamer (this
will ensure that they are accurately
placed). Deburr each hole using an
oversize drill.
Once the holes have been made,
insert the board with the two 3.5mm
sockets angled downwards. Push these
into the appropriate holes and then
lever the board down. The DC socket
should clear the edge of the box, allowing you to lay the board flat on the
internal “shelves”.
If it won’t go in, you may need to
either file the board edges where it is
catching on the box or slightly enlarge
the holes for the 3.5mm input and
output sockets.
Once the board is in, secure it in
position with the two screws provided
with the box. Now, using a multimeter
set on continuity mode, check that the
board ground is electrically connected
to the box. You can use the exposed
metal tab on the side of the DC socket
as a ground test point.
It is also a good idea to ensure that
there is no short circuit between the
Fig.6: this front panel artwork can
either be photocopied or you can
download it in PDF format from the
SILICON CHIP website.
exposed wire link on the top side of
the PC board and the box, or between
the exposed tab on the rear of the DC
socket and the box. If there is, your
power source will be shorted out when
it is plugged in.
If you do get a short, remove the PC
board and check for any leads or other
metal pieces sticking out the underside
which may be contacting the box.
Assuming there are no short circuits, plug your power source back in
and check that the preamplifier still
works. If not, there may be a short
circuit from one of the signal paths
to the box for the same reason stated
above. The board has been designed
so that the component pads clear the
box edges and shelves (except for the
ground track) but there may be some
circumstances under which they can
make contact.
All that remains now is to fit the
front panel and attach the lid. You can
either photocopy the artwork shown in
Fig.6 or you can download it in PDF
format from the SILICON CHIP website
and print it out. It can be protected
using wide strips of clear tape (or
laminated) and attached using a smear
of silicone sealant.
The gain control shaft and LED
should project through the holes in the
lid by a few millimetres – just enough
to allow the gain control to be adjusted
with your finger tips while making it
difficult to accidentally alter it if it is
bumped.
If you wish, you can press the provided neoprene seal into the recess
underneath the lid just prior to fitting
it. However, the holes drilled earlier
mean that the box is no longer dustSC
proof or waterproof.
siliconchip.com.au
Economy 4 Channel
H264 DVR & Camera Kit
Multiplexing DVR
system with H.264
compression
technology complete with
four IR outdoor
CCD cameras,
four 20 metre
pre-wired
camera cables and power supply. Fitted with a 250GB HDD, the
DVR delivers quality image reproduction at a touch of a button,
plus built-in Ethernet capability that enables the unit to be
accessed (with password protection) via the Internet using a
standard web browser. The recorder features advanced motion
trigger recording, video loss detection, remote network record
and USB back-up support.
Just add a TV or monitor for a
complete surveillance system.
QV-8100
799
$
250GB HDD
00
Windscreen Mount Suction
Bracket for iPhone®
A handy device for Dad to mount his
iPhone® to the windscreen for easy
access. The strong 80mm diameter
suction mount will keep his
iPhone® securely attached. The
ball and socket joint enables
positioning for maximum
effectiveness. Will hold an
iPhone® with or without a
protective back cover.
Caution: The use of windscreen-mounted devices
is illegal in some states, so check with your local
traffic authority before using this device. Always
ensure it is mounted so that it does not obstruct
your view or cause a distraction.
19 95
$
USB CASSETTE DECK
Record cassette tracks to your computer via USB or play back
through the built-in 5W speaker. You can also run the line level
outputs to an external amplifier and use it as a component
cassette deck.
• Dimensions: 178(L) x 72(H)
x 178(W)mm
GE-4054
79 95
$
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
2MP Web Camera with Microphone
Ideal for podcasting or creating a YouTube masterpiece. No
drivers required, just plug and shoot. Built-in microphone
included for adding sound.
39 95
$
Happy
Father’s
Day!
Weather Station LCD Keyring
A weather station that fits in the palm of your hand, it shows
forecast, temperature, humidity, time, date and moon phase. It
also has an alarm clock with snooze button. Complete with
inbuilt LED torch and compass.
• Batteries included
• Celsius or Fahrenheit
• Max/min temperature and
humidity memory
• Dimensions: 93(H) x 50(W) x
18(D)mm
XC-0341
19 95
$
Refer: Silicon Chip Magazine September/October 2010
Many of you know that you can buy $3-8,000 imported marine
growth electronic antifouling systems. Jaycar, with Silicon Chip
have developed a similar system based on this technology and
information in the public domain. This project uses the same
ultrasonic waveforms and virtually identical ultrasonic
transducers mounted in sturdy polyurethane housings.
By building yourself (which includes some potting) you save a
fortune! Standard unit consists of control electronic kit and
case, ultrasonic transducer , potting and gluing components
and housings. Research reveals only one transducer is needed
for boats under 40ft. Basically all parts supplied in the
project kit including wiring.
249 00
$
34
• Current consumption: 10mA
• Frequency response: 100Hz - 5kHz
• S/N ratio: 67dB
• Battery voltage indication: Down to 7V
KC-5497
Media Players are a great way to easily view your collection of
downloaded movies or digital pictures on your TV. Once the
media player is connected to your TV just attach your USB hard
drive or thumb drive with your movies or SD card from your
digital camera and start watching. The user interface is as
simple as they come with an eye catching design. The remote
control gives you complete control over your viewing
experience. Extensive file support makes this the perfect home
entertainment accessory. Video playback: Supports
up to 720p AVI/MP4, DIVX, XVID, Mpeg1/2, RM,
RMVB, DAT, MOV
(not H.264) and VOB
Music playback: MP3,
WAV, OGG & WMA
audio formats Great Gift Idea
XC-4206
For Father’s Day
Also Available: 1080p Media
Player with USB/SD/LAN ports
XC-4204 $169.00
• 12VDC
Including epoxies
• Suitable for power or sail
• Could be powered by a solar
panel/wind generator
• Available end of September call first for availability
KC-5498
Team any of these LED DMX-controlled lights with a controller
or software for complete control over your stage, party or DJ
lighting setup. Each is 240V powered, individually addressable
via DIP switch and includes a mounting bracket.
A budget 61-LED 4 Ch DMX
Spotlight SL-3420 $99.00
Dimensions: 180(L) x 170(Dia)mm
All aluminium Par 46
5-Channel 94-LED DMX
Spotlight SL-3422 $139.00
Dimensions: 300(L) x 135(Dia)mm
Par 64 5-Channel 94-LED
DMX Spotlight SL-3424 $169.00
Dimensions: 245(L) x 195(Dia)mm
Housed in a tough
rubberised case, this is
the ideal power
accessory for your next
camping, fishing or
4WD adventure. In
addition to a 200W
modified sine wave
inverter, it also provides
a USB outlet, an LED work
light and two 12V
cigarette lighter outlets.
FROM
Dimensions: 230(W) x 180(H) x 62(D)mm
MI-5103
99 95
$
LED DMX Spotlights
Multifunction 200W Inverter
www.jaycar.com.au
Refer: Silicon Chip Magazine September 2010
A hearing loop is an inductive assisted listening system for the
hearing impaired. They're typically installed in venues such as
churches and conference rooms to enable listeners to receive
in-ear communication via a wireless induction loop. You can
now install this technology on your own TV, home theatre or
hi-fi system. This will enable someone who's hard of hearing
to hear at their own volume level without having to turn the
volume up to a level too high for everyone else. The receiver
will drive a pair of headphone or earbuds from the
signal picked up from the hearing loop. The
whole unit is completely self-contained and
can be carried around in a pocket or you can
add a belt clip, so the user isn't constrained
by a set of headphone leads. The kit is
complete with case, label, PCB
95
and components.
$
Note: Transmitter not included
Now Dad Can Watch his
Downloaded Movies with Ease
Ultrasonic Antifouling System
HS-9004 Note: iPhone® not included
• 2MP
• Plug-and-play
QC-3233
Hearing Loop Receiver Kit
79 95
$
To order call
1800 022 888
Prices valid until 23/09/2010. Limited stock on sale items. No rainchecks. All Savings are based on Original RRP
99 00
$
2
1:10 Scale RC Brushless Electric Cars
RC Helicopter Bargains
Featuring a much higher motor speed than your average RC car (3300 rpm/Volt), these brushless electric
cars are more efficient, so your battery pack lasts longer. Both models are ready to race and have highefficiency brushless motors with electronic speed controllers, four wheel drive, independent suspension,
super-tuff Lexan bodies, rechargeable batterypacks and digital proportional remote control units.
• Recommended for ages 12+
Great Gift Idea
Brushless Touring
Truggy
For Father’s Day
• Length: 360mm
• Length: 460mm
• Wheelbase: 260mm
• Wheelbase: 275mm
• Track: 200mm
• Track: 250mm
GT-3674
• Gear ratio: 6.25:1
• Gear ratio: 1:8.038
• Battery: 7.2V, 2000mAh
• Battery: 7.2V, 2000mAh
GT-3674 WAS $299.00
GT-3676 WAS $329.00
269 00
$
SAVE 30
$
00
279 00
$
SAVE 50
$
00
3 Channel Shark Helicopter with Alloy Frame
All aluminium airframe, fuselage and landing gear make
this chopper more than a toy and suitable for outdoor
flying in calm conditions. A great challenge for the more
experienced pilot.
• Li-Po battery recharges
in about 20 minutes
to give about
10 minutes
flight time
• Remote requires
4 x AA batteries
• Trim control
• Plugpack charger included
• 380mm long
• Recommended for ages 14+
GT-3380 WAS $79.95 Limited Stock
GT-3676
Spare parts available separately
Accessories & Upgrades For Electric Car Range
1:10 Scale Car Brushless Motor / Electronic Speed Controller Upgrade
GADGETS & GIZMOS
Add serious tyre-shredding, wheel-standing horsepower to your 1:10 scale electric RC car. The kit comprises two parts - a
3300rpm/Volt brushless motor and 75amp electronic speed controller (ESC) - and will fit our GT-3670 and GT-3672, or just about any
1:10 scale RC racing car. This brushless motor and ESC combination can be powered by a normal 7.2V Ni-MH RC battery pack, but we
seriously recommend using our SB-2310 3300mAH 7.4V LiPO battery pack to get the most from this serious upgrade to your RC car.
See our website for a video demo of the awesome performance of this upgrade in the Jaycar carpark.
Electronic Speed Controller specifications:
• Low battery voltage cut-off to protect LiPO
batteries from damage
• Over temperature protection
• Max current - 75A
• Battery Input - 7.2V Ni-MH,
or 7.4V Li-Po
199 00
$
Motor Specifications:
• Standard RC540 size motor (36mm x 50mm)
• Brushless motor - 3300 rpm/Volt
• Shaft Diameter - 3.175mm (1/8")
Li-Po batteries offer excellent performance compared to Ni-Mh
and Ni-Cd batteries and can be consistently charged &
discharged at a much higher rate. They are also smaller &
weigh far less. This particular battery pack is the perfect
upgrade for 1:10 scale electric remote control cars, & features
standardised sizing & output cabling that are common with
most 1:10 scale car batteries.
Voltage: 7.4V
$
Capacity: 3600mAh
Discharge rate (cont.): 20C
Discharge rate (burst): 40C
Charge input: 3-pin balance connector
Output: 12AWG silicone fly leads with Deans connector
Dimensions: 137(L) x 45(W) x 23(H)mm
SB-2311
99 95
6.0V 1600mAh Ni-MH RC
Receiver Battery Packs
The perfect solution to constantly replacing the receiver
batteries in your RC car. Available in two types, "hump pack"
and "flat pack", to suit almost any RC car application. Each has
five 1.2V 1/3A 1600mAh cells, and are fitted with standard
2-pin JST connectors.
95
$
6.0V Ni-MH 1600mAh
Hump Pack Receiver
Battery SB-2302
Dimensions: 52 x 32 x
32mm, 60mm lead
95
$
6.0V NiMH 1600mAh Flat Pack
Receiver Battery SB-2304
Dimensions: 86 x 32 x
17mm. 80mm lead
29
29
Better, More Technical
RC Fail-Safe
SAVE $10 00
2.4GHz Mini 4 Channel Helicopter
Very stable and easy to fly, probably the best
chopper we've had so far. Four channels gives
you complete control for complex and
accurate manoeuvring, takeoff and
landings. The body is
made from Lexan
so is very flexible and strong.
119 00
$
SAVE $30 00
2.4GHz 3-Channel RC Car Remote
Fitting a fail-safe device
into your nitro powered
cars and boats will give you
added peace of mind. If you lose
radio control, your throttle
servo will return to a
neutral position. Lead
length 100mm.
DC-1504
24 95
$
7.2V Ni-MH 2000mAh RC Battery
High capacity, high current
discharge Ni-MH packs
for radio control cars.
Fitted with standard
"Tamiya" type plug.
7.2V Ni-MH 2000mAh R/C
Battery SB-2312 $34.95
7.2V Ni-MH 3300mAh R/C
Battery SB-2314 $49.95
69 95
$
• 18 minute charge gives about
10 minutes flying time.
• Remote requires 4 x AA batteries.
• Measures 185(L)mm approx.
• Recommended for ages 10+
GT-3384 WAS $149.00
GT-3675
7.4V 3600mAh Lithium-Polymer
Battery Pack
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
Never worry about having the right crystal again. You can save
all of your models and setups in one transmitter, and recall
them with a couple of button pushes. Each model
memory has fully programmable features such as
throttle and steering curves, ABS, traction control,
steering limits and much, much more.
Available as a transmitter and receiver
system that includes: 2.4GHz transmitter,
receiver and servo battery holder.
Additional 2.4GHz 3-channel receivers are
available separately
(Cat no. DC-1502 $79.95).
• 3 channel
00
$
• 2.4GHz
• Race timer
• Auto Start function
• Anti-skid braking
• Programmable throttle and steering curves
DC-1500
149
FROM
34 95
$
7.2V 700mAh Ni-MH RC
Battery Stick Pack
A great value long-lasting
rechargeable Ni-MH battery pack
for radio controlled cars, including
our 1:10 scale RC Ferrari Enzo
(GT-3210) and Ferrari F430 (GT-3211).
Fitted with standard
95
Tamiya type plug.
$
SB-2306
14
All Savings are based on Original RRP
Limited stock on sale items.
Deans Style 60A 2 Pole Gold
Plated Connector Set
These are the industry standard in high
performance connectors. Rated number
one by RC Car Action, the world's leading
RC car racing magazine. These connectors
offer considerably less resistance than
their competitors and are rated
at 60 amps. Supplied as a pair.
$ 95
PT-4450
3
To order call 1800 022 888
Happy Father’s Day!
DON’T JUST
SIT THERE,
BUILD SOMETHING
Buy Dad His Very Own Ferrari!
Interactive Music Quiz
USB Turntable with Amp
Copy your LPs, 45s or even 78s straight to your PC, or simply
listen to your record collection via the built-in amp and
speakers. Finished in contemporary white
piano finish with blue LED accents.
Test your family and friends' music knowledge with this
interactive music quiz that you control! Game options include
'name that track', 'beat the intro', 'name the artist' and 'sing
the next line'. Or make up your own game - the possibilities
are endless!
• RCA line outputs
• USB cable and
software included
• Contemporary looks
• Measures: 320(W) x
265(D) x 85(H)mm
GE-4056 WAS $99.00
• Speaker console with speaker, four
team buzzers and LCD points display
• Quizmaster controller with music
start/stop button, points buttons, crowd
sound effects, three music distortion
buttons and volume control
• MP3 player (not included)
connection to the Quizmaster
controller
• Requires 3 x AA batteries
• Suitable for ages 8+
GE-4233 WAS $39.95
89
$
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
00
SAVE $10 00
Talking Swear Box
Tired of people around you swearing
and can't get them to stop?
Introduce them to the talking
swear box and they will soon
change their bad habits.
• 3-Channel
• Remote requires
1 x 9V battery
GT-3203 Was $89.95
34
$
95
SAVE $5 00
Challenge your
friends in an
intergalactic battle and
bring balance to the force.
Extremely light and durable, made of
tough acrylic to take all the knocks of
travelling around the galaxy at light speed.
Sound and light effects.
9
Solar Kits
Mini Solar Bullet Train Kit
All aboard the solar bullet train! This kit is an excellent
way to teach how solar power is used to drive a small
motor. Perfect for train enthusiasts!
• Includes 18 parts, 4 screws, and 1 mini solar panel
• Suitable for ages 10+
KJ-8929
14 95
$
19 95
$
Size: 710(L) x 48(Dia)mm
GT-3520
Sudoku Toilet Paper
Forget about reading National Geographic while you're
indisposed - just play with the sodoku loo roll!
When finished, put it to good use!
• Double ply for comfort
GH-1508
Solar Powered Planetarium
Easy to build and loads of fun. Not
only does it provide a hands-on
lesson about how solar power
drives a motor, but also gives some
educational pointers on
planets and the solar
system. Operates from a
50W halogen light as well. See website for
full kit contents. Suitable for ages 10+
KJ-8927
1:10 Scale RC Ferrari
GT California
Sabre SFX LED Sword
$ 95
5Per roll
$ 95
Sports Stopwatch
• 1/100th second timing
$ 95
• Water resistant
• Split time, alarm and calendar
SAVE $3 00
• Includes 600m lanyard
• Dimensions: 55 (W) x 65 (H) x 15 (D)mm
XC-0270 WAS $12.95
9
24 95
3-In-1 Solar Robot Kit
This 3-in-1 solar robot kit easily transforms into three
intergalactic robotic designs. See how solar power drives
the motor forcing these 3 robots to make different
movements. If it’s a cloudy day, then have some
indoor fun and use a
50W halogen light.
Projects include a tank,
robot and a scorpion.
24 95
$
www.jaycar.com.au
1:20 Scale RC
Ferrari 2008 F1
79 95
$
SAVE $10 00
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
• 3-Channel
• Remote requires
2 x AA batteries
GT-3207 Was $54.95
39 95
$
SAVE $15 00
SnapMusic Audio Capture for PC
Turn your PC into a mini recording
studio. Record and archive
music from your old vinyl
records, cassettes or any
other audio source
directly to your PC and save
the files as high-quality WAVs or MP3s.
See website for full specifications.
• Audio capture box with line-in/out,
S/PDIF in/out and mic-in all-in-one
• Create your own podcasts from any
program material
• Record live performances or lectures
• Convert audio files formats
• Burn high quality audio CDs
• Includes SnapMusic Studio 715 and Roxy
Easy Media Creator 9 LE
XC-4994
89 00
$
5.5" Graphics Tablet
A great Father's Day gift for the active Dad! It's a handy sports
timer that will be a useful addition to any sports bag.
$
Superbly detailed and fully factory licensed, these RC Ferraris
will give hours of fun for all ages. Pick from either 1:20 or the
huge 1:10 scale Ferrari. They have 3 channels so you can race
against each other, full function remote control and adjustable
steering bias. Each has a rechargeable battery pack included
for the car.
USB Plasma Ball
As the ball becomes energised, the gases inside light up
and turn into plasma. By touching the outside of the ball,
it will produce amazing effects.
$14 95
System requirements:
• Windows XP or Mac OS X
SAVE $5 00
• USB 1.1 port
• Dimensions: 130(H) x 100(W)mm
GE-4089 WAS $19.95
Limited stock on sale items.
All Savings are based on Original RRP
Using a graphics
tablet is
completely
natural, more
comfortable and
far more
accurate than a
mouse, with
higher resolution and pressure sensitivity. The pen has user
defined buttons and "hotspots" around the border of the
tablet. Paint, draw, write or touch up. Absolutely essential tool
for graphics designers, photographers or other creatives.
• Battery and software included
• Windows 2000, XP, Vista or Mac
• Dimensions: 205(W) x 190(H)mm
XC-0356
69 95
$
GREAT GIFTS FOR FATHERS DAY
• 3 x LR44 batteries included
• Dimensions: 160(W) x
105(H) x 60(D)mm
GH-1316
•Suitable for ages 10+
KJ-8928
3
4
New Thermometers
Non-Contact AC Voltage
Tester with Torch
Jumbo Display In/Out Thermometer
One display that shows both the
inside and outside temperatures
simultaneously. It will also record
the minimum and maximum
temperatures. The outside
temperature sensor is waterproof
and is on a 3 metre cable. It also
has a tilting bail for standing as
well as a keyhole for wall
mounting. Jumbo digits for the
optically challenged.
About the size of a marking pen, this non-contact tester detects
AC voltages from 100 - 600V. It can be used for detecting
live mains in outlets, powerboards or insulated
wiring. It also has an LED torch and a
handy pocket clip. A must
for every toolbox.
• Red LED and audible voltage indicator
• Requires 2 x AA batteries (not included)
• CAT III rated
• Dimensions 180(L) x 20(D)mm
QP-2271 WAS $19.95
• Reads Celsius or Fahrenheit
• Temperature range: -39.9°C to 49.9°C
-39.8°F to 122°F
• Requires AA battery
• Size: 95(W) x 140(H) x 22(D)mm
QM-7310
19
$
95
Jumbo Display Thermometer/Hygrometer
Displays the temperature and
humidity together on the one
huge LCD display. It also has a
min / max function (memory).
Switch between C° and F°.
Requires a AAA battery.
TOOLS
• Temperature: -10° - 60°C
(14° - 140°F)
• Humidity: 10 - 99% ±-5%
• Accuracy: ±-1°C, ±-1.8°F
• Size: 110(H) x
100(W) x 22(D)mm.
QM-7312
14 95
$
SAVE $5 00
30 Piece Tool Kit with Case
Minor DIY repairs are a breeze with this 30 piece tool
kit and every DIYer should have one of these in easy reach.
The tools are held securely in a zip-up case. Cutters, pliers,
tape measure, sockets, screwdriver bits and more. See website
for detailed contents.
24 95
$
24 95
• Pocket clip
• Stainless steel probe
• Temperature range: -50 - 120°C, -58 - 248°F
• Accuracy: ±1°C
• Length: 150mm
QM-7314
Indoor Desk Thermometer
Handy desk or table-top thermometers.
Measures degrees Celsius with
hi and low memory. Tilting bail
for standing on desk purposes.
Indoor only or indoor/outdoor
type. Battery included.
High Current Fuse Holder
Bolt-Down Fuse 125A
Bolt-Down Fuse 250A
Bolt-Down Fuse 500A
SF-1980 $19.95
SF-1982 $9.95
SF-1984 $9.95
SF-1986 $9.95
Cable Stapling Guns
Indoor QM-7316 $5.95
Indoor/Outdoor QM-7318 $6.95
Cable Stapling Guns
FROM
5
$ 95
Pencil Butane Torch
Pocket sized gas torch for heatshrinking, soldering etc and uses
standard butane gas. Adjustable flame, all metal construction.
11 95
$
Better, More Technical
• 135W
• Over 200 accessory pieces
• See website for full kit contents
• Size: 210(L) x 52(Dia)mm
TD-2459
44 95
$
Heavy Duty Wire Stripper /
Cutter / Crimper with Wire Guide
19 95
$
SAVE $10 00
Gaming Console Tool Kit
24 95
$
SAVE $15 00
Patented technology designed for high current
protection up to 250 amps found OEM on
Ford, GM and Chrysler vehicles.
Slo-Blo® feature eliminates nuisance
blowing during temporary, short duration
overloads. Commonly used for battery and
alternator connections and other heavy gauge
cables requiring ultra high current protection.
Rated up to 32V AC or DC. Terminal studs 8mm.
9
• Range: -20 - 50°C
• Size: 64(W) x 72(H) x 18(D)mm
A heavy duty tool for
crimping BNC/TNC
connectors onto
RG58/59/62 coax cable. The tool features a
secure ratchet mechanism for accurate and
reliable crimps.
TH-1846 WAS $39.95
Ultra High Current Fuses
$ 95
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
• For 1.5 - 6mm terminals
• Spring return
TH-1827 WAS $29.95
Ratchet Crimping Tool for
BNC/TNC Connectors
$
Flexible shafts have a multitude of uses. The kit consists of a
powerful 32,000 RPM rotary tool that Dad can use with
numerous attachments in the usual way, plus a 1m long
flexible shaft that attaches in seconds to give extra versatility.
Suitable for model
making,
automotive,
workshop, art,
jewellery or
sculpture.
Designed for easy wire stripping of AWG 10-24 gauge cable
(0.13 -6.0mm). The wire guide ensures the correct
length is stripped a precision blade is
incorporated for easy wire
cutting. Also features
quality crimping jaws.
• Case measures: 210(L)
x 160(W) x 48(H)mm
TD-2166
LCD Probe Thermometer
Multi-purpose digital thermometer for the kitchen, lab,
factory, workshop or barbeque. It measures in Celsius and
Fahrenheit and fits in a pocket.
• Size: 205(L) x 13(Dia)mm
TS-1667
Rotary Tool Kit with Flexible Shaft
If you have ever attempted any repair or improvement
on your gaming console, you know that the right tools an
make the difference between a good experience and a bad
on. Everything you need to get into your
gaming console and accessories.
Includes tools for pretty
much every console and
handheld on the market
today - WII, X-Box,
Playstation etc. Carry case included.
See website for full contents.
95
$
TD-2109
29
Micro Blade Fuses 10pk
FROM
9
$ 95
Micro-blade fuses to suit newer model
cars. The pack contains one each of
5, 7.5, 25, 30A and two each
of 10, 15, 20A.
SF-2146
9
$ 95
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
Take the pain out of cable installation. Instead of trying to pound away with a hammer, simply staple the
cable to eaves, rafters or joists. The staples have an integral plastic cable clamp that holds the cable
firmly in place. Each gun takes a variety of staples sizes to accommodate cables up to 12.5mm diameter.
Cable Staple Gun 4-10mm
TH-2610 $19.95
Staple
includes gun, 2 interchangeable blades and 200 staples.
Guns From
Heavy Duty Staple Gun Kit 4-12.5mm
TH-2615 $49.95
95
$
Includes heavy duty die cast gun, 3 interchangeable blades
and 200 staples in a carry case.
Cable Staples Refill 4-6mm Pk 200
TH-2611 $9.95
Staples From
Cable Staples Refill 6-8mm Pk 200
TH-2612 $9.95
Cable Staples Refill 8-9mm Pk 200
TH-2616 $9.95
$ 95
Cable Staples Refill 9.5-11mm Pk 200
TH-2617 $9.95
Cable Staples Refill 11.5-12.5mm Pk 200
TH-2618 $9.95
19
9
All Savings are based on Original RRP
Limited stock on sale items.
To order call 1800 022 888
Happy Father’s Day!
DON’T JUST
SIT THERE,
BUILD SOMETHING
Screwdriver with 10 Bits & Light
LED illuminated bit driver for working in spaces with poor
lighting. The handle has four LEDs built in to provide working
light. 10 bits are included, but any standard hex bit will fit.
Great for fiddling around under the bonnet etc
• Four LEDS to
95
$
eliminate blind spots
• Bits included: PH #0,
$
SAVE 8 00
#1, #2, slotted 3, 4, 5mm,
T15, M6 pin drive, M4 hex, hex - 1/4" square converter
• Batteries included, plus a spare set
TD-2091 WAS $22.95
14
Sound Level Datalogger
149
Idea
Great Gift
• USB interface
Father’s Day
For
• Over-range indication
• System requirements: Windows 2000, XP, Vista.
• Dimensions: 140(L) x 28(W) x 21(H)mm
QM-1599
CCTV Power Distributor Box
Makes distributing power to multiple CCTV cameras a simple
matter. Simply connect a common source up to 30VDC and
distribute it to up to 9 slave devices. Screw
terminal connection.
39 95
$
188pc Rotary Tool Accessories Pack
An environmentally friendly DMM with
rechargeable batteries that can be charged
from the built-in solar panel, 12-36VDC or
from mains power. Never have to buy
batteries again.
At substantially lower cost than the
hardware store brands and with 188
pieces, this kit will service every
rotary tool bit you'll ever need.
Everything is housed in a case so
you can see exactly where all the
bits belong. Sanding, grinding,
cutting and polishing attachments.
See website for full list of contents.
TD-2458
95 00
$
•Category: Cat III 600V
SAVE $24 00
•Display: 2000 count
•Size: 179(H) x 88(W) x 39(D)mm
QM-1546 WAS $119.00
19 95
$
Professional Laser Distance Meter
Multifunction LED
Controller with Remote
Great for applications like back lighting, mood lighting and
commercial signage. Comes complete with a wireless remote
control, so you can adjust your
LED effects from a distance of up
to 50 metres. Features adjustable
12 modes, 8 speeds, pause and
brightness control. Unit requires
12-24V supply and will provide
up to 5A maximum load per
channel. See our website for
compatible LED modules.
Dimensions: 211(L) x 40(W) x 30(H)mm
MP-3275
79 95
$
Biometric Fingerprint
ID Access Control
Control a single door or use multiple units
on a site connected to a PC via an RS232,
RS485 or Ethernet connection. Software
included.
• Up to 500 users
• 12VDC 3A relay output
• Requires 9VDC <at> 500mA
• Dimensions: 180(L) x
82(W) x 55(H)mm
LA-5121 WAS $499.00
279 00
$
SAVE $220 00
Also available
Universal RFID/Fingerprint Access Controller
LA-5122 $199.00
8-Zone 2-Partition Alarm Panel
With 8 protection zones including 2 zones for panic and duress alarms, the control panel is designed for home and office protection.
The system gives local alarm warnings and is supplied with one alarm control panel and one master control keypad. Programmable
user codes, delays and alarm duration.
169
00
$
• Operating voltage: 16.5VDC
• Entry delay: 15 - 90 seconds
• Exit delay: 60 seconds
SAVE $30 00
• Alarm duration: 3 - 5 minutes or unlimited
• Alarm outputs: 12VDC, 2.5A
• Suitable backup battery: 12V, 7.2Ah
available separately - SB-2486 $34.95
• Suitable 17VAC plugpack: MP-3022 $24.95
• Dimensions: Control panel: 168(W) x 168(H) x 78(D)mm
Keypad: 117(W) x 117(H) x 27(D) mm
LA-5361
Note: This alarm panel includes a functional alarm dialler, however, it is not approved for use in Australia / New Zealand, as such we recommend that
you do not connect it to the telephone network. LA-5361 WAS $199.00 Limited Stock
www.jaycar.com.au
Rechargeable Solar DMM
Limited stock on sale items.
All Savings are based on Original RRP
Distance, area, volume or indirect
measurement, this does it all in metres,
feet or inches. It also adds, subtracts and
takes min/max measurements. Invaluable
for architects, estimators, builders or
renovators. Battery and case included.
199
00
• Backlit LCD
$
• Laser accuracy
• Dimensions: 110(L) x 47(W) x 28(H)mm
QM-1621
Outdoor IP65 Rated Tri-tech
Microwave/PIR Sensor
Most PIRS are generally not suitable for outdoor use. The dual
lenses, use of two synchronised PIR sensors and microwave
technologies, plus the movement detection algorithm built in
reduces false alarms and with the IP65 rating makes this
sensor suitable for outdoor security applications. It also has NO
and NC alarm outputs, tamper switch and LED alarm
trigger indicator. See website for specifications.
• All-in-one motion sensor
• Automatic background analysis
• Selectable PIR & microwave sensitivity $
• 12VDC power
• Dimensions: 168(H) x 95(W) x 65(D)mm
LA-5042
Swivel Bracket LA-5043 $19.95
149 00
Electromagnetic Door Locks
Compatible with any access control system, magnetic door
locks meet the most rigorous building and fire safety codes.
No moving parts, instantaneous release, holding force of
180kg or 280kg. They can be surface mounted or ZL and L
brackets provide for installation in wood, metal or glass doors.
Both operate from 12VDC and are finished in satin anodised
aluminium. Suitable for in-opening or out-opening doors,
mounting hardware and drilling templates included.
180kg Electromagnetic Door Lock
Size: 170(L) x 41(W) x 21(H)mm Cat. LA-5060 $79.95
ZL Bracket for LA-5060 Cat. LA-5061 $39.95
L Bracket for LA-5060 Cat. LA-5062 $24.95
280kg Electromagnetic Door Lock
Size: 250(L) x 49(W) x 25(H)mm
Cat. LA-5063 $99.00
ZL Bracket for LA-5063
Cat. LA-5064 $39.95
L Bracket for LA-5063
Cat. LA-5065 $24.95
TOOLS & SECURITY
Designed for recording and logging sound pressure
level measurements for quality control, illness prevention,
acoustic design or any other type of environmental
sound measurement in domestic or industrial
applications. The memory is able to record up to
129,920 samples with A or C weighting at
intervals from 1 second to 24 hours and
downloaded to a PC for later analysis.
Modified to calculate SPL via proper log
averaging rather than the inaccurate
00
$
arithmetic average used on the original
design. Battery and windsock included.
• Individually protected
PTC output
• Individual status LED
indicators
• 1 - 30V AC or DC input
• Dimensions: 138(L) x 65(W) x 28(H)mm
MP-3351
5
6
7" TFT Colour Monitors with Headrest
12VDC Voltage Polarity Easy Tester
With these 7" LCD colour monitor headrests, kids can watch the same movie on two different monitors, or
play different games on their X-Box® through the AV inputs. Both master and slave (sold separately) come
with a grey headrest, & both fit easily into your car seats. Finally Dad will be able to drive in peace!
7" TFT Colour Monitor with
Headrest and DVD Player
• MPEG4 functions
• Supports DivX / DVD / VCD / CD /
CDG / MP4 / MP3 / WMA / JPEG
• Game functions
(supports 8 bit & 32 bit game)
• Supports MS/MMC/SD cards
• Easy installation in most seats
• Headrest dimensions: 290(W) x
210(H) x 130(D)mm
QM-3776
7" TFT Colour Monitor
with Headrest
• Screen size: 7 inches
• Resolution: 234(H) x
480 (W) RGB
• Headrest dimensions:
270(W) x 190(H) x 140(D)mm
• Weight: 1300g
QM-3773
199
$
00
Flush Mount Mini Waterproof
Camera for Cars or Trucks
Designed for use in vehicles to give drivers a clear view of car
or truck blind spots. Composite RCA cable and the appropriate
sized hole saw included.
89 95
$
• Sensor: CMOS
• Resolution: 628 x 512 pixels
• Minimum illumination: 0 Lux / F1.2
• Camera dimensions: 31(L) x 20(W)mm
QC-3513
AUTO
Response Precision Car Amplifiers
With improved heat sinks and upgraded low-profile chassis
design, each model delivers surprising grunt and performance
in a sleek and compact package that fits neatly under a car
seat. All include gold plated power and speaker terminals and
variable low pass filters. Plus our class AB amps come with
variable high pass filters and pass through RCAs; while our
class D subwoofer amps feature variable subsonic filter, phase
shift and master/slave operation.
2 x 80WRMS Class AB Amplifier
Dimensions: 266(L) x
235(W) x 58(D)mm
AA-0450 $149.00
4 x 50WRMS Class AB Amplifier
Dimensions: 316(L) x 235(W) x 58(D)mm
AA-0451 $199.00
2 x 150WRMS Class AB Amplifier
Dimensions: 376(L) x 235(W) x 58(D)mm
AA-0452 $229.00
FROM
149 00
$
4 x 100WRMS Class
AB Amplifier
Dimensions: 436(L) x
235(W) x 58(D)mm
AA-0453 $299.00
500WRMS Linkable Class D Subwoofer Amplifier
Dimensions: 232(L) x 178(W) x 58(D)mm
AA-0454 $249.00
1000WRMS Linkable Class D
Subwoofer Amplifier
Dimensions: 306(L) x
178(W) x 58(D)mm
AA-0455 $369.00
Response Precision 4 x 100WRMS Full
Range Digital Amplifier
Dimensions: 306(L) x 178(W) x 58(D)mm
AA-0457 $349.00
12 Month
Warranty
Better, More Technical
269
$
A passive, quick and easy testing
solution that performs five essential
tests in the field: voltage, load,
polarity, voltage drop and continuity.
The load applied is selectable
between 1A or 500mA to test wiring
depending on location, device to be
tested, and anticipated voltage drop.
The illuminated power connector
clearly displays polarity. Ideal for CCTV
and security installers, car audio,
roadies, AV techs etc.
00
In-Dash MP3 Player with Radio
Listen to your favourite MP3s directly from the USB/SD card
slot. Featuring PLL tuner with 18FM/12 AM presets, and
MP3/WMA playback you will never miss a beat with this indash MP3
player.
• Front USB and SD card slot
• MP3 ID3 tag display
• 4 channels x 40W MAX power output
• 4 channels x 20W RMS power output
• 2 channels x 2V line-out
QM-3781
99 00
$
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
1 Watt LED Torch with In-built
Car Charger Plug
Low battery? No worries, this super-bright 1 watt LED torch
conveniently recharges in your car's cigarette lighter socket.
With a robust aluminium alloy housing it can take a
fair amount of abuse and still shine as
brightly as the day
you bought it.
19
• Dimensions:
160(L) x 35(Dia)mm
SL-3381
$
95
5-in-1 Inverter / Compressor / Work
Light / Charger / Jump Starter
Far more than your average jump starter this unit has an
impressive set of features for a hundred different uses. Tucked
in on either side are two tough insulated battery clamps for all
your jumpstarting needs, on the front panel you have 2 x
12VDC cigarette lighter sockets for operating 12V
appliances, a 5 LED worklight and two dial indicators
for air pressure and charge status.
Powered by the internal 12V
18Ah SLA battery, it even has
a 200W inverter to charge
your laptop, etc. See
Website for specifications.
• Dimensions: 220(L) x
215(W) x
295(H)mm
MB-3594
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
149 00
$
All Savings are based on Original RRP
Limited stock on sale items.
24 95
$
Dimensions: 51(L) x 44(W) x 29(H)mm
QP-2215
Vehicle LED Daytime
Running Lights
These Euro styled
superbright LED bulbs will
turn on automatically on
ignition, making your car
more noticeable on the
road. With a lifespan of 50,000
hours, these long life and energy saving DRLs
are a much better daytime alternative than using your fog
lights or low beam headlights. Flush-mounted brackets are
included for easy installation and directional tilt-adjustment.
149 00
$
• Energy efficient 12V 6.1W
• Emark 87R certificate
• Each lamp measures 190(W) x 30(H) x 43(D)mm
SL-3419
Low Voltage Battery Isolator
With microprocessor control, this indispensable device monitors
the output voltage of any 12V lead-acid battery. If the terminal
voltage drops below 11.9V, the battery will be automatically
disconnected. Essential for boats, camping, caravans, RVs, 4WD,
solar power systems etc.
99 95
$
• High cranking capacity - 800A
• High input/output current - 200A
• Low power consumption - 15mA
• 3 year warranty
• Mounting hardware included
• Dimensions: 85(H) x 55(W) x 35(D)mm
MB-3678
Three Stage 48V 9A Battery Charger
Suitable for golf buggies, electric wheelchairs or similar
applications. It monitors and manages your charging with
three different stages and will maintain the optimum charge
level. Compact and lightweight. Includes output cables with
eye terminals to attach to your battery.
• Switchable charging modes
• Short circuit, output
current, polarity
and thermal
protection
• LED charge
status indication
• Digital Charge Display
• Input: 190 - 260VAC
• Output: 48VDC <at> 9A max
• Dimensions: 298(L) x 112(W) x 60(H)mm
MB-3628
499 00
$
Great for
Golf Buggies
To order call 1800 022 888
7
Happy Father’s Day!
DON’T JUST
SIT THERE,
BUILD SOMETHING
High Power Wireless-N
USB 2.0 Network Adaptor
2 x USB 3.0 Port Upgrade Kit
Able to reach wireless networks from significant
distances with enough signal strength to do what you
need. The unit can connect to wireless networks up to
1.5km away. The supplied software provides you with
a myriad of specifications of wireless networks
broadcasting in your area.
69 95
$
Dimensions: 75(L) x
58(W) x 10(H)mm
Antenna: 172(H)mm
YN-8306
79 95
$
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
Dual 2.5/3.5" SATA HDD
Docking Station - USB 3.0
4 Port USB 3.0 Hub
USB 3.0 hub with four ports. 4.8Gbps
data rate. 10 x faster than USB 2.0.
• Dimensions: 85(L) x
32(W) x 18(H)mm
XC-4947
A blazing fast USB 3.0 ready dual
SATA docking station for the home or
office. Dock two 3.5 or 2.5 inch SATA
drives or one of each, and in a flash
you can back up gigabytes, terabytes
or petabytes of information without
the hassle of installing hard drives in
enclosures or in the PC.
79 95
$
USB 5-Button Laser Mouse
All the normal mouse functions - left and right click,
scrolling, plus forward, back and quick-launch button.
Ergonomically shaped for fatigue-free use.
Rechargeable Wireless
Optical Mouse
Enjoy complete freedom from the constraints of cables on your
workstation when mousing around. You can use rechargeable
batteries and charge via the USB lead or simply
use 2 x AA alkaline batteries. The USB dongle
stores away in the mouse's back door
when not in use.
Plug B to Socket A Adaptor
Micro B Plug to Socket A Adaptor
Socket A to Socket A Gender Changer
Plug Micro B to Socket B Adaptor
PA-0930 $12.95
PA-0931 $12.95
PA-0932 $12.95
PA-0933 $12.95
FROM
12 95
$
99 00
$
Mini 4 Port HUB USB 2.0
Collected a box full of hard drives over the years? Want a
simple way to access them? This adaptor is the perfect tool.
Older USB 2.0 SATA adaptors are unable to extract the full
3.0Gpbs transfer speed of SATA drives, so you're restricted to a
paltry 480Mpbs. This adaptor will give you the speed you need
to transfer large file in a fraction of the time.
(your PC must have a USB 3.0 port).
Compatible with Windows
2000/XP/Vista/
Win 7/MAC OS
95
9.X/10.X/Linux
$
XC-4145
79
29 95
$
2.5" SATA HDD Enclosure - USB 3.0
USB Optical Mini-Mouse
If you own a laptop or netbook, there's no doubt a
mouse is easier to use than a touchpad. Take this to school,
the office or on business trips. It's small enough
not to take up much space, but big enough
to be functional. Ideal for the kiddies
first starting to use computers too.
• Scrolling wheel
• Plug and play
• Compatible with Windows
2000, XP, Vista, 7
XM-5242
119 00
$
USB 3.0 Adaptors
USB 3.0 to 2.5/3.5"
HDD/SSD SATA Adaptor
95
• Plug and play
• Windows 2000, XP, Vista, 7
XM-5246
• Cold start feature
• Software included
• Rating: 375W, 600VA
• SLA battery: 7Ah
• Supply voltage 220 to 280VAC
• Backup time: 3 min at full load
• Recharge time: 10 hrs
• Output waveform: Step sine wave
• Dimensions: 268(L) x 180(W) x 80(H)mm
MP-5222
IT
17
Dimensions: 130(W) x
61(H) x 103(D)mm
XC-4697
Compact and completely self-contained, this is the ideal
backup solution for your data or other important equipment. It
has 3 surge-protected outlets as well as 3 outlets backed up
by the UPS. It also has RJ11 ports for
protecting phone or fax lines.
Note: HDD not included.
• Plug and play - no drivers required
• Windows 2000, XP, Vista, 7
XM-5240
$
Add two USB 3.0 ports to the front of your desktop PC for
compatibility with the next generation of superfast USB 3.0
hard drives, flash drives and other assorted peripherals. The
front panel will fit neatly into the 3.5" FDD slot
of most PC cases. Each port has a USB 3.0
cable running from the rear which
should be plugged into the
ports on the supplied
PCI-E card.
XC-4147
Line Interactive Uninterruptible
Power Supply (UPS - 600VA)
9
$ 95
www.jaycar.com.au
Take advantage of the massive speed increase of USB 3.0. Slot
a 2.5" SATA HDD into this enclosure and
when connected to a USB 3.0 port
of a computer you will
experience speeds up
to 10 times faster
than USB 2.0.
• Includes one 1.1m USB 3.0
Micro B - to Male A cable
• Locking screws included
• Dimensions: 77(W) x 113(L) x 14(D)mm
XC-4684
59 95
$
Limited stock on sale items.
All Savings are based on Original RRP
The perfect add-on to increase the number of USB ports on
your computer. This unit will allow up
to 4 USB peripherals to be
utilised without the loss of
speed. It is plug and play
with auto-detection and
safe removal from your USB port.
95
$
• 750mm USB interface lead supplied
$
• Hub measures: 83(W) x
SAVE 5 00
16(H) x 32(D)mm
Great Gift Idea
XC-4864 WAS $24.95
19
For Father’s Day
Switchmode Mains Adaptor
3 - 13.8VDC 2.5A
Variable desktop power
supply with binding post
and 7 DC plugs. 1.5 metre
lead with interchangeable
connectors.
• Output voltage: 3, 5, 6, 9, 12, 13,8VDC
• Output current: 2.5A max
• Dimensions: 140(L) x 80(W) x 42(H)mm
Approval number: SGSEA/100289
MP-3308
39 95
$
New TV Antennas
Indoor Flat Panel UHF/VHF Amplified Digital Antenna
Outdoor Flat Panel UHF/VHF Amplified Digital Antenna
This flat panel indoor amplified digital antenna features low
noise circuitry, multidirectional reception and auto gain control receiving both local free-to-air analogue and digital TV as well
as DAB+ digital radio signals with remarkable consistency and
crystal-clear clarity. Includes 6V 100mA mains adaptor and PAL
to F coaxial cable. Mount it either freestanding, on your wall or
even on your ceiling in either vertical or horizontal position. Its
shiny piano black finish will nicely complement your flat panel
LCD or plasma TV.
A versatile space-saving outdoor antenna that's ideal for apartments or when
antenna roof mounting is either too difficult or not an option. Once mounted
you can easily adjust vertical and tilt position to maximise reception strength.
With an integrated amplifier for enhanced reception clarity, it delivers local freeto-air analogue and digital TV as well as DAB+ digital radio programs. It also
features waterproof and weather resistant ABS housing, low noise circuitry,
multidirectional 360° reception and auto gain control. Includes mounting
bracket, 6V 100mA mains adaptor, and PAL to F coaxial cable.
• Panel size: 227(W) x 235(H) x 14(D)mm
LT-3131
49
$
Remote Controls
Universal VESA Adaptor
Universal Learning Remote
with A/C Control
• Backlit LCD
95
$
• Low battery indicator
• Audible reminder
• Requires 3 x AAA batteries
• Dimensions: 200(L) x 55(W) x 26(D)mm
AR-1726
37
24
Touchscreen 8 in 1 LCD Remote Control
For Father’s Day
This unit identifies over 40 preset popular air
conditioning brands with digital searching
but will also auto search for other brands not
so commonly used.
95
$
19
• Easy 3-step set up
SAVE $5 00
• Requires 2 x AAA batteries
• Dimensions: 130(H) x 55(W) x 22(D)mm
AR-1729 WAS $24.95
YOUR LOCAL JAYCAR STORE
Australia Freecall Orders: Ph 1800 022 888
AUSTRALIAN CAPITAL TERRITORY
Belconnen
Ph (02) 6253 5700
Fyshwick
Ph (02) 6239 1801
NEW SOUTH WALES
Albury
Ph (02) 6021 6788
Alexandria
Ph (02) 9699 4699
Bankstown
Ph (02) 9709 2822
Blacktown
Ph (02) 9678 9669
Bondi Junction Ph (02) 9369 3899
Brookvale
Ph (02) 9905 4130
Campbelltown Ph (02) 4620 7155
Coffs Harbour
Ph (02) 6651 5238
Croydon
Ph (02) 9799 0402
Erina
Ph (02) 4365 3433
Gore Hill
Ph (02) 9439 4799
Hornsby
Ph (02) 9476 6221
Liverpool
Ph (02) 9821 3100
Maitland
Ph (02) 4934 4911
Wall mount your DVD player or any
other component right under your
flat-screen TV. Tempered glass
shelves and black anodised
aluminium finish
to complement
modern décor. Also features cable
management.
Single or double shelf models:
Single Shelf CW-2830 $69.95
Double Shelf CW-2832 $99.95
DJ Mixing Essentials
2 Channel Pro DJ Mixer
49
Universal Air Conditioner
Remote Control
Glass Wall-Mount DVD Brackets
Adapt any VESA mounting TV to any bracket.
Many LCD or plasma brackets on the market are only designed
to take TVs with standard 200mm or larger mounting centres,
thereby limiting the range of brackets you can use with some
TVs. This handy adaptor solves the
problem by providing centres for
100, 200 and 300mm VESA
mounts. Solid steel construction,
black finish.
95
CW-2815
$
Pre-programmed with thousands of devices, and
able to learn and control up to 8 different devices
including the AV equipment & air conditioners.
Use the learning function or the preprogrammed code library to enrol each
component or use the macro functions to
program up to 100 keystrokes. For each
different device, the LCD backlight is colour
coded for easy recognition and you can change
the device key layout as you like. Requires 4 x
AAA batteries.
95
$
• Size: 195(L) x
SAVE $10 00
65(W) x 21(H)mm
AR-1728 WAS $59.95
Great Gift Idea
69 95
$
• Panel size: 281(W) x 305(H) x 20(D)mm
LT-3139
Also available New Outdoor Omni-Directional UHF/VHF Amplified Digital Antenna LT-3141 $89.95
95
The ideal mixer to learn on. Two channels each with
RCA inputs for CD or other line level source and a set
of dedicated phono inputs. The BPM counter is
capable of accurately measuring the beats per
minute of almost any kind of dance music
automatically and works
equally
well with
a CD
player or a
turntable.
• Level
meters on
each channel
• 2 band EQ on each channel
• Phono and line level inputs
• Mic and headphone outputs
• Selectable CF curve
• Dimensions: 330(W) x
22(H) x 102(D)mm
AM-4206
Newcastle
Ph (02) 4965 3799
Penrith
Ph (02) 4721 8337
Rydalmere
Ph (02) 8832 3120
Sydney City
Ph (02) 9267 1614
Taren Point
Ph (02) 9531 7033
Tweed Heads
Ph (07) 5524 6566
Wollongong
Ph (02) 4226 7089
NORTHERN TERRITORY
Darwin
Ph (08) 8948 4043
QUEENSLAND
Aspley
Ph (07) 3863 0099
Caboolture
Ph (07) 5432 3152
Cairns
Ph (07) 4041 6747
Capalaba
Ph (07) 3245 2014
Ipswich
Ph (07) 3282 5800
Labrador
Ph (07) 5537 4295
Mackay
Ph (07) 4953 0611
Maroochydore Ph (07) 5479 3511
Mermaid Beach Ph (07) 5526 6722
Nth Rockhampton Ph (07) 4926 4155
Arrival dates of new products in this flyer were confirmed at the time
of print. Occasionally these dates change unexpectedly. Please ring your
local store to check stock details. Prices valid to 23rd September 2010.
All savings are based on original RRP
DJ Skills Mixing and Scratching Guide
Explores the history of the DJ from the radio
jock to the hip-hop, rave and club generation,
and the influence of jazz and other music forms
on the modern DJ. It also covers tools of the
trade - turntables, hard disks, drum machines,
effects and mixers, as well as the skills to
become a working DJ.
• Softcover, 282 pages
• 240 x 190mm.
BA-1445
44 95
$
Great Gift Idea
For Father’s Day
USB Turntable with USB Direct Encoding
Transfer your vinyl collection directly to your USB device. Technology
has never been easier. Simply play your records, plug your USB device
in and click record. When finished click record again and your music is
stored onto your USB - Too easy. Finished in chrome and black.
• 2 speed belt drive turntable
• 33 1/3 and 45 RPM
• Anti-skating control
• Motor off and reverse function
• RCA Phono/line output
• Dimensions : 449(W) x
00
$
145(H) x 370(D) x mm
AA-0494
149 00
$
249
Townsville
Underwood
Woolloongabba
SOUTH AUSTRALIA
Adelaide
Clovelly Park
Gepps Cross
TASMANIA
Hobart
Launceston
VICTORIA
Cheltenham
Coburg
Frankston
Geelong
Hallam
Melbourne
Ringwood
Shepparton
Springvale
Sunshine
Ph (07) 4772 5022
Ph (07) 3841 4888
Ph (07) 3393 0777
Ph (08) 8231 7355
Ph (08) 8276 6901
Ph (08) 8262 3200
Ph (03) 6272 9955
Ph (03) 6334 2777
Ph (03) 9585 5011
Ph (03) 9384 1811
Ph (03) 9781 4100
Ph (03) 5221 5800
Ph (03) 9796 4577
Ph (03) 9663 2030
Ph (03) 9870 9053
Ph (03) 5822 4037
Ph (03) 9547 1022
Ph (03) 9310 8066
Head Office
320 Victoria Road, Rydalmere NSW 2116
Ph: (02) 8832 3100 Fax: (02) 8832 3169
Thomastown
Werribee
WESTERN AUSTRALIA
Maddington
Midland
Northbridge
Rockingham
NEW ZEALAND
Christchurch
Dunedin
Glenfield
Hamilton
Hastings
Manukau
Mt Wellington
Newmarket
New Lynn
Palmerston Nth
Wellington
NZ Freecall Orders
Online Orders
Website: www.jaycar.com.au
Email: techstore<at>jaycar.com.au
Ph (03) 9465 3333
Ph (03) 9741 8951
Ph (08) 9493 4300
Ph (08) 9250 8200
Ph (08) 9328 8252
Ph (08) 9592 8000
Ph (03) 379 1662
Ph (03) 471 7934
Ph (09) 444 4628
Ph (07) 846 0177
Ph (06) 876 0239
Ph (09) 263 6241
Ph (09) 258 5207
Ph (09) 377 6421
Ph (09) 828 8096
Ph (06) 353 8246
Ph (04) 801 9005
Ph 0800 452 922
SERVICEMAN'S LOG
Electros with lumpy bits are not good
Faulty electrolytic capacitors have been a
common problem in electronics gear over the
last few years. In fact, some items only just
make it through warranty before their power
supply electros develop lumpy bits and fail.
Marilyn asked me to look at her
DGTEC DG-HD03 set-top box (STB).
The unit was barely 18 months old
but the display was now stubbornly
showing “8888” and nothing else. It
wouldn’t respond to commands from
the remote and there was no output
signal.
It hadn’t been a sudden failure.
Instead, the unit had become increasingly intermittent in operation over a
period of several weeks before finally
packing it in. Marilyn had tried to clear
the fault by switching it off and on at
the wall socket to reboot the firmware
but it made no difference.
The unit was located in a TV cabinet
in the living room. It rested on top of
the DVD player which in turn sat on a
shelf below the TV set. And one thing
I noticed as it was being retrieved was
that there wasn’t a lot of space between
the STB and the shelf above it.
That meant that the ventilation
wasn’t all that great but at the time,
I mentally dismissed this as being a
factor. These devices don’t consume
much power, especially on standby,
so overheating shouldn’t have been a
problem (or so I thought).
My initial reaction was that the fault
might be due to “crook” electrolytic
capacitors, probably in the power supply. I’ve lost count of the number of
devices I’ve repaired over the years
This close-up view shows the output side of the switchmode power supply. The
five faulty electros with the bulging tops are arrowed.
siliconchip.com.au
Items Covered This Month
•
•
•
•
DGTEC DG-HD03 set-top box
Hot over coolant
The bouncing modem
Front-panel USB socket woes
simply by replacing faulty electros.
They’re usually quite easy to spot too
– they’re the ones with the bulging
(domed) tops.
I told Marilyn that if it was something obvious such as faulty electros,
then fixing it shouldn’t be a problem.
But if it wasn’t obvious, then it would
be a “bin job” as the fault would be
virtually impossible to track down,
especially on a double-sided PC board
with lots of surface-mount parts (and
no circuit diagram).
When it came time to tackle the
unit, I confirmed the symptoms and
checked that the batteries in the remote
were OK. I then removed the case lid
and took a peek inside. This revealed
two PC boards – a power supply board
and a much larger main board which
carried the microcontroller, digital
tuner, support circuitry and the various input and output sockets. And the
fault was glaringly obvious – five electrolytic capacitors with bulging tops
on the power supply board!
The other thing that struck me was
that the varnish on the top of the power
supply board had discoloured around
many of the components. So it looked
like it had been running hot after all
and this had undoubtedly contributed
The two 1000µF capacitors had
overheated and their rubber seals
were separating from the cans.
September 2010 57
Serr v ice
Se
ceman’s
man’s Log – continued
This view shows the rebuilt power
supply board from the DGTEC
set-top box. All the electros except
for the one at bottom left were
replaced.
to the premature failure of the electros.
The five capacitors in question were
all branded “JFD” and were sleeved in
brown heatshrink. They were rated at
105°C and ranged in value from 220µF
(16V) up to 1000µF (10V).
It was the two 1000µF units that had
fared the worst. They had become so
hot that their rubber seals had been
partially ejected from the cans, leaving
them sitting at odd angles on the power
supply board (see photo).
Another six JFD-branded electros
on this board appeared to be OK but
obviously the best course of action was
to replace the lot. If five out of the 11
had failed, the rest probably wouldn’t
be far behind.
The power supply board is easy to
remove – just unplug the wiring assemblies, remove four M3 machine
screws and lift it out of the case. This
revealed that there were also a lot of
surface-mount parts on the underside.
However, this side of the board appeared to be OK, so it was worth tak-
58 Silicon Chip
ing a gamble on replacing the suspect
capacitors.
This is where my vacuum desoldering station really earns its keep. It
makes removing parts a snack and it
took only a few minutes to replace all
the original electros with good-quality
105°C units (low-ESR types would
have been preferable all round but I
only had some of these). The unit was
then quickly reassembled and tested
with an old analog TV.
And that fixed the problem. The unit
immediately fired up, responded to the
remote and gave perfect pictures on
all channels. In fact, the DGTEC DGHD03 is quite a nice unit – it’s built
into a sturdy steel case, looks good, is
easy to drive and comes with a solid
remote control, unlike the cheap and
nasty remotes you get with some settop boxes.
So did the original electros fail because the unit overheated due to poor
ventilation? Or were they inadequately
rated for the job or was it a combination of both?
Certainly, 18 months is a pretty poor
service life but it’s an all too common
occurrence with electrolytic capacitors these days. I’ve fished bulging
electros out of everything from computer motherboards to ADSL modems to
DVD players and this happens so often
that you really have to wonder about
the quality of some of these capacitors.
Just out of curiosity, I checked the
power consumption of the unit. This
gave figures of 9.5W when the unit was
on and just 0.77W on standby. The unit
had always been switched to standby
when it wasn’t being used but being
in the living area, it had also had its
fair share of use. These units can run
hot, so the lack of ventilation would
not have helped, especially on a hot
summer’s day.
Anyway, I returned the unit to Mar
ilyn with the suggestion that the unit
be placed on top of the TV set, to give
it plenty of air. Electrolytic capacitors
with lumpy bits are not good.
The bouncing modem
It’s not only set-top boxes that
have problems with bulging electros.
They’ve long been a problem in modems as well, as this story from A. P.
of Toowoomba, Qld illustrates . . .
This story began about a year ago
when I replaced some bulging and
leaking electrolytic capacitors in a
Thomson Speedtouch 536 ADSL2
modem belonging to my friend Nick.
This time, it seemed that Nick was
having trouble with his phone line.
Certainly, when he called me, his voice
was overlaid by a distinct hissing noise
and it was apparently worse at his end.
He told me that the previous day he
had submitted an online order to upgrade his Bigpond internet plan from
ADSL1 to ADSL2+ but had not yet
received any confirmation of when this
would happen. He had also updated
his modem’s firmware to ensure compatibility with ADSL2+. Could either
of these things be causing the hiss?
I was a little surprised at this because we had discussed the possibility
of him upgrading to ADSL2+ a few
days before. At that time, I had checked
the availability of ADSL2+ on Nick’s
line by entering his phone number into
the web form Bigpond provides for
this purpose. It had come up negative.
I now repeated this check while we
were on the phone and got the same
result. As a result, I told Nick that his
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
ACOUSTICS
SB
proposed upgrade to ADSL2+ probably wasn’t feasible
and would be rejected. I also rejected the hypothesis
that the problem with Nick’s phone was related to the
ADSL2+ software upgrade to his modem.
I then suggested that we should make sure that the
problem lay in his phone line before we called Telstra
to report a fault. And so I called in to his place that
afternoon and we started our investigations.
Nick’s house has three phone outlets, each with an
in-line ADSL filter. There are phone handsets in the
bedroom and lounge, while the outlet in the study
is shared by another phone handset and the ADSL
modem.
We began by checking the modular connectors on all
the phones and filters and found that all the contacts
were clean. We then tried different permutations of the
phones and soon discovered that the hiss disappeared
when we disconnected the phones in the bedroom and
lounge. However, there was also no hiss when just the
bedroom and lounge phones were connected and the
study phone and modem were disconnected.
This all indicated a loading problem but at which
end? Either the Telstra line had developed a fault or one
of the devices connected to the phone line had become
faulty and was imposing a higher load than normal.
Unfortunately, it wasn’t possible to eliminate any
given device, because we didn’t have any spare phones
to connect to the line. Nevertheless, I was suspicious
of the modem. About a year previously, I had replaced
six bulging and leaking CapXon brand capacitors in
its power supply section and drilled extra ventilation
holes to keep the new capacitors cool. However, I had
an uneasy feeling about the replacement capacitors.
They were an unknown brand at the time and although
they were rated for the job, I was unsure of their quality.
Driven by curiosity as much as anything else, I
cracked open the case of the modem and immediately
spotted a problem. Two of the new 105°C Suntan capacitors I had installed – one 470µF and one 1000µF
– were bulging and leaking! Fortunately, I had brought
a spare modem with me as a precaution and in minutes it was installed and working. There was just one
problem – the hiss remained and was as bad as ever.
I didn’t believe that we had two faulty modems with
identical symptoms, so it now looked very likely that
the phone line itself was faulty. But first, I now reconsidered the possibility that Bigpond had switched on
the ADSL2+ in spite of all the evidence to the contrary.
However, this seemed unlikely as they hadn’t even
dynamica
September 2010 59
Serr v ice
Se
ceman’s
man’s Log – continued
confirmed Nick’s order yet, let alone
notified him that the ADSL2+ had been
activated. And of course, their own
service availability form was telling
us that ADSL2+ wasn’t available at
his address.
Next, I looked at the ADSL in-line
filters Nick was using. They were all
C10 Model C10245E types. I then
checked the filters that had come in
the box with the Bigpond ADSL2+
modem I had just installed. These
were C10 Model C10245M types but
for some reason, I failed to register that
the model numbers were different. I
did swap the filter in the study for one
of the new filters but only in case the
study filter was faulty.
When this didn’t fix the problem
I took my leave, suggesting to Nick
that the fault was almost certainly in
the line and that he should report it
to Telstra.
Two days later Nick called me to tell
me the outcome and this time there
was no hiss accompanying his voice.
Telstra had tested the line and found
no problem. Apparently, Bigpond had
turned on ADSL2+ the day after Nick
ordered it and the Telstra technician
who came to investigate told Nick that
the C10245E filters were not suitable
for ADSL2+. As a goodwill measure,
he had installed an ADSL2+ central
line filter without charge and this fixed
the hiss problem.
With 20:20 hindsight, I looked up
the FAQ on the www.c10.com.au
website which explains that, in some
cases, connecting multiple in-line
filters to an ADSL2+ line results in
“noise on the telephone”. The newer
“M” series filters (such as those supplied with my ADSL2+ modem) were
designed to eliminate this problem.
As for Nick’s Speedtouch modem,
I replaced the faulty capacitors with
good-quality Hitano units and now
expect it to survive into obsolescence.
Hot over coolant
This next story is from M. S. of Niddrie, Victoria who installs and services
car stereo systems. Here it is . . .
I recently repaired a CD stacker that
was installed in a 1995 Ford Falcon.
I’d had this stacker out for about two
weeks while waiting for the parts to
turn up and had then re-installed it
after it had been fixed.
Unfortunately, that wasn’t to be the
last I would hear from this particular
customer. About a week later, he rang
to tell me that the engine in the car was
now overheating when he accelerated
or it was working under load.
So what did this have to
do with me? Well, despite
the fact that I had only
worked on his CD player,
he was blaming me for this
completely unrelated mechanical
problem. His reason? – I was the last
person to work on the car, so it had to
be my fault.
Anyway, he brought the car back
and I removed the CD stacker (which
was still working OK). I then checked
all the earths in the car (they could
be a problem in earlier models but
these were OK) before refitting the
CD stacker.
When he returned, I asked him if
any other work had been done on
the car. His answer was that it had
had a full service but the overheating
problem had only started when the CD
stacker was refitted. And according to
his convoluted logic, that meant that
I was to blame.
I protested that refitting the stacker
could not possibly cause this problem
and suggested he take the car to a mechanic to get what was clearly an unrelated fault diagnosed and repaired.
However, this guy was not prepared to
accept that and now goes to Consumer
Affairs to get further satisfaction.
As a result, Consumer Affairs ordered further checks on the car via
two motoring organisations and a wellknown technical institute. The Institute found that the oil and fuel were
within the manufacturer’s specifications but that too much of the wrong
coolant had been used. This incorrect
coolant was changing the resistance of
the temperature sensor as the flow rate
increased with engine RPM.
So the engine wasn’t overheating
after all – the gauge just indicated that
it was. And that certainly had nothing
to do with the CD stacker repair.
As for getting a full service done by
a qualified mechanic, I don’t believe
that happened. Instead, this bloke did
what many people do with old cars –
he serviced it himself and it was he
who used the wrong coolant.
I wasted a lot of time on this job,
trying to figure out what might have
gone wrong. Unfortunately, some people will try anything to get something
for nothing. It makes me wonder how
they sleep at night!
Front-panel USB socket woes
Probably because of the way the
cables are so often roughly yanked
out of them, USB sockets can cause all
sorts of problems on PCs. This story
of one such case comes from D. S. of
Maryborough, Qld . . .
The Serviceman’s story on USB
60 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
woes in the July 2010 issue of SILICON
CHIP reminded me of a somewhat troublesome repair which arrived on my
bench some months ago. It concerned
a home-built desktop PC that used a
Gigabyte EP43-US3L motherboard,
4GB of RAM and an Intel CPU. It had
been neatly assembled but after working correctly for quite some time, had
now developed a fault.
The issue was that when the power
switch was pressed, the supply would
power up, the CPU fan would start and
all the associated LEDs on the board
and case would light – but only for
about one second! The supply would
then shut down and would not restart
unless the mains supply was switched
off and then back on, whereupon it
would exhibit exactly the same symptoms all over again.
I started by disconnecting the power
supply and then plugging my ATX
supply tester into it. This nifty little
device activates the supply and has
a small LCD screen which displays
all the relevant voltages. In this case,
the supply came to life and all the
voltages where well within limits and
rock steady.
My scope also confirmed the absence of ripple which can at times
upset the supply or the motherboard.
So the supply was good!
Next, I turned my attention to the
motherboard. I reconnected the supply to the motherboard but left all the
hard drives and optical drives disconnected, along with the case fans and
the light show around the front panel
Servicing Stories Wanted
Do you have any good servicing stories that you would like to share in
The Serviceman column in SILICON CHIP?
If so, why not send those stories in to us? In doesn’t matter what the
story is about as long as it’s in some way related to the electronics or
electrical industries, to computers or even to car electronics.
We pay for all contributions published but please note that your material
must be original. Send your contribution by email to:
editor<at>siliconchip.com.au
and be sure to include your full name and address details.
(just why this area of the case is lit is
beyond me. I tend to look at my monitor when using my PC, not the case).
However, when the power switch was
pressed, the supply again quickly shut
down. It was time to delve a bit deeper.
I have had issues with CPUs in the
past so I substituted the CPU for a
known good unit and tried again. It
still powered down within about a
second so I tried disconnecting the
reset button, again without result. I
then removed the RAM and the 12V
ATX connector (the board will power
up but not run if this connector is left
disconnected) but it was still shutting
down.
By this stage, I just had the motherboard with nothing but the main
24-pin power connector and two offboard USB connectors plugged in.
And then it hit me – the USB ports in
the front of the case use a 5V supply
from the motherboard! I yanked the
USB connectors off the board, hit the
power switch again and the system
sprang into life.
After shutting it down, I reconnected everything except the front-panel
USB ports and rebooted. The system
booted perfectly, so the front USB ports
were the culprits.
Closer examination revealed that the
internal contacts of one of these USB
ports was damaged and in contact with
the metal surround. This was shorting the 5V supply to ground and the
motherboard was detecting this and
shutting down the supply to prevent
damage.
In hindsight, I probably should have
checked the “Pwr Good” signal but all
it would have told me was that the
supply was being shut down by the
safety circuits, not why.
Unfortunately, I was unable to buy
a replacement USB sub-board. As a
result, I advised the owner to purchase
a USB hub with its own power pack
SC
and use that instead.
New Lower DSO Prices for 2010!
Shop
On-Line
at
emona.com.au
GW GDS-1022 25MHz
RIGOL DS-1052E 50MHz
RIGOL DS-1102E 100MHz
25MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
250MS/s Real Time Sampling
USB Device & SD Card Slot
50MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
USB Device, USB Host & PictBridge
100MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
USB Device, USB Host & PictBridge
Sydney
Brisbane
Perth
ONLY $499 inc GST
Melbourne
Tel 02 9519 3933
Tel 03 9889 0427
Fax 02 9550 1378
Fax 03 9889 0715
email testinst<at>emona.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
ONLY $713 inc GST
Tel 07 3275 2183
Fax 07 3275 2196
Adelaide
Tel 08 8363 5733
Fax 08 8363 5799
ONLY $966 inc GST
Tel 08 9361 4200
Fax 08 9361 4300
web www.emona.com.au
EMONA
September 2010 61
This receiver is designed to pick up the signal from a hearing
loop and will drive a pair of headphones. You can use it
with a hearing loop you install in your own home or with
commercial loops already installed in halls and churches.
HEARING
LOOP
RECEIVER
By JOHN CLARKE
E
Connect a hearing loop to your TV or stereo system, use
lsewhere in this issue we introduce the concept of
hearing loops for those with hearing loss. They’re this Hearing Loop Receiver and an earbud or two – and
specifically intended for use with hearing aids fitted they will be able to hear everything in the program, with
no need to have the volume cranked up!
with T-coils (the other article explains T-coils).
But there are many people in the community who have
hearing loss and, for various reasons (cost, denial and van- Our Hearing Loop Receiver
It’s housed in a small case which can attach to a belt or slip
ity are the main ones!) don’t own or want a hearing aid,
into a pocket, so it’s fully self-contained. The user can walk
particularly one of the more advanced types.
This project, in fact this whole series of related projects, is around without the sudden jolt of reaching the end of a headphone lead! It’s
intended for them
equipped with
– and anyone else
a power switch,
who “suffers in siCurrent Consumption............10mA
power on LED,
lence” (or perhaps
volume control
suffers in muffles!). Frequency response..............-3dB at 100Hz with stereo 32Ω headphones
and of course a
You might have ..............................................connected. Upper response to beyond 5kHz
standard 3.5mm
experienced it in
jack outlet for
your own house- Signal to noise ratio.............-67dB A-weighted with respect to a 400mA/m
headphones or
hold: someone who (with stereo 32-ohm .............field strength and VR1 at mid setting.
earphones.
wants the TV or headphones connected)........Noise is dependent upon background
Current constereo turned up ..............................................environmental noise from mains wiring
sumption is
beyond everyone ..............................................and equipment
about 10mA,
else’s comfort level
which should
so they can hear it. Battery voltage indication.....Down to 7V
Specifications
62 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
give up to 40 hours of use before the
9V battery needs to be changed (a rechargeable battery could be used). The
power LED also functions as a battery
indicator where its initial brightness
when power is applied is dependent
upon battery voltage.
By now, we hope you’ve read the
article in this issue on the design and
installation of a hearing loop. That will
give you a much better understanding
of how the Hearing Loop Receiver
works, so we won’t go into a lot of
detail here.
But if you haven’t seen that article,
a hearing loop at its most basic simply consists of a loop of wire around
a room, driven by a standard audio
amplifier. The magnetic field it produces induces the audio signal into
a coil in a hearing aid equipped with
a T-Coil or in this case, our Hearing
Loop Receiver.
Circuit description
The circuit for the Hearing Loop Receiver is shown in Fig.1. It comprises
two low-cost ICs plus a handful of
other low-cost parts.
The magnetic field from the hearing loop is detected using inductor
L1. This is actually the secondary
winding of a standard Xenon flash
tube trigger transformer (eg, Jaycar
MM2520). Because of the very large
number of turns, it has a high inductance – around 8.2mH. Best of all, it is
quite cheap and is suitable for the task
of hearing loop monitoring.
One side of L1 is biased at about
+4.05V using two 10kΩ resistors connected in series across the 8.1V supply. A 100F capacitor bypasses this
half-supply. The 4.05V rail biases the
output of IC1b so that its output can
swing symmetrically within the available power supply rail.
Tying one side of the transformer
secondary winding to the +4.05V
supply means that it is effectively
grounded while the other end of the
winding provides the signal to op amp
IC1b. The DC resistance of inductor L1
is 27Ω, presenting a low source impedance at low frequencies to the noninverting input of IC1b and thereby
minimising low-frequency noise.
A 2.2kΩ resistor is connected in parallel with L1 to lower the inductor’s Q
and prevent the possibility of oscillation. The 220pF capacitor that shunts
high frequency signals to ground also
assists in this. Furthermore, the input
siliconchip.com.au
It’s all housed inside a “remote control” case which is small enough to fit into a
pocket, or clip to a belt via an optional clip. So if Grandpa forgets he’s wearing
it and gets up to walk around, he won’t leave his head back in his easy chair!
of each amp stage has a 10Ω “stopper”
resistor to help prevent oscillation.
Any signal induced in L1 will rise in
level with frequency, at about 6dB per
octave, because the induced voltage is
proportional to the rate of change of
the magnetic field.
To compensate for this and to provide a flat frequency response, a 33nF
capacitor across the 100kΩ feedback
resistor, between pins 6 & 7 of IC1b,
rolls off signal above about 50Hz at
6dB/octave. This counteracts the rise
in response from the inductor. At the
same time, the frequency response is
rolled off below 16Hz using the se-
ries connected 1kΩ resistor and 10F
capacitor between pin 6 and ground.
Op amp IC1a provides the second
stage of gain, adjustable via the 10kΩ
trimpot, VR1. In the trimpot’s minimum position, the maximum gain is
101, as set by the 100kΩ and 1kΩ resistors. Minimum gain of about 10 is
available when VR1 is set at maximum.
Because of VR1, the low frequency
rolloff at maximum gain is 16Hz (the
same as for IC1b) and 1.45Hz at minimum gain.
Further frequency rolloff is provided by the 330pF capacitor across
the 100kΩ feedback resistor. This rolls
September 2010 63
D1 1N5819
150
+8.1V
+8.7V
POWER
LED1
470 F
10k
K
2.2k
L1 8.2mH
ZD1
4.7V
10
6
IC1b
7
10
4
3
2
IC1a
220pF
100 F
100k
10k
33nF
100k
330pF
1k
1k
1
VR1
10k
10 F
S1
POWER
K
D2
1N4148
K
9V
BATTERY
A
1k
A
IC1: TL072
8
5
A
K
A
470 F
470 F
27k
10 F
VR2
10k
LOG
LEVEL
100nF
6
3
VOLUME
2
1
IC2
LM386N
8
10
5
100 F
T
7
10
4
LK1
R
10 F
10 F
TO 32
HEADPHONES
S
47nF
3.5mm
STEREO
SOCKET
LED
1N4148
SC
2010
HEARING LOOP RECEIVER
A
ZD1
A
K
K
1N5819
A
K
K
A
Fig.1: the electromagnetic signal radiated by the hearing loop in the building is “intercepted” by inductor L1, which is
then amplified and processed by IC1 before being fed to audio amplifier IC2, which drives the headphones.
off signals above about 4.8kHz.
Next, the signal passes through a 10F coupling capacitor to the 10kΩ volume control, VR2. This sets the level
the of signal applied to the LM386 audio power amplifier,
IC2. This can provide up to about 500mW into 8Ω with a
9V supply, with distortion typically 0.2%.
When using stereo 32Ω headphones, the power is about
250mW; more than adequate for headphone listening.
Note that both left and right headphones are connected
in parallel, via link LK1.
IC2 has a gain of 20 and its power supply is bypassed
with a 470F capacitor. The separate 10F bypass at pin 7
removes supply ripple from the amplifier’s input stages. A
Zobel network comprising a series 10Ω resistor and 47nF
capacitor prevents amplifier instability.
The LM386 drives the headphones via a 10Ω resistor
Controls are simple: just a power switch and volume. Most
3.5mm phones/ear buds will be fine. The large “block” at
the back of the case is an optional belt clip so the unit can
easily be worn around.
64 Silicon Chip
and 100F capacitor. The 100F capacitor provides low
frequency rolloff below 61Hz, assuming that 32Ω stereo
headphones are used.
The circuit is powered by a 9V battery, while diode D1
provides protection against reverse polarity connection
(which is quite easy to do with a 9V battery).
LED battery condition indicator
LED1 functions as a battery condition indicator, as well
as showing when the Receiver is on.
When power is first applied, current for the LED flows
through the 4.7V zener diode ZD1, the 1kΩ resistor and
the discharged 470F capacitor.
If the battery is fresh, the 9V battery provides 8.7V at the
anode of LED1. This voltage is reduced by about 1.8V by
LED1 and by 4.7V with ZD1, leaving 2.2V across the 1kΩ
resistor. So LED1 lights with a current of 2.2mA.
At lower battery voltages, there is less voltage across the
1kΩ resistor so the LED is dimmer. At a battery voltage of
7V, there is about 0.2V across the 1kΩ resistor and the LED
barely lights.
With LED current flow, the 470F capacitor charges up
so that the LED current is reduced. A 27kΩ resistor across
the 470F capacitor ensures that the LED stays lit but at a
low current that allows it to be still visible. This indicates
that the power is on and means that battery voltage testing
happens only at power up. When the receiver is switched
off, diode D2 discharges the 470F capacitor.
The 8.7V supply is used directly by IC2 but it is fed to
IC1 via a 150Ω resistor. A 470F capacitor decouples this
supply and prevents any supply modulation from affecting
siliconchip.com.au
IC1, which could cause instability.
Construction
10k
10
150
IC2
LM386
ZD1
4V7
10k
100k
IC1
TL072
100k
9V BATTERY
220pF
10 F
1k
1k
330pF
4148
0 1 6 0A H CJ
27k
RELPU O C/REVIE CER P O OL
5819
D1
D2
The Hearing Loop Receiver is
LED1
constructed on a PC board coded
S
VR2
T
01209101 and measuring 65 x
R
S1
86mm. The PC board and comCON1
ponents are housed in a “remote
100nF
control” case measuring 135 x 70
LK1
x 24mm. Panel labels attach to the
100 F
front edge of the box and on the
470 F 10 F
47nF
front face.
The PC board is designed to fit
10 F
onto the mounting bushes within
10
the box. Make sure the front edge
of the PC board is shaped to the cor100 F
470 F
rect outline so it fits into the box.
It can be filed to shape if necessary
L1
using the PC board outline shape
as a guide.
33nF
This PC board can also be used to
10
470 F
build the Hearing Loop Neck Loop
1k
Coupler (which we will describe
+ –
2.2k
in a future issue) since most of the
VR1
+
10k
parts are the same. However, there
10
10 F
will be a few unused component
holes in the PC board for the Hearing Loop Receiver.
Begin construction by checking
the PC board for breaks in tracks
or shorts between tracks and pads.
Repair if necessary. Check the hole
size for the PC board mounting and
for the 9V battery leads. These are
3mm in diameter.
Assembly can begin by soldering in the two PC stakes,
followed by the resistors. Use the resistor colour code table
and/or a digital multimeter to help in confirming the resistor values. The diodes can now be installed, mounted with
the orientation as shown.
IC1 & IC2 can be now be installed, either directly on
the PC board or mounted on DIP8 sockets (which makes
removal easier if necessary). When installing sockets or ICs,
orient them using the notch positioned as shown.
Install the 2-way header (LK1), followed by the capacitors. Make sure the capacitors are placed on the PC board
so their height above the board is no more than 12.5mm,
otherwise the lid of the case will not fit correctly. Electrolytic types must be oriented with the shown polarity.
Trimpot VR1 and inductor L1 are next. Note the third
wire of L1 is soldered to a spare pad on the PC board. Switch
S1, potentiometer VR2 and the 3.5mm stereo socket can
be soldered in next.
LED1 mounts horizontally but at a height of 6mm above
the PC board. Bend its leads down 90°, 12mm from the
base of the LED, making sure the anode lead is to the left.
To install the 9V battery clip, firstly pass the wires through
from the battery compartment side of the case and loop the
wires through the holes in the PC board. This secures the
wires ready to be soldered to the PC stakes.
Four 6mm M3 screws secure the PC board to the integral
mounting bushes in the box. However, before fitting, you
will need to drill out the small holes for the switch, LED,
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.2 (above left) shows the component
layout on the PC board, with a matching
photo alongside. Ignore the unused holes
in the board – they’re for another project
in the series! The photo below shows
how it all fits together inside the case.
September 2010 65
Parts List – Hearing
Loop Receiver
Fig.3 (right) the front panel label,
reproduced here same size, depicts
the Hearing Loop symbol. Itself
adapted from the international
“hearing assistance” symbol (with
the added “T”), it is displayed
wherever a hearing loop is
installed. In many cases, there will
also be raised Braille dots giving the
same message to blind people.
Headphones Volume
Power
Fig.4: this label is glued to the top
panel of the receiver
volume pot and headphone socket in
the top panel. A 1:1 photocopy of the
label makes a good template for drill
hole positions.
Panel labels for this project can be
downloaded from the Silicon Chip
website (www.siliconchip.com.au).
Go to the downloads section and select
the month and year of publication.
The file can be printed out using stationery suitable for your printer. Some
choices would be adhesive-backed
photo paper, ordinary bond paper
which could be laminated and glued
onto the panel, or perhaps plastic film
such as overhead projector film. If
you use the latter, print the label as a
mirror-image so that the ink is behind
the film when placed onto the panel
(that protects the label). Once the ink
is dry, cut the label to size.
The plastic film can be glued to the
panel using an even smear of neutralcure silicone. If you are using a black
coloured panel, use coloured silicone
such as grey or white so the label has
contrast. For panels that are off white
or aluminium the silicone sealant can
be clear.
Cut the holes out in the panel using
a sharp hobby knife.
Testing
Apply power and check that the
power LED lights. There should be
about 8.1V between pins 4 and 8 of
IC1 (assuming a 9V battery supply).
IC2 should have about 8.7V between
pins 4 and 6.
If these tests are OK, plug in a pair
of headphones and apply the “blurt”
test: touch the inductor (L1) terminal
on the lower section of the PC board.
There should be a “blurt” noise in the
headphones if the volume is turned up.
Final testing can be made with the
Hearing Loop Receiver and a Hearing
Loop. Note that the receiver needs to
be at right angles to the loop, ie, for a
normal horizontally mounted loop, the
receiver is held vertical. Trimpot VR1
is adjusted so that the volume range
for VR2 is suitable without allowing
the volume level to be adjusted to
excessive levels.
If you require a belt clip for the receiver, the Altronics H0349 belt clip is
suitable (www.altronics.com.au). SC
Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
No. Value
2
100kΩ
1
27kΩ
2
10kΩ
1
2.2kΩ
3
1kΩ
1
150Ω
4
10Ω
66 Silicon Chip
4-Band Code (1%)
brown black yellow brown
red violet orange brown
brown black orange brown
red red red brown
brown black red brown
brown green brown brown
brown black black brown
5-Band Code (1%)
brown black black orange brown
red violet black red brown
brown black black red brown
red red black brown brown
brown black black brown brown
brown green black black brown
brown black black gold brown
1 “remote control” case
135 x 70 x 24mm
(Jaycar HB5610, Altronics
H0343 or equivalent)
1 PC board coded 01209101,
65 x 86mm
1 top panel label 55 x 14mm
1 front panel label 75 x 49mm
1 miniature SPDT toggle switch,
PC mount (S1)
1 3.5mm stereo socket, PC
mount
1 knob to suit potentiometer
2 DIP8 IC sockets (optional)
1 trigger transformer for Xenon
flashtube (L1) (Jaycar
MM2520, Altronics M0104 or
equivalent)
4 M3 x 6mm screws
1 2-way pin header with 2.54mm
spacing
1 jumper shunt
1 9V (216) alkaline battery
1 9V battery clip
2 PC stakes
Semiconductors
1 TL072 dual op amp (IC1)
1 LM386 1W amplifier (IC2)
1 4.7V 1W zener diode (ZD1)
1 3mm LED (LED1)
1 1N5819 1A Schottky diode (D1)
1 1N4148 switching diode (D2)
Capacitors
3 470F 16V PC electrolytic
2 100F 16V PC electrolytic
4 10F 16V PC electrolytic
1 100nF MKT polyester
1 47nF MKT polyester
1 33nF MKT polyester
1 330pF ceramic
1 220pF ceramic
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
2 100kΩ 1 27kΩ 2 10kΩ
1 2.2kΩ
3 1kΩ
1 150Ω
4 10Ω
1 10kΩ horizontal trimpot (VR1)
1 10kΩ log potentiometer, 9mm
square, PC mount (VR2)
Capacitor Codes
Value F value IEC Code EIA Code
100nF 0.1uF
104
100n
47nF 0.047uF
473
47n
33nF 0.033uF
333
33n
330pF
330
330p
220pF
220
220p
siliconchip.com.au
+5V
Q1
BC556
f
g
e
6
D3
D4
IC1
ATTINY
2313
d
DISP2 NFD-8021BS
a
b
c
f
e
g
d
dp
a
b
f
g
e
c
dp
d
D1
D2
g f e d c b a dp
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
DISP3 NFD-5621BS
a
b
c
f
e
d
dp
a
b
g
c
dp
What it is & how it works
PD2
g f e d c b a dp
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
f
e
g
d
a
b
f
g
e
c
d
dp
c dp e d g
b
c
dp
f
b a
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PB3 15
14
PB2
13
“Charlieplexing”
is a multiplexing technique for driving displays
PB1
12
PB0
and is particularly
suited for use with microcontrollers. It
11
PD6
reduces the
number
of outputs required to drive a given display
16
PB4
but implementing
it can be a little tricky. Here is an in-depth
PB5 17
18
8explanation
PB6 of how it works.
19
PD4
PB7
2
PD0
By NICHOLAS VINEN
T
PA2/RST
1
+5V
RLY1
K
HE REMOTE-CONTROLLED Digi- all six digits using just nine tracks in place of the specialised IC. This
tal Up/Down Timer described in and no external components (apart D2also allowed us to optimise the track
August 2010 features six920mm-high from the microcontroller). The method
connections, dramatically simplifying
PD5
LED digits in three dual displays. we used is known as “Charlieplex- the board layout.
A
These are great because they
3 are bright ing”. It was originally developed by
PD1
and easy to read from a distance but Christopher Malinowski in 1979 but Multiplexing
unlike a Liquid Crystal Display (LCD),
was popularised by Charlie Allen at
Before describing how the technique
they do not have an on-board control- Maxim, with the development of the works, let’s first look at how a 7-seg4
ler IC. This means that driving
them MAX6950 and MAX6951 ICs. These ment LED display is normally driven.
XTAL2
D5 normally involves
+
using external can drive five or eight
7-segment dis- This method is not restricted to this
components and quite a few tracks on plays from a 16-pin ICPIEZO
package.
type of display – it can be used with
the7PC board.
We used a similarBUZZER
scheme for our vacuum fluorescent displays, incanX1
8MHz
PD3 we found a way to drive timer project, with a microcontroller descent displays, Nixie tubes etc. The
However,
5
–
XTAL1
D6
GND
10
D6: 1N4148
A
a
D2
D1
Charlieplexing
DISP1 NFD-8021BS
20
Vdd
D1
D2
470Ω
CON4
K
33pF
10k
C
B
33pF
Q2
BC546
C
C
CON2
E
D1, D2: 1N4004
A
LLED DIGITAL TIMER
LED
K
B
K
A
7805
BC546, BC556
E
IN
C
GND
OUT
Fig.1: the conventional multiplexing scheme for driving common anode LED displays. Each digit is individually
switched on in sequence and the appropriate cathode control lines drive the wanted segments via transistors Q5-Q8.
siliconchip.com.au
CON1
September 2010 67
Fig.2: this shows how the same four LED displays are driven using Charlieplexing. In this case, the
anodes and cathodes are driven using complementary transistor pairs. This is convenient when
using a microcontroller, as their digital outputs are typically configured in this manner.
main differences are the drive voltage
and current.
Fig.1 shows the conventional multiplexing arrangement, although we
have simplified it by showing just
four LEDs in each display and only
four displays. However, this method
can handle any number of segments
or displays by adding more transistors
and control lines.
Of course, as the number increases,
routing the tracks becomes more difficult.
It works as follows: the anode control lines are active-low and only one
of them is active at any given time.
Typically, transistors Q1-Q4 are turned
on in sequence with a 25% duty cycle.
Conversely, the cathode control lines
are active-high and any combination
may be turned on at any given time.
Let’s say we want to light LEDs 2,
4, 5 & 9. First, anode control line 1 is
brought low and Q1 is turned on. At
68 Silicon Chip
the same time, cathode control lines
2 & 4 are switched high. As a result,
LEDs 1-4 are driven at the anode but
only LEDs 2 & 4 are driven at their
cathodes, so only these two LEDs light.
Before Q1 is turned off again, all the
cathode control lines are brought low
(off). Q2 then switches on and cathode
control line 1 is switched high. In this
case, LED5-8 are driven at their anodes
but only LED5 is driven at its cathode
and so only LED5 lights.
Finally, LED9 is switched on by
turning Q3 on (after Q2 is turned off)
and taking cathode control line 1 high.
All the cathode control lines (and
thus the cathode drivers) then remain
off while Q4 is turned on, so that no
further LEDs light.
Duty cycle
In this circuit, any LED can only be
on 25% of the time because the driver
transistors are switched in sequence.
So in reality, when multiplexed LEDs
are alight, they are actually flashing. However, by making them flash
rapidly enough, they appear to be lit
continuously due to persistence of vision (ie, our eyes cannot react rapidly
enough to detect the flashing). As a
result, we just see the lit segments.
It also follows that the LEDs are 25%
as bright as they would be if switched
on permanently, assuming equal currents. In practice, this is compensated
for by using brighter LEDs or by driving
them at higher peak currents. Most
LEDs can handle much higher currents
for brief periods than they can on a
continuous basis (ie, at DC), as the ultimate limit is their dissipation rating.
If they are only switched on a portion
of the time, the average dissipation is
a fraction of the instantaneous dissipation (in this case, 25%).
This multiplexing scheme is widely
used and it works well but it has dissiliconchip.com.au
advantages. The main problem is the
number of control lines necessary. It
is the sum of the number of segments
and the number of digits.
For last month’s Digital Timer with
six 7-segment digits (which have eight
LEDs each, including the decimal
point), this would mean 6 + 8 = 14
control lines. It would also require 14
transistors and 22 resistors.
This could be reduced by driving the
cathodes directly from the microcontroller outputs but if this is done, it’s
difficult to make the segment brightness consistent between digits due to
internal resistances in the microcontroller’s power supply.
By using Charlieplexing, we managed to drive the displays using nine
pins and no additional components.
Charlieplexing
Now take a look at the “Charlieplexing” arrangement shown in Fig.2. This
shows the same LED displays as before
but with the new driving arrangement.
There are actually more transistors,
five PNP and five NPN, but they are arranged as complementary pairs. This is
handy because microcontroller digital
outputs have a similar configuration.
If the transistors in a complementary
pair are individually controlled, as
they are in a micro, we have what is
known as a “Tri-state” output (a term
coined by National Semiconductor). If
one transistor is on and the other is off,
then the output is either active high or
active low (ie, pull-up or pull-down). If
both transistors are off, then the output
is “high-impedance”, ie, not driven.
Switching both transistors on creates
a short circuit between the supply rails
so this condition is prevented.
Transistor pairs 1-4 drive one common anode and between one and four
cathodes. It doesn’t matter which
cathodes are driven by which pair.
However, the common anode of each
display is driven by a different pair
than for its cathodes.
As before, one anode is brought high
at any given time. Transistor Q1 drives
the first display’s common anode, Q3
the second, and so on. When Q1 is
switched on, the first display’s four
cathodes are controlled by Q4, Q6, Q8
& Q10. Similarly, when Q3 is switched
on, the second display’s four cathodes
are controlled by Q6, Q8, Q10 & Q2.
Now, say we want to turn on the
same LEDs as in our last example (ie,
LEDs 2, 4, 5 & 9). We set pair 1 to acsiliconchip.com.au
tive high, pairs 2 and 4 to active low
and pair 3 to high impedance. That
means that transistors Q1, Q4 and
Q8 will be switched on while the rest
will remain off. As a result, LED2 and
LED4 will both be forward biased so
they will light up.
Now consider LED8 in this state. It
is also being driven at both ends – its
anode by Q4 and its cathode by Q1.
However because its anode is pulled
low and its cathode high, it is reverse
biased. Since LEDs act as diodes, no
current will flow and so LED8 will
remain off. This is the trick which
allows Charlieplexing to control the
same number of display segments with
less control lines.
As before, to light the other segments, the microcontroller cycles
through the anodes and turns on the
appropriate cathodes.
In the case of the MAX6590/1 ICs,
not only are the transistor pairs internal to the IC but the cathode transistors
have an adjustable current limit, so no
additional parts are required. You just
need the IC, the four digits and five
tracks. Since the order of the anodes
and cathodes are not important, they
can be re-mapped in the software – we
can route those five tracks whichever
way is most convenient.
As demonstrated in last month’s
timer project, similar results can be
obtained with a microcontroller. The
catch is that driving the display requires a fair bit of processing power
as it is necessary to cycle through the
segments one at a time and light them
(or not) individually. This is because
we must rely on the internal resistance
in their output transistors to limit the
current without additional resistors.
It is possible to add one resistor per
cathode set to the circuit to solve this
problem although brightness matching between digits can then become
an issue, depending on the current at
which the segments are being driven.
However, either technique is valid and
can provide simpler circuitry than the
traditional multiplexing method.
Because Charlieplexing is software
intensive, it is best suited to applications where the microcontroller does
not have a lot of work to do besides
driving the display. This is the case
with our Digital Up/Down Timer and
there are many other applications
which can take advantage of “Charlieplexing” to simplify circuit design
SC
and PC board layout.
Helping to put you in Control
Control Equipment
Freetronics
TwentyTen
Based on the Arduino Duemilanove but with
improvements and
updates It's 100%
Arduino compatible. Also included in
the package are a USB cable, and our
Getting Started guide sheet.
$36.30+GST
Thermostat Simple
to use thermostat with
an internal NTC thermistor sensor and
relay ON/OFF output
Will control over
5~50°C. $19.95 +GST
Light Sensor Switch
Easy to use light sensor. Can be used to
switch on lighting when
it becomes dark. Wallmount with a cable
gland for weather-proof
wiring. Adjustable time delay.
$12.95 +GST
400W Brushless
AC Servo Motor
Ideal for cost sensitive applications.
Comes with a
standard 2500-line encoder with differential encoder signals and Hall
Sensors $295 +GST
USB Brushed DC
Motor Controller has
four interface modes:
USB, logic-level serial,
analog voltage, and
hobby radio control (RC). Supports
open-loop and closed-loop speed or
position control. 6-16VDC 12A operation. $119.95+GST
Inductive Proximity
Sensor switch. Features a 4 wire NPN transistor output with both
NO+NC Outputs, LED
indication, IP67 and
wide power supply of 10-30VDC. PNP
Output available. Commonly used to
measure shaft speed. $27.50+GST
Ph: 03 9782 5882
New, Easier to Use Website
www.oceancontrols.com.au
September 2010 69
Electrolytic capacitor
reformer and tester
Last month we introduced our new electrolytic capacitor reformer and
tester – ideal for anyone working with vintage radios, valve equipment or
indeed the hobbyist who has gathered a collection of electrolytics over the
years. Now you can not only test them, you can (usually!) breathe new life
into them if they’ve suffered from the ravages of time!
W
ith the exception of the power
supply, microswitch (S6) and
of course the capacitor under test/reforming, virtually all of the
circuitry and components used in the
Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer and
Leakage Meter are mounted on a single
PC board measuring 222 x 120mm and
coded 04108101.
This is supported behind the transparent lid of the case – in fact, a modified storage organiser – which houses
the instrument.
As you can see from the photos and
assembly diagrams, the main board is
suspended from the lid of the enclosure
and label (which becomes the instrument’s front panel) via four 25mm long
M3 tapped spacers.
The LCD display module mounts
just above the centre of the main board
on four 12mm long M3 tapped Nylon
spacers (or two such spacers if you use
the Altronics LCD module).
The DC/DC converter’s step-up
transformer T1 (wound on a 26mm
ferrite pot core) mounts on the main
board at upper left using a 25mm long
M3 Nylon screw and nut, while voltage
selector switch S1 also mounts directly
Part 2: by JIM ROWE
on the board at lower left.
The only components not mounted
directly on the main board are power
switch S2, pushbutton switches S3-S5,
the two test leads (fitted with alligator
clips) and, as mentioned earlier, the
microswitch. All switches are mounted
on the front panel, with their rear connection lugs extended down via short
lengths of tinned copper wire to make
their connections to the board. All of
these assembly details should be fairly
clear from the diagrams and photos.
To begin fitting the components on
the main board we suggest you fit the
fixed resistors. These are all 1% tolerance metal film components, apart
from the 0.27Ω, 2.2kΩ and 8.2kΩ 5W
resistors and the 2 x 1kΩ 1W resistors.
When you are fitting all of the resistors make sure you place each value in
its correct position(s), as any mixups
may have a serious effect on the meter’s
operation and/or accuracy. Check each
resistor’s value with a DMM if you want
to make sure of no mistakes.
It’s also a good idea to fit the 1W
and 5W resistors with their bodies
about 2mm above the top of the board,
rather than resting on it. That’s because
these resistors can become quite warm
during an extended ‘electro reforming’
test run.
It’s logical to follow with the wire
links, most of which are 0.4mm long, so
they’re easily fashioned from resistor
lead offcuts. There are quite a few of
these links, of which five are located
underneath the position where the LCD
module is fitted later.
Next place the eleven 1mm terminal pins in the board – two for each
of the three test point locations, two
for the DC input connection and three
for the high voltage output (to the
micro-switch and capacitor). Follow
these with the sockets for IC1 and IC2
(both 8-pin sockets) and IC3 (an 18pin socket).
After these are in place you can
fit 25-turn trimpot VR1 at centre left
and trimpots VR2 and VR3 at upper
right. Next are the small low-value
capacitors, followed by the two larger
470nF/630V metallised polyester units
and finally the two high voltage elec-
WARNING: SHOCK HAZARD!
Because the voltage source in this instrument can be set to provide quite high DC voltages (up to 630V) and can also supply significant
current (tens of milliamps), it does represent a potential hazard in terms of electric shock. We have taken a great deal of care to ensure
that this hazard is virtually zero if the instrument is used in the correct way – ie, with the lid closed and secured – even to the extent of
quickly discharging any capacitor when the lid is opened.
However, if the safety switching is bypassed, especially when it’s set to one of the higher test voltages, it is capable of giving you
a very nasty ‘bite’ should you become connected across the test clips or a charged high voltage capacitor. There are some situations
where such a shock could potentially be lethal.
Do NOT bypass the safety features included in this design. We don’t want to lose any SILICON CHIP readers to electrocution.
70 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
The completed reformer and tester built into its modified “storage organiser”
case. The circuitry, including the test clips, is completely isolated when the lid
is closed and any charge on the capacitor under test/reforming is bled away
safely when the lid is opened. There is plenty of room inside the case for the
12V DC power supply and in this case its IEC lead, which in use emerges from a
hole cut in the side of the case alongside the supply.
trolytics, which lie on their side at the
top of the board with their leads bent
down by 90°. They are each held down
using a Nylon cable tie which goes
through the hole in the PC board and
around the edge. Once the high voltage
electros are in place you can mount the
low voltage electros, three of which go
at far right and the remaining 47F unit
at lower centre just near TP2.
Don’t forget to fit all of the electros
with their orientation as shown in the
PC board overlay diagram (Fig.3), as
they are all polarised.
Next fit the two relays, making sure
that they too are orientated as shown
in Fig.3. Then you can solder in voltage
selector switch S1, which as you can
see mounts with its indexing spigot in
the ‘1:30’ position. Before you fit the
switch you should cut its spindle to a
length of about 12mm and file off any
burrs, so it’s ready to accept its knob.
After switch S1 has been fitted
to the board, remove its main nut/
lockwasher/position stopwasher
combination and turn the spindle by
hand to make sure it’s at the fully antisiliconchip.com.au
clockwise limit. Then refit the position
stopwasher, making sure that its stop
pin goes down into the hole after the
moulded ‘11’ digits.
Next refit the lockwasher and nut to
hold it down securely, allowing you
to check that the switch is now ‘programmed’ for the correct eleven positions – simply by clicking it around
through them by hand. You’ll probably
need to temporarily attach the knob
first to get enough grip to turn it. If all
is OK, remove the knob for now.
The next step is to wind the step-up
autotransformer T1. This might sound
a bit daunting, but it’s not. You can find
step-by-step instructions in the box
titled ‘Winding Transformer T1’, which
also explains how to fit the completed
transformer to the main PC board.
The final components
With the transformer wound and
fitted to the board, you’ll be ready to
install diodes D1-D6. These are all
polarised, so make sure you orientate
each one correctly as shown in Fig.3.
Also ensure that D1-D3 are the three
1N4148 diodes, D4 is
the UF4007 and the
two 1N4004 diodes
for D5 and D6. When
fitting the two zener
diodes ZD1 and ZD2,
note that they are NOT
the same voltage – and
of course they too are
polarised.
After the diodes install transistors Q1,
Q2, Q4 and Q5, which
are all TO-92 devices.
Make sure that you fit
the two BC337 (NPN)
devices as Q1 and Q4,
with the BC327 (PNP)
devices as Q2 and Q5.
You can follow these
with voltage reference
IC4, which is also in a
TO-92 package. If in
doubt, use a magnifying glass to confirm the
type numbers.
Next come REG1 and
Q3, which are both
in TO-220 packages.
In this project they
each lie flat on the
top of the board with a
19mm-square (6073B type) heatsink
underneath and with their leads bent
down by 90 degrees at a point about
6mm away from the body. Each device
is then held in position on the board
using a 6mm long M3 machine screw
and nut. These should be tightened
before the leads are soldered to the
pads underneath to prevent stress on
the pads.
Next fit LED1 to the board. It is located just to the right of the socket for
IC1, with its cathode ‘flat’ side towards
rotary switch S1. Note that it is fitted
vertically, with its leads left almost at
their full length – so that the bottom of
the LED’s body is about 22mm above
the top of the board. This should mean
that the top of the LED’s body will just
protrude from the matching hole in the
case lid, after final assembly.
The final component to be mounted
directly on the board is the connector
for whichever LCD module you are
going to use. In the case of the Jaycar
QP-5516 module, this will be a 14-way
(7x2) length of DIL (dual inline) socket
strip, fitted vertically at the left-hand
end of the module position; whereas
if you are using the Altronics Z-7013
module, you will need to fit a 16-way
September 2010 71
12-15V DC INPUT
+
1000 F
1000 F
REG1
7805
4004
D2
VR2
2.4k
4148
10k
22
VR3
D5
D3
4148
TP1
LCD
CONT
220 F
+
TPG
POWER
10k
RE MR OFER CITYL ORT CELE
E GAKAEL R OTI CAPA C &
RETE M T NERRU C
CABLE TIE
SECURES
DC LEAD
–
S2
SET 2.49V
REF
RLY1
0102 ©
10k
1M
IC2
LM358
10nF
47 F
1k
+
100nF
TPG
6V2
ZD1
1k
2
22k
4
6.8k
1
2
5
11
6
S
2.0k
100
K
3.0k
A
T
100
7
8
9
2.4k
560
30
LED1
560
F
16
110
10
SET APPLIED
VOLTAGE
150
270k
33
220
S1
4.7k
TP2
PIC16F88
IC3
100nF
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
14
S5
3.0k
56
6.8k
Q3
IRF540N
NC
100nF
2.2k
820k
BC327
VR1 50k
1k 1W
T+
Q2
(NO)
(NC)
TPG
TP3
1k 1W
T–
CABLE TIE SECURES
3-CORE FLEX
TO MICROSWITCH
0.27
5W
1k
2.2k 5W
ZD2
BC337
75k
IC1
34063
1nF
75k
Q1
2.2k
75k
4V7
680k
100k
JAYCAR QP-5516 LCD MODULE
560
D4 UF4007
T1
COIL
DECREM
TIME
INCREM
TIME S4
!VH+
RLY2
100
2.2k
10k
100nF
75k
COMMON
3
10180140
D1
4148
47
100k
390k
470nF 630V
470nF 630V
390k
4.7k
D6
4004
NO
390k
8.2k
5W
Q4 BC337
10k
10k
10k
K
A
100k
TEST
S3
Q5
BC327
+
–
47 F
450V
IC4
LM336Z
-2.5
390k
100k
+
100k
–
47 F
450V
CABLE TIE
SECURES
CAPACITOR
(TEST CAPACITOR
NEGATIVE)
Fig.3: Apart from the 12V plugpack, interlock microswitch and test leads/clips,
everything mounts on or is attached to the one large PC board, as shown here.
The cable ties reduce the flexing on the soldered joints as the case is opened.
72 Silicon Chip
length of SIL socket strip horizontally,
along the lower long side.
Once this connector has been fitted and its pins soldered to the pads
underneath, you’ll be almost ready to
mount the LCD module itself.
All that will remain before this can
be done is to attach to the board either
four or two 12mm long M3 tapped Nylon spacers, in the module mounting
positions. This will mean two at each
end in the case of the QP-5516 module,
or only one at each end in the case of
the Z-7013 module. In each case attach
the spacers using a 6mm M3 screw
passing up through the board from
underneath – but in the case of three
of the four screws for the QP-5516
module, you’ll need to fit an M3 Nylon
flat washer under each screw head as
these screws are unavoidably close to
tracks under the board.
Next ‘plug’ a 7x2 length of DIL pin
strip into the socket strip you have
just fitted to the board for the QP-5516
module, or a 16-way length of SIL pin
strip into the socket strip for the Z-7015
module. Make sure the longer ends of
the pin strip pins are mating with the
socket contacts, leaving the shorter
ends uppermost to mate with the holes
in the module.
Now remove the LCD module from
its protective bag, taking care to hold
it between the two ends so you don’t
touch the board copper. Lower it carefully onto the main board so the holes
along its left-hand end (QP-5516) or
along its lower front edge (Z-7015)
mate with the pins of the pin strip, allowing the module to rest on the tops
of the 12mm long nylon spacers.
Then you can fit either one or two
more 6mm M3 screws to each end of
the module, passing down through the
slots in the module and mating with
the spacers. When the screws are tightened (but not OVER tightened!) the
module should be securely mounted
in position.
The final step is then to use a finetipped soldering iron to carefully solder each of the 14 or 16 pins of the pin
strip to the pads on the LCD module, to
complete its interconnections.
After this is done you can plug the
three main ICs into their respective
sockets, making sure to orientate them
all as shown in Fig.3.
Your PC board assembly should now
be just about complete. Before finishing it off (ie, putting it in the case), we
will run a few checks on it to make
siliconchip.com.au
Winding Transformer T1
Many constructors are put off projects which involve
of the pot core, though, there’s a small plastic washer to
winding a transformer but in most cases, it’s not too difprepare. This is to provide a thin magnetic ‘gap’ in the
ficult a job and requires just a little care and attention
pot core when it’s assembled, to prevent the potcore from
to detail.
saturating when it’s operating.
In the case of the Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer and
The washer is very easy to cut from a piece of the thin
Tester, step-up autotransformer T1 has only 90 turns of
clear plastic that’s used for packaging electronic compowire in all, with an initial primary winding of 10 turns
nents, like resistors and capacitors. This plastic is very
of 0.8mm diameter enamelled copper wire followed by
close to 0.06mm thick, which is just what we need here.
four 20-turn layers of 0.25mm diameter enamelled copSo the idea is to punch a 3-4mm diameter hole in a
per wire to form the secondary.
piece of this plastic using a leather punch and then use
And as you can see from the coil assembly diagram
a small pair of scissors to cut around the hole in a cir(Fig.4, below), all five layers are
cle, with a diameter of 10mm.
wound on a small Nylon bobYour ‘gap’ washer will then be
bin which fits inside a standard
ready to place inside the lower
UPPER SECTION
OF FERRITE
ferrite pot core (bobbins are
half of the pot core, over the
POT CORE
sold to match the cores).
centre hole.
Here’s the procedure: first
Once the gap washer is in poBOBBIN WITH WINDING
you wind on the primary ussition, you can lower the wound
(10T OF 0.8mm DIAMETER
ing 10 turns of the 0.8mm
bobbin into the pot core around
ENAMELLED COPPER WIRE
WITH END BROUGHT OUT.
diameter enamelled copper
it and then fit the top half of the
THEN START OF 0.25mm DIA
wire primary, which you’ll find
pot core. Your autotransformer
ENAMELLED COPPER WIRE
TWISTED TO IT, BEFORE
will neatly take up the width
should now be ready for mountWINDING 4 x 20T LAYERS
of the bobbin providing you
ing on the main PC board.
OF SECONDARY. NOTE
THAT ALL FIVE LAYERS
wind them closely and evenly.
To begin this step, place a
SHOULD BE COVERED
Then cover this first layer with
Nylon flat washer on the 25mmWITH INSULATING TAPE)
a 9mm-wide strip of plastic
long M3 Nylon screw that will
FINISH (OF SECONDARY)
insulating tape or ‘gaffer’ tape,
be used to hold it down on the
to hold it down.
board. Then pass the screw
TAP (END OF PRIMARY,
START OF SECONDARY)
Now twist the start of the
down through the centre hole
START (OF PRIMARY)
0.25mm wire around the ‘finin the pot core halves, holding
ish’ end of the primary winding
them (and the bobbin and gap
'GAP' WASHER OF 0.06mm
and proceed to wind on the first
washer inside) together with
PLASTIC FILM
layer of the secondary – windyour fingers.
ing in the same direction as you
Then lower the complete aswound the primary, of course.
sembly
down on the upper left
LOWER SECTION
In this case you should find
of the board with the ‘leads’
OF FERRITE
POT CORE
that 20 turns will neatly take
towards the bottom, using the
up the width of the bobbin,
bottom end of the centre Nylon
providing you again wind them
screw to locate it in the correct
closely and evenly.
position.
(ASSEMBLY HELD TOGETHER & SECURED TO
After winding this first layer
When you are aware that the
PC BOARD USING 25mm x M3 NYLON SCREW & NUT)
of the secondary, cover it with
end of the screw has passed
another layer of insulating
through the hole in the PC
tape. Then wind on another layer, again of 20 turns and
board, keep holding it all together but up-end everything
cover it with a layer of insulating tape as before.
so you can apply the second M3 Nylon flat washer and
Exactly the same procedure is then followed to wind
M3 nut to the end of the screw, tightening the nut so that
on the third and fourth layers of the secondary.
the pot core is not only held together but also secured to
Each of these extra layers should be covered with
the top of the PC board.
another 9mm-wide strip of plastic insulating tape just
Once this has been done, all that remains as far as the
as you did with the first layer, so that when all five laytransformer is concerned is to cut the primary start, ‘tap’
ers have been wound and covered, everything will be
(primary finish/secondary start) and secondary finish
nicely held in place.
leads to a suitable length, scrape the enamel off their
The ‘finish’ end of the wire can then be brought out of
ends so they can be tinned and then pass the ends down
the bobbin via one of the slots (on the same side as the
through their matching holes in the board so they can be
primary start and primary finish/secondary start leads)
soldered to the appropriate pads.
and your wound transformer bobbin should be ready to
Don’t forget to scrape, tin and solder BOTH wires
fit inside the two halves of the ferrite pot core.
which form the ‘tap’ lead – if this isn’t done, the transJust before you fit the bobbin inside the bottom half
former won’t produce any output.
siliconchip.com.au
eptember 2010 73
2010 73
SSeptember
The finished PC board, ready for mounting in the case. While pushbutton switches S3, S4 and S5 are shown in position
here for the photograph, they are normally not soldered in until the board is mounted on the front panel – they have to
pass through the panel from above and are connected to the PC board via lengths of tinned copper wire.
sure everything is according to Hoyle.
Checkout and setup
NOTE: the following checks MUST
be done with S1 on a low voltage setting (say 35V or less). NEVER apply
power to the unit with S1 on a higher
voltage setting without the PC board
fitted to the case and the safety interlock in place.
If you connect the 12V DC plugpack
to the mains and then switch on the
power using S2, a reassuring glow
should appear from the LCD display
window – from the LCD module’s
backlighting. You may also be able to
see the Meter’s initial greeting ‘screen’.
If not though, you’ll need to use a small
screwdriver to adjust contrast trimpot
VR3 until you get a clear and easily visible display. (VR3 is adjusted through
the upper small hole just to the right
of the LCD window.)
After a few seconds, the display
should change to the Meter’s measurement direction ‘screen’, where it tells
you to set the appropriate test voltage
(using S1) and also the test time period
(using S4 and/or S5), before pressing
the Start/Stop Voltage Application
button (S3) to begin the test.
Note that if you make no adjustments to the test time period using S4
or S5, the default time period will be
74 Silicon Chip
10 seconds.
If you just set the test voltage and
press S3 at this stage, without any capacitor connected to the alligator clips
(make sure the alligator clips cannot
short!), LED1 should begin glowing to
indicate that the test voltage is being
presented to the test terminals and the
LCD display should change to read:
Vtest=ON 0m09s
Cap Lkg= 0.00A
where the time displayed on the right
end of the upper line will be decrementing to show the ON time remaining. Then when the remaining time
falls to zero, you’ll hear a soft ‘click’
and LED1 will go dark to indicate that
the test voltage has been removed. At
the same time the top line of the display
will change to read:
Vtest=OFF 0m 0s
while the lower line will remain
unchanged.
Assuming all has gone well at this
point, your unit is probably working
correctly. However if you want to set
its calibration to ensure maximum accuracy of the readings, try connecting
your DMM between the terminal pins
TP1 and TPG (at upper right on the
board, accessible via the gap between
the board and front panel). You should
get a reading of close to 2.5V and assuming this is the case try adjusting
trimpot VR2 with a small screwdriver
until you get a reading as close as possible to 2.490V.
Now set your DMM to a range where
it can read a voltage of 63V accurately
and connect its probes between the
Meter’s test terminals. Then turn S1
to the ‘63V’ position and press S3 to
turn on the test voltage source. The
DMM reading should quickly rise to
read very close to 63.0 volts and if
so there’s no need to go further. But
if the reading is not within the range
of 62.5 - 63.5V, you’ll need to bring it
inside this range (and ideally to 63.0V)
using a small screwdriver or insulated
alignment tool passed down through
the hole in the front panel midway
between the test terminals, to adjust
the setting of VR1. Once you set the
test voltage on the 63V range in this
way, all of the other voltage settings
will be correct as well.
Note that if you haven’t set the Meter’s timer to increase the testing time
period from its default 10 seconds, the
timer will turn off the test voltage after
this time. So if you want to take your
time to adjust the voltage to 63V using
VR1, you might want to crank up the
time period using S4, to keep the test
voltage present for as long as you need.
Once the 2.49V reference voltage and
the 63V test voltage have been set in
siliconchip.com.au
this way, your Electrolytic Capacitor
Reformer/Leakage Meter has been set
up correctly and will be ready to be
fitted into the case.
Preparing the “case”
As mentioned earlier, the case we
have used is a little unusual. It’s sold
as a “Storage Organiser” and is made
by Trojan. Ours came from Bunnings
Hardware for the princely sum of
$9.95. It has a transparent hinged lid
and in the “body” it has three rows of
fixed dividers plus quite a number of
movable dividers which fit into slots
moulded into the fixed dividers.
First determine where your PC board
will lie inside the case. Use an enlarged
photocopy of the front panel (see Fig.7)
or a same-size copy of the PC board
layout and use it on the outside of the
case as a template for drilling.
The left-to-right position is fairly
unimportant (just make sure you leave
enough room for the leakage current
guide if you use the PC board layout
diagram). However, you need to make
sure that the PC board lies exactly in
the space between the vertical dividers
so that when the lid is closed, it fits!
There are four holes to be drilled
to mount the PC board and nine for
controls/indicators. You don’t need to
cut a slot for the LCD readout because
the lid is transparent enough to read
through it. (Yeah, we know, our photos
show a cutout – we did that before we
realised it was transparent enough!
D’oh!) You will, however, need a cutout
in the front panel label.
We modified the case to accommodate the PC board by removing a 30mm
deep by 215mm long section from one
of the fixed dividers, then cut notches
along the moulded slots about 10mm
wide and about 25mm down from the
top. The photo of our modified case
gives a better idea.
The PC board sits down in the removed divider section and along the
slot notches each side. 25mm threaded
standoffs then mount the PC board to
Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
No. Value
4-Band Code (1%)
5-Band Code (1%)
1
1MΩ
brown black green brown
brown black black yellow brown
1
820kΩ
grey red yellow brown
grey red black orange brown
1
680kΩ
blue grey yellow brown
blue grey black orange brown
4
390kΩ
orange white yellow brown orange white black orange brown
1
270kΩ
red violet yellow brown
red violet black orange brown
5
100kΩ
brown black yellow brown brown black black orange brown
4
75kΩ
violet green orange brown violet green black red brown
1
22kΩ
red red orange brown
red red black red brown
5
10kΩ
brown black orange brown brown black black red brown
1
6.8kΩ
blue grey red brown
blue grey black brown brown
2
4.7kΩ
yellow violet red brown
yellow violet black brown brown
1
3.0kΩ
orange black red brown
orange black black brown brown
2
2.4kΩ
red yellow red brown
red yellow black brown brown
4
2.2kΩ
red red red brown
red red black brown brown
1
2.0kΩ
red black red brown
red black black brown brown
5#
1kΩ
brown black red brown
brown black black brown brown
2
560Ω
green blue brown brown
green blue black black brown
1
220Ω
red red brown brown
red red black black brown
1
150Ω
brown green brown brown brown green black black brown
1
110Ω
brown brown brown brown brown brown black black brown
3
100Ω
brown black brown brown brown black black black brown
1
56Ω
green blue black brown
green blue black gold brown
1
47Ω
yellow violet black brown
yellow violet black gold brown
1
33Ω
orange orange black brown orange orange black gold brown
1
30Ω
orange black black brown
orange black black gold brown
1
22Ω
red red black brown
red red black gold brown
1
16Ω
brown blue black brown
brown blue black gold brown
(All 5W resistors will have values printed on them. # 2 1kΩ are 1W. )
siliconchip.com.au
the underside of the lid, onto which we
had previously glued the front panel
and drilled the required holes (actually we melted the holes with a fine
soldering iron but don’t tell the boss!).
You’ll also need to mount the microswitch so that it is actuated when
the lid is closed. The microswitch
has two mounting holes through the
body which make this fairly simple.
It doesn’t have to be horizontal when
mounted, in fact a little bit an angle
makes the action on the actuator arm
more certain.
Holes also need to be drilled (or
melted) through the divider walls to
allow the HV wires (from PC board
to microswitch/negative capacitor
terminal) to pass through, along with
the wires from the plugpack to the PC
board.
Power supply
While we have built the prototype
with a switch-mode 12V 2A plugpack,
that’s not the only option.
The supply can be virtually any
12-15V DC type with a minimum of
about 1.5A output – just so long as it
fits inside the case.
If you use a plugpack, it obviously
needs to be outside the unit when in
operation. Therefore a small slot can
be cut in the outside vertical wall of
the case, just deep enough to allow the
figure-8 cable to pass through when the
lid is closed and locked.
An alternative is to use a switchmode adaptor supply – one we had on
hand was a 12V, 4A type which came
from Altronics (Cat M8938). At 60mm
wide, this particular supply fits nicely
into the case, as our photo shows.
Yet another, often much cheaper,
alternative, is to use what is commonly
sold as a “hard disk drive” supply –
they’re usually about the same size as
the above model (or a little less), and
have a 12V, 2A DC ouput (along with
a 5V 2A ouput which can be ignored).
The latter supply is often sold with,
or is available for, external hard disk
drives and we’ve seen them advertised
for less than $5 each!
Both of these supplies generally have
Capacitor Codes
Value F value IEC Code EIA Code
470nF 0.47uF
474
470n
100nF 0.1uF
104
100n
10nF 0.01uF
103
10n
1nF 0.001uF
102
1n
eptember 2010 75
2010 75
SSeptember
LAMINATED LABEL
GLUED TO
UNDERSIDE OF CASE LID
S2
S5 (WITH
& S5
S4 S4
BEHIND)
S3
CASE LID
LED1
0.1
5W
(Q3)
LCD MODULE
S1
(IC2, WITH IC3 BEHIND)
(REG1)
(RLY2)
PC BOARD
Fig.5: the PC board “hangs” from the case lid, which becomes the front panel. The label is on the inside of the lid.
an IEC socket so a standard IEC power
cable can be used. To do this, a 30mm
hole could be cut in the case side to allow the supply’s IEC plug to fit through,
which would then allow the supply to
remain inside the case when in use.
There’s even room to store an IEC
cable inside the case in the area you
would normally connect the capacitor
under test/reforming.
We used the front 1/3 of the case for
the capacitor under re-forming or test
and storage for the supply. One of the
supplied orange dividers makes neat
separate compartments for both the
capacitor and the supply.
Fitting the front panel
Before proceeding to final assembly,
tinned copper extension wires need to
be soldered to the three pushbutton
switches (S3-S5) which will go through
the front panel from above and soldered to the underside of the PC board
when it is in position.
A tip here is to make all of the S3S5 extension wires slightly different
lengths and longer than you’d think
necessary (say from 30 to 50mm) so
that when one goes in, it doesn’t pop
out doing the next one!
Unfortunately, the front panel is
longer than a SILICON CHIP page so we
haven’t been able to provide a samesize artwork as normal. The easiest way
to get the panel is to download the PDF
from siliconchip.com.au and print it.
A colour printer is the best but you
will need to be able to print A3 paper.
To provide a little more protection
and rigidity, we laminated ours (again,
an A3 laminator is required), cut out
all the holes (including the LCD hole)
then glued it, face-side up, inside the
lid of the case using spray adhesive.
Hopefully all the holes you previously drilled in the panel will line up
with those you drilled earlier.
Allow the glue to dry and you should
now be ready for the only slightly fid76 Silicon Chip
dly part of the assembly operation:
attaching the PC board assembly to the
rear of the lid/front panel.
This is only fiddly because you have
to line up all of the extension wires
from switches S2-S5 with their matching holes in the PC board, while you
bring the lid and board together and at
the same time line up the body of LED1
along with switches S1 and S2 with
their matching holes in the front panel.
Just take your time and the lid will
soon be resting on the tops of the board
mounting spacers. Make sure LED1
is poking through its hole, then you
can secure the two together using the
four remaining 6mm long M3 machine
screws, with washers underneath the
heads to protect the relatively soft
plastic of the case lid.
Now it’s a matter of soldering each
of the switch extension wires to their
board pads. Once they are all soldered
you can clip off the excess wires with
sidecutters.
Place the power switch washer and
nut on the thread and tighten (adjust
the underside nut up or down as necessary so you don’t bow the plastic) and
finally make sure the LED is poking
through its front panel hole.
Final wiring
Power wiring (from the 12V power
supply/plugpack) and high voltage
wiring (to the microswitch and capacitor negative) can be attached to
the PC stakes even with the board in
position. It’s a bit fiddly and you have
to be careful not to damage the plastic
lid but the stakes are close enough to
the outer edges of the PC board to make
this possible.
To protect the soldered joints, as
much as possible, as the lid is opened
and closed, we secured both the power
supply and output cables to the PC
board using small cable ties.
Remember to run the various wires
through the holes you have drilled in
the divider walls before soldering to
the PC board. The power supply connections are straightforward (remember the polarity!) but the high voltage
wiring is just a bit more difficult. Note
our comments earlier about the type of
cable used for the high voltage cable: it
must be rated at 250V or higher.
• The wire from the HV+ terminal goes
to the microswitch “NO” terminal.
• The wire which connects to the 2 x
1kΩ 1W bleed resistors on the PC
board goes to the microswitch “NC”
terminal.
• The wire from the microswitch
“COM” terminal goes direct to the
capacitor positive (red) alligator
clip.
• The wire from the T- terminal goes
direct to the capacitor negative
(black) alligator clip.
By the way, if you find this description a bit confusing, refer to the diagrams of Figs. 3&5 and also the inside
photos shown last month. These will
hopefully make everything clear.
Using it
The new Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer is very easy to use, because literally all that you have to do is connect
the capacitor you want to test between
the alligator clips (with the correct polarity in the case of solid tantalums and
electrolytics), close the lid, set selector
switch S1 for the correct test voltage
and then turn on the power using S2
(assuming you have already plugged
in your plugpack supply).
When the initial greeting message
on the LCD changes into the ‘Set Volts
& Test Time, Press Strt’ message, press
S4 and/or S5 to set the time period to
whatever you need. Then it’s simply
a matter of pressing the Start/Stop
Voltage Application button (S3) to
start the test.
What you’ll see first off may be a
reading the capacitor’s charging current, which can be almost 20mA at
siliconchip.com.au
first (with high value caps) but should
table attached to the front panel, the
then drop back as charging continues.
leakage currents for tantalum and aluHow quickly it drops back will
minium electrolytics also never drop
depend on the capacitor’s value.
down to zero but instead to a level of
With capacitors below about 4.7F,
somewhere between about 1A and
the charging may be so fast that the
9200A (ie, 9.2mA) depending on both
first reading you see may be less than
their capacitance value and their rated
100A, with the meter having immeworking voltage.
diately downranged.
So with these capacitors, you will
If the capacitor you’re testing is of
need to set the Meter’s testing time
the type having a ‘no leakage’ dielectric
period to at least 3 minutes to see if the
(such as metallised polyester, glass,
leakage current reading drops down
ceramic or polystyrene), the current
to the ‘acceptable’ level as shown in
should quickly drop down to less than
the front panel table and preferably
a microamp and then right down to
even lower.
zero. That’s if the capacitor is in good
If this happens the capacitor can be
condition, of course.
judged ‘OK’ but if the current never
On the other hand if the capacitor
drops to anywhere near this level this
is one with a tantalum or aluminium
indicates that it is in need of either
oxide dielectric with inevitable leakreforming or replacement.
age, the current reading will drop more
What about low leakage (LL)
slowly as the test proceeds.
electrolytics?
In fact it will probably take up to
a minute to stabilise at a reasonably
Well, the current levels shown in the
steady value in the case of a solid
table are basically those for standard
tantalum capacitor and as long as 3
electrolytics rather than for those rated
minutes in the case of a ‘good’ aluas low leakage.
minium electrolytic. (That’s because
So when you’re testing one which
these capacitors generally take a few
is rated as low leakage, you’ll need
minutes to ‘reform’.)
to make sure that its leakage current
RDG_SiliconChip_0910.pdf
1
6/08/10
1:36 PM
As you can see from the guide
drops well below the maximum val-
ues shown in the guide table. Ideally
it should drop down to no more than
about 25% of these current values.
Another tip: when you’re testing
non-polarised (NP) or ‘bipolar’ electrolytics, these should be tested twice
– once with them connected to the
alligator clips one way around and
then again with them connected with
the opposite polarity.
That’s because these capacitors are
essentially two polarised capacitors
internally connected in series backto-back. If one of the dielectric layers
is leaky but the other is OK, this will
only show up in one of the two tests.
Reforming old electros
While reading the preceding paragraphs about testing capacitors, you’ve
perhaps been wondering about the
Reformer’s main function: reforming
electrolytics that may have high leakage currents due to a long period of
inactivity.
How do you use it for this function?
In exactly the same way as you use it
for testing capacitors, except that for
reforming you set the timer for a much
longer testing time period.
The idea here is that you still set S1
CC
MM
YY
CM
CM
MY
MY
CY
CY
CMY
CMY
KK
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 77
630V
450V
400V
250V
DECREASE
APPLICATION
TIME
START/STOP
VOLTAGE
APPLICATION
INCREASE
100V
63V
16V
25V
* Figures for Solid Tantalum capacitors are after a charging period of one minute.
# Figures for Aluminium Electrolytics are after a charging/reforming period of three minutes.
9200
8230
5970
4110
3300
2900
2450
2060
1300
4700 F
1590
600
1000 F
730
1500
1340
1130
950
1900
2740
3790
4250
3850
3500
3130
2250
500
680 F
600
1300
1100
950
780
1560
1640
1470
1050
230
150 F
280
600
520
430
370
730
1470
1350
1200
900
50
100 F
230
500
420
330
300
600
460
570
530
420
380
460
340
270
50
11
15 F
13
8.0
8.0
10 F
5.0
5.0
4.7 F
19
6.0
35
38
25
78 Silicon Chip
100
25
18
230
320
290
250
60
15
12
8.0
23
1800
TEST
VOLTS
ON!
35V
10V
50V
SELECT
CAPACITOR
WORKING VOLTAGE
SET TEST
VOLTAGE
270
240
220
5.0
Standard
Aluminium
Electrolytic#
<3.3 F
5.0
5.0
17
10
8.0
6.0
50
59
54
48
15
19
24
17
16
36
22
20
18
9.0
7.0
6.5
10
47 F
10
1.5
6.8 F
2.0
3.0
4.0
14
19
17
15
12
7.5
5.0
3.5
3.0
1.0
Solid
Tantalum*
< 4.7 F
1.5
2.5
LEAKAG E C URREN T SH OULD BE ZERO FOR
ALL OF TH ESE TYPES, AT RATED VOLTAG E
Ceramic,
Polystyrene,
Metallised
Film (MKT,
Greencap
etc.), Paper,
Mica
POWER
SET 2.49V
REFERENCE
SET LCD
CONTRAST
ELECTROLYTIC CAPACITOR
RE-FORMER & TESTER
450V
400V
250V
100V
63V
50V
35V
25V
Maximum leakage current in microamps A) at rated working voltage
16V
10V
TYPE OF
CAPACITOR
CAPACITOR LEAKAGE CURRENT GUIDE
630V
SILICON
CHIP
320mm
Fig.6: the front panel, which incorporates the leakage
table, is too big to fit on the page, so is reproduced at
exactly 75%. If you photocopy this at 133% (which in
this case you can do without infringing copyright) it will
come out right size. Obviously, you’ll need a copier that
can handle A3 paper. Alternatively, you can download
the PDF file from siliconchip.com.au You’ll still need a
printer that can handle A3 paper!
for the capacitor’s rated voltage but simply crank up the
testing time period using S4 until it’s set for either 30 or
60 minutes. Then connect the capacitor to the alligator
clips (making sure of the polarity) and finally press the
Start/Stop Voltage Application button (S3) to start the
test/reforming operation.
Because the metering part of the instrument will continue to make measurements during the reforming period,
this allows you to keep track of the leakage current as it
slowly falls from its initial high figure (which may well
be up in the region of 20mA). This is due to the oxide
dielectric inside the electro slowly regrowing (reforming)
as a result of the current passing through it.
Needless to say if the current readings don’t fall, even
slowly, the electro concerned is beyond being reformed
and should be scrapped.
On the other hand if the current readings do fall significantly but still don’t come down to an acceptable level,
this indicates that the electro will probably benefit from
another reforming operation.
There’s no problem about giving a capacitor repeated
reforming operations, provided that it doesn’t get overheated. In fact, significant heating is really a sign that the
electro is beyond reforming and is not worth any further
rescue efforts.
So this is the basic procedure, when dealing with
electrolytics:
1. First give it a standard 3-minute test run at rated voltage and
see if the leakage current tapers down to an acceptable level
during this time. If it does, the capacitor is OK.
2. If the current doesn’t taper down significantly and/or the
capacitor becomes overheated, it is beyond help and should
be discarded.
3. If the current does taper down significantly but doesn’t reach
an acceptably low level, it can be regarded as a candidate for
reforming. Give it a test/reforming run of 30 or 60 minutes.
4. At the end of the reforming run, test it again with a standard
3-minute test period. If the leakage current is now in the acceptable range (according to the guide on the front panel),
the capacitor has successfully reformed and is now OK. But
if it hasn’t quite finished reforming, it would be worth giving
it another 30 or 60-minute session to see if this will ‘do the
trick’.
Errata
In the parts list published last month, no mention
was made of the mains power adaptor. As discussed in
this month’s text, you’ll need a 12-15V DC supply at a
minimum of about 1.5A. A more robust supply (ie higher
current output) won’t hurt but it does need to be able to
fit into the case!
Also, six (not two) small cable ties are needed, the
extras to secure the cables from the PC board to the microswitch/test leads and 11, not 10 PC pins are required.
siliconchip.com.au
All you need to know about . . . electrolytics!
Most Silicon Chip readers
So electrolytics have large
ETCHED & ANODISED
will be aware that all capacicapacitance because of these
ALUMINIUM FOIL (ANODE)
tors consist of two electrodes
three factors, the very high
separated by an insulating
surface area of the anode,
THIN OXIDE
FILM ON ANODE
IONISED ELECTROLYTE = ACTUAL CATHODE
dielectric.
the very thin aluminium oxide
(THIS IS THE
(IN PAPER SEPARATOR)
DIELECTRIC)
It’s the dielectric which
dielectric and the relatively
allows the capacitor to store
high dielectric constant of
energy (ie, a ‘charge’) in an
around 8.5.
ETCHED ALUMINIUM
FOIL (APPARENT CATHODE)
electric field between the
The anodising process was
two electrodes. The capacioriginally referred to as “formtance is directly proportional to the surface area of the
ing” as in forming the oxide layer.
electrodes on either side of the dielectric, and inversely
The capacitor is wound with the etched/anodised foil,
proportional to the thickness of the dielectric itself. So
a paper separator and the non-anodised aluminium foil
to achieve a high capacitance the electrode area must
which becomes the negative electrode. The capacitor
be as large as possible, while the dielectric must be as
windings are usually then immersed in a bath of electhin as possible.
trolyte and connected to a power supply to “re-form” the
There’s also another factor which determines the
anodised layer on the positive foil which is inevitably
capacitance: the dielectric constant ‘k’ of the dielectric
damaged during the winding process.
material. The capacitance is again directly proportional
After that, the windings have their terminations conto this property, so to achieve a high capacitance you
nected to an aluminium can in the case of the negative
need to use a dielectric material with as high a k value
electrode and to the positive terminal for the anode. The
as possible. Examples are polyester/Mylar with a k of
can is sealed with a rubber bung and then it is recon3.0 and mica with a k value of 6.0.
nected to a power supply for a final re-form and leakage
Electrolytic capacitors were developed about 90 years
current test.
ago in an effort to produce high value capacitors which
It should be noted that the electrolyte layer is critical
were at the same time much more compact than other
to the performance of the capacitor. Because it is a
types. Over the years they have been greatly improved
liquid, it can fill the etched pits in the oxide layer. This
but they are still not quite as reliable and they don’t have
means that the actual cathode is in intimate contact with
the very low leakage of other capacitors such as mica,
the dielectric layer, minimising dielectric thickness and
ceramic or polyester.
therefore maximising capacitance.
As you can see from the diagram of Fig.7 (above), both
New electrolytic capacitors typically have a shelf life
electrodes in an electrolytic capacitor are made from
of many years but the older they get, the higher their
thin aluminium foil and between them is sandwiched a
leakage current becomes as the oxide layer on the alusheet of paper soaked in a conducting liquid or ‘elecminium anode gradually deteriorates, due to the lack of
trolyte’ (often sodium borate in aqueous solution, with
a polarising DC voltage. In most cases, though, such
additives to retard evaporation).
capacitors can be rejuvenated by a re-forming process
So superficially it would seem that we have a pair of
whereby they are connected to a DC supply via a suitconducting electrodes separated not by an insulating
able current limiting resistor.
dielectric but by a sheet of paper soaked in conductive
Initially, when the DC voltage is applied, the leakage
electrolyte.
current will be quite high but it should come down within
But before the capacitor is assembled, the aluminium
a minute or so to a value which is less than the capacifoil which is to become the anode (positive electrode)
tor’s specified leakage current at the rated voltage. This
has its surface etched in a caustic soda solution to
project makes that process easy and safe for electrolytic
greatly increase its surface area. This process covers
capacitors with a wide range of voltage ratings, in addition
the surface with an array of microscopic pits, which can
to measuring the capacitor’s leakage current.
have a total effective surface area of up to 60 times
So that’s what is inside an electrolytic capacitor and
greater than the original unetched area for high voltage
that’s why it’s able to provide a very high capacitance
electrolytics and even higher for low voltage electros.
in a surprisingly small package. The main drawback of
The etched aluminium foil is then subjected to an
electrolytics is that they always exhibit at least a small
anodising process, whereby a very thin aluminium oxleakage current – as shown in the front panel table. So they
ide layer covers the surfaces of all of the microscopic
are really only suitable for use in circuits where this small
pits. This aluminium oxide is not only an insulating
leakage current does not upset circuit operation. Luckily
dielectric but it also has a relatively high k value of 8.5.
SC
this still gives them a great many applications.
+
–
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 79
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.altronics.com.au/
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.altronics.com.au/
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.altronics.com.au/
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.altronics.com.au/
Vintage Radio
By MAURIE FINDLAY, MIEAust., VK2PW
All about thermionic valves
. . as told by a veteran
(or vacuum tubes) .radio
designer
Valves reigned supreme in the electronic
world for more than 40 years, being the
essential components of radio receivers,
transmitters, early computers and many
other devices. When television first came
to Australia, it was black & white and the
sets used valves. It has now been 50 years
since the end of the valve era.
W
ITH AN EYE to preserving our
history, there are many enthusiasts who restore early equipment,
mostly radio receivers from the 1930s,
40s and 50s. Most popular sets used
from four to six valves and many of
them were well made and are wellworth keeping as representative of the
technology of the era.
During the World War 2 (WW2), all
84 Silicon Chip
radio communication depended on
valves. It wasn’t much use sending
up a squadron of fighter planes if they
couldn’t talk to each other and coordinate the operation. Initially, valves
were the least reliable parts in the
equipment used until valve manufacturers in several countries made them
much more rugged.
These military valves were pro-
duced using the latest technology
available and in versions equivalent to
ordinary valves. Most of them, if not
abused, will meet their original
specifications after 60 years.
Not all people restoring
early radios will be trained
technicians or engineers.
They may be able to do
a great job of polishing
the cabinet, replacing the
dial cord and even repairing
the speaker cone. However, when
switched on, the set just doesn’t perform as well as it should. Maybe the
maximum volume is limited or it will
pull in only strong local stations. If
so, does the set need realignment or
does it have a faulty valve? Or could
something else be wrong?
Valves are a common reason for
poor performance in old radios and
this article will answer some of the
questions that are commonly raised
by people restoring vintage sets.
But first a word of warning. Most
enthusiasts will be aware of the basic safety issues for radios operating
from the 230VAC power mains. If you
are not confident about dealing with
mains-operated equipment, then leave
well alone. Even if you are capable and
know what you are doing, be careful
about doing repairs for acquaintances.
There could be legal implications if
something goes wrong.
We’ll assume here that we are dealing only with sets that have a mains
transformer. If you have such a set, it
should be fitted with a good-quality
3-core power lead that’s been properly
anchored and has a good earth connection to chassis.
Unless you a very experienced
and know exactly what you are dosiliconchip.com.au
Taken in February 1954, this picture shows “Radio & Hobbies” staff members Raymond Howe, Neville Williams, John
Moyle (Editor) and Maurice Findlay on the roof on “The Sun” newspaper building in Elizabeth St, Sydney (there to watch
the Queen proceed down nearby Macquarie St during her 1954 visit to Australia). Both Raymond Howe & John Moyle
served in the RAAF during WW2, specialising in signals and radar.
ing, don’t touch transformerless (hot
chassis) AC/DC sets that have one side
of the mains (Active or Neutral) connected to chassis. They are absolute
death traps for the unwary and should
be avoided.
What sort of valves are there?
The simplest electronic valve type
is the diode. It has two elements – the
cathode and the plate (anode). When
the plate is made positive with respect
to the cathode, electrons are attracted
to it and a current flows. Conversely,
if the plate is negative with respect to
the cathode, no current flows.
Diode valves are used to rectify
alternating current. The larger diodes
typically rectify the high-voltage AC
secondary of the mains transformer,
while the smaller diodes are used to
recover the audio modulation from radio frequency (RF) signals. More often
than not though, the latter will not be a
single diode valve but will instead be
incorporated into other valve types. In
fact, there will usually be two diodes
in the envelope – one to recover the
audio and the other to derive the AGC
siliconchip.com.au
(automatic gain control) signal.
The next valve on the list is the
“triode”. It has an element called a
“grid” which is placed between the
cathode and the plate. This grid usually consists of a fine helix of wire
which surrounds the cathode.
In operation, the grid is usually
made slightly negative with respect
to the cathode and, depending on
the voltage applied to it, controls the
electron flow to the positive plate. In
this way, it can be made to amplify.
As a result, triodes in radio receivers
are usually used to amplify audio signals (ie, the audio is fed to grid of the
triode stage). However, triodes have
problems operating at radio frequencies (RF) because of the capacitance
that exists between the plate and the
grid (known as Miller Effect).
This problem can be overcome by
placing another helix of wire around
the control grid, to screen it from the
plate. Valves with this feature are
known as “tetrodes” and are used in
simple circuits to amplify RF signals.
Another grid called the “suppressor” is often also placed around the
screen grid. This improves the efficiency of the valve which is now called
a “pentode”. Like the screen grid, the
suppressor grid also usually takes the
form of a helix but the turns are more
widely spaced.
A special case for power valves is
the “beam tetrode”. It employs a special construction technique that does
away with the need for a suppressor.
Pentodes are commonly used for both
audio and RF amplification.
Special valves
To make things more complicated,
there are a number of special valves
that are frequently used in superheterodyne receivers to convert the
tuned RF signal to the intermediate
frequency (IF). One such valve is the
“triode heptode”
In this type of valve, the triode
element forms part of an oscillator
and it injects the oscillator signal
into a screened grid which is in the
main electron stream to the plate. As
a result, the intermediate (IF) signal
appears at the plate and is then fed to
the receiver’s IF stages.
September 2010 85
Fig.1: reproduced from the April 1949 issue of “Radio & Hobbies”, this diagram shows the various valve types that were
available. The valves designed for battery sets used directly-heated cathodes, while valves designed for use in mainsoperated sets generally used indirectly-heated cathodes to eliminate hum problems.
Most valve superhet receivers use
a triode-heptode for the input stage.
However, more elaborate receivers
may use a pentode RF amplifier stage
before the frequency converter. This
amplifies the tuned RF signal before it
is fed to the converter and so provides
better performance on weak signals.
Cathode construction
The cathodes for all the above valve
types can take two different forms. For
battery operation, strands of wire are
used and valves with directly heated
cathodes suitable for operation from
both 1.5V and 2V were produced.
By contrast, most of the valves
encountered by restorers in mainsoperated sets use indirectly-heated
cathodes. This type of cathode consists
of a fine metal tube with the heater
wire inside and insulated from it. A
big advantage of indirectly-heated
valve cathodes is that the heater can be
operated from low-voltage AC without
introducing hum.
An exception in mains-operated
sets may be the main (double diode)
rectifier. This rectifies the high-voltage
AC secondary of the transformer to
provide the HT (high-tension) line
and this valve is often directly heated.
Both directly and indirectly-heated
cathodes employ special coating
materials to ensure a good supply
of electrons. In use, these materials
gradually deteriorate, resulting in low
86 Silicon Chip
emission and eventually making the
valve unserviceable.
Other parts
Now for a brief look at other components. First, the electrolytic capacitors on the HT line in the power
supply don’t last for 50 years and if
the originals are still there, they will
need replacing. You can often tell from
their appearance that they have failed,
especially if they are leaking.
If there is any doubt, replace them
with modern capacitors with a voltage
rating of, say, more than 400V. The replacement values should be equal to or
only slightly higher than the originals.
In particular, note that substituting
much larger value capacitors in the
position immediately following the
rectifier will invariably shorten the life
of this valve, so don’t do this.
Note also that the negative leads of
these capacitors are sometimes connected to positions other than to the
chassis. This means that you must
check the lead connections carefully
before removing the originals.
Low-value (non-electrolytic) capacitors and resistors are more reliable
than electros. Most resistors can be
checked in-circuit (with the power
switched off) using a multimeter,
while suspect capacitors can be removed and checked on a capacitance
meter. One common problem in old
sets is a noisy volume control. An
aerosol contact cleaner may fix this
problem but if the control is worn,
replacement is the only answer.
Valve sockets and the pins of the
valves themselves can also cause
problems if the radio has been stored
in damp conditions. Look carefully at
the general condition of all metal parts
– if they are corroded, this gives a good
indication of valve socket problems
Power transformers are generally
reliable, even after many years. The
primary winding can be checked
with a multimeter by measuring the
resistance between the Active & Neutral pins on the power plug with the
power off and the radio’s on/off switch
(if fitted) in the ON position. The primary winding will typically have a DC
resistance of several hundred ohms.
If you have an insulation tester,
check that the primary isn’t breaking
down to the transformer frame.
Valve testers
During the heyday of valve radios,
valve testers were readily available.
You simply removed the valve from
its socket, set the controls of the tester
according to a chart, plugged the valve
into the tester and checked the reading
on a meter. Although not totally foolproof, the results given by a valve tester
were good enough for most purposes.
In fact, technicians who didn’t
know much about radio could often
fix sets just by testing the valves.
siliconchip.com.au
Alternatively, they just replaced the
valves in turn to determine which one
(if any) was faulty. Such technicians
were often derisively referred to as
“valve jockeys”.
Because they had to accommodate
a wide variety of valves with different
connection and power requirements,
most valve testers were generally quite
complicated. The most basic units tested the ability of the cathode element to
emit electrons and checked for shorts
between the elements. By contrast, the
more sophisticated units also tested
the valve’s ability to amplify at varying
power levels and usually required an
experienced operator.
Making an instrument to test valves
is impractical as a hobby project unless it is confined to simple tests on
a particular series of valves. Instead,
it is far easier to check valves in-situ
by checking voltages (and sometimes
current) while the radio in operation.
In addition, an emission test on a
valve tester can reject valves which
may work perfectly well in low-power
circuits.
The valves and other parts should
also be checked visually (eg, are the
valve heaters glowing?) but for other
checks on the circuit, a multimeter is
essential. Many basic digital multi
meters (or DMMs) are available for
$30 or less and these have a number
of ranges to read current, AC and DC
voltages and resistance. Nearly all
DMMs have a high input resistance
on the voltage ranges (typically 10MΩ)
so that they don’t disturb the circuit
being measured.
If you don’t have a DMM, buy one.
You will probably pay less for it than
you did for the radio!
The older-style moving-coil multimeters can be used for some measurements. However, their input impedance is much lower than for DMMs
and this can lead to misleading results
when making voltage measurements,
particularly in high-impedance circuit. Even modern moving-coil multimeters have this problem.
Typical valve problems
OK, so what goes wrong with valves.
Here are the most common problems
and how to diagnose them:
(1) They lose emission – after a long
period of use, the cathode (or filament)
can no longer supply enough electrons
to allow the valve to operate properly.
In practice, a valve’s emission can
siliconchip.com.au
This photo illustrates the size
difference between an octal (8-pin)
valve and a later 9-pin “miniature”
valve. The 9-pin (and 7-pin) types
dispensed with the Bakelite base,
the valve pins emerging directly
through the glass envelope.
be checked in circuit by measuring
the current at the cathode. A valve
data book can be helpful here, to give
an indication as to what to expect. If
the valve has a resistor from cathode
to earth, simply measure the voltage
across it and then calculate the current
through it using Ohm’s Law.
Power valves in mains-operated
sets typically have cathode currents
of 50mA, while other valves typically
have values from 2-10mA. However,
the cathode current will be lower for
battery-operated sets.
(2) Vacuum is lost – when this happens, the cathode no longer emits
electrons and so there will be no
cathode current.
(3) Short-circuits between elements –
this can be detected by checking the
voltages around the valve. If elements
are shorted, the voltages on them will
be the same and will be incorrect.
(4) Open circuits – this particularly occurs with valves which have Bakelite
bases, where wires from the elements
are extended to the base pins. They can
sometimes be repaired by re-soldering
the base pins.
(5) Loose Bakelite bases and/or top
caps – can be repaired by re-gluing.
8-pin octal valves
Untold millions of broadcast-band
radios were manufactured in Australia
between 1930 and 1960. AWA, Philips,
Mullard, Astor and Kriesler are just
a few of the brand names that come
to mind. The early sets used valves
with an 8-pin (octal) base and a glass
envelope. Some valves also had the
grid connection via a cap at the top.
The valve type was usually screenprinted on the glass. Basically, a
valve with a particular type number
complied with the standards set by
agreement with a number of manufacturers. There were several sets of typenumbering standards, two of which
were widely used in Australia – the
American system and the European
system.
For the American system, the starting number usually denotes the voltage for the heater or filament. Thus,
a valve with a type number starting
with “6” was designed for 6.3V while
a type number starting with a 12 was
designed 12.6V (this odd voltage
comes from the fact that many radios
were made for cars).
The last two letters denoted the type
of envelope. “G” indicated a normal
glass envelope, while “GT” denoted
a smaller glass envelope. There were
also valves produced with metal envelopes and for these the “G” or “GT”
designation was simply left out. Metal
September 2010 87
Fig.2: this was virtually the standard configuration for a mains-operated 5-valve superhet radio during the late 1940s and
1950s, although this particular circuit was actually published as the “ABC Five” in the August 1966 issue of “Electronics
Australia”. The “ABC” stood for “all bits collected”.
valves were produced in relatively
small quantities.
By contrast, European type numbers
often started with letters to indicate
the elements within the valve. An
“A” usually indicated a diode, a “B”
a triode and so on.
If your object is simply to restore historical radios, it isn’t really necessary
to become an expert on the thousands
of valve type numbers. However, you
should try to get a circuit diagram of
the radio with the voltages marked
and the base pin numbers indicated.
A valve data book could also be useful or you could check the data on the
internet.
Directly-heated valves
Inexpensive battery-operated radios
from the 1950s typically used the following valve types: 1R5 (frequency
changer); 1T4 (pentode IF amplifier);
1S5 (diode and pentode detector plus
audio amplifier); and 3V4 (audio
power amplifier – used to drive a
small loudspeaker). These valves are
of all-glass construction, have 7-pin
miniature bases and had directlyheated cathodes.
A 1.5V battery is used to power
the filaments, while a 90V battery (2
x 45V) is used for the high tension
88 Silicon Chip
(HT) supply. By modern standards,
the performance is not outstanding
and a common problem with these
valves is that the filaments tended to
be unreliable.
A more rugged series of valves designed for battery-operated receivers
was produced by AWV in Australia.
These came in larger glass envelopes,
with octal plastic bases and 2V filaments. Their power consumption was
higher than the 1T4 series but they
were more reliable and gave better
performance. A number of military
sets used the 2V series.
Indirectly-heated valves
Indirectly-heated valves were man
ufactured with a number of heater
voltages: 2.5V, 4.0V, 6.3V and 12.6V,
plus some with even higher voltages.
However, the majority required 6.3V.
A simple mains-operated radio of
the 1950s typically used the following valves: 6J8-G (triode heptode –
frequency changer); 6U7-G (pentode
– IF amplifier); 6B6-G (double-diode &
triode – detector, AGC & audio amplifier); 6V6-G, (beam tetrode – audio amplifier); 5Y3-G (double diode – power
rectifier). These are all 6.3V indirectly
heated types except for the 5Y3-G
which has a 5V heater/cathode and is
operated from a separate 5V winding
on the power transformer.
Combined with well-designed
tuning coils and IF transformers, the
performance of a radio with this valve
line-up on local stations is more than
adequate. In fact, the audio gain of
the standard 5-valve mains-operated
set has some reserve and the audio
amplifier following the detector can
be left out if very high volume is not
required. This was the basis of the
4-valve “Little General” radio made
popular in the 1940s by John Moyle
who was the Editor of “Radio & Hobbies” (later to become “Electronics
Australia”).
It now more than 60 years since the
original “Little General” was described
in “Radio & Hobbies”. Since then, transistors, ICs and large capacity memory
chips have made mobile phones and
digital radios both reliable and inexpensive. None of these consumer items
are now manufactured in Australia.
Modern day marvels
John Moyle died in 1960. What
would he have made of a little radio
on sale in popular stores in the year
2010 for about $40 – an hour’s working
time for a skilled tradesman?
The type of set I’m thinking of typisiliconchip.com.au
Maurie Findlay – An Interesting Career
Maurie Findlay began his electronics
career by making valve radios while still at
school in the 1940s. He subsequently did
a course to become a marine operator in
his late teens and qualified for an amateur
radio license at about the same time.
Being an avid reader of “Radio & Hobbies”, he jumped at the chance when offered a job with the magazine in 1947. He
subsequently left in 1953 to spend a year
with Mullard-Australia as a sales engineer,
just three years before the introduction
of TV into Australia. His responsibilities
included advising manufacturers on the
best valve types to use in early TV receivers. During this time, he made a number
of trips to Mullard’s plant at Hendon in
South Australia to study the manufacture
and testing of valves.
Maurie then rejoined “Radio & Hobbies”
for another five years. During his 10 years
total with the magazine, he completed a
cadetship as a journalist and studied part-
time to become a professional engineer.
As well as being involved in the production of the magazine, Maurie also designed
and described valve and later solid-state
radio receivers, as well as amateur transmitters and test equipment. He hand-made
the mobile radio equipment used by “The
Sun” newspaper in the early 1950s and was
generally involved in designing and testing
the system. A major accomplishment at the
time was his ability to eliminate receiver
hash, due to the crude “vibrator” power
supplies that were used!
Maurie left “Radio & Hobbies” at the
end of 1959 and joined the de Havilland
Company as a trials engineer working on
the “Black Knight” research rocket. This
British-designed rocket was used to study
the physics of re-entry into the Earth’s
atmosphere at very high speed. The aim,
almost reached at that time, was 20,000
miles/hour (32,000km/h).
Maurie’s responsibility on the Black
Knight project involved the special tape
recorder used in the re-entry head. He
then returned to the company’s plant at
Stevenage in the UK to study the larger
“Blue Streak” rocket.
Family responsibilities had priority over
career and he subsequently returned to
Australia to take up a position as Chief
Engineer with Weston Electronics. Among
other things, this company was involved in
the manufacture of VHF transceivers and
outback radio systems.
In 1962, Maurie formed Findlay Communications Pty Ltd which was to produce
SSB marine equipment and mobile sets
for use in the Royal Flying Doctor Service
over a period of nearly 25 years. During
this time, Findlay Communications also
designed and supplied receivers and solidstate 1kW transmitters for the Australian
Civil Aviation Authority.
Now retired, Maurie is a Member of the
Institution of Engineers Australia and is still
an active radio amateur with the call-sign
VK2PW.
There were lots of “Little General” 4-valve sets described in
“Radio & Hobbies” over the years. This one was described
in January 1946 by Neville Williams and is closely based
on the design originally published in the April 1940 issue
by John Moyle. The valve line-up was as follows: 6J8-G,
EBF2-G, 6V6-G and 5Y5-G.
cally measures no more than about 100 x 60 x 30mm and
is powered by two AA cells which last for about a month
with typical usage. It features not only an AM broadcast
band but shortwave, stereo FM and an inbuilt digital clock
with alarm features as well. And of course, digital tuning
and a preset station memory are all part of the deal.
John Moyle was an imaginative and resourceful man.
He would almost certainly have come up with some new
SC
angle. I knew him well.
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 89
CIRCUIT NOTEBOOK
Interesting circuit ideas which we have checked but not built and tested. Contributions from
readers are welcome and will be paid for at standard rates.
D1
REG1 7805
OUT
IN
GND
470nF
K
9–12V <at> 300mA
A
DC
IN
470 F
25V
S1
6
PROGRAMMING
PORT
S
1
Vdd
P1
2 SER
IN
R
T
10k
P3
D2
4
390
Vss
A
8
390
1k
LED2
90 Silicon Chip
C
NC
COM
NO
Q1
BC338
E
LED1
K
D1, D2: 1N4004
A
B
A
K
K
A
flash is short, the time is almost up.
Q1 is an NPN transistor that
switches the load via relay RLY1.
Diode D2 protects against relay coil
back-EMF and diode D1 provides
power supply reverse polarity protection.
The relay should have contacts
rated for 250VAC and 30A, to cope
with the surge current of the induction motor in the refrigerator.
Suitable units would be a Jaycar
SY-4040 chassis-mount type with
SPST contacts or Altronics S-4211
chassis-mount with SPDT contacts.
Pins 2 & 7 provide the standard
serial programming interface. The
time delay can be preset within specific parameters via a special set-up
mode when the circuit is powered
up or to a wide range of delay times
by software changes. LED2 flashes
once for every 10 minutes of time
delay set, whenever the unit is powered up. For example, six flashes
indicates 60 minutes.
Set-up mode is obtained by holding down pushbutton switch S1
until a series of rapid flashes from
LED2 is observed. The time delay
setting is then incremented by 10
7805
BC338
LEDS
This timer was designed to temporarily switch a cafe refrigerator off,
to reduce background noise when
a meeting was being convened in
the cafe area. It provides automatic
switch-on after an adjustable period
of at least two hours. This avoids
the refrigerator being inadvertently
left off.
With the current software, the timer
has a settable range of 10-180 minutes
in 10-minute increments but with
some appropriate software tweaks,
it has a capability of milliseconds to
about 49 days.
With change-over contacts on the
relay, the timer could switch the load
on or off for the timing period, for
other applications.
The timer is based on a PICAXE08M microcontroller. It is toggled
on or off whenever pushbutton S1
is pressed. LED1 and the relay are
on when the pin 3 output is high
during timing mode. LED2 flashes
when the pin 5 output is high during timing and gives an indication of
the time delay remaining by varying
the mark-to-space ratio of the flash.
If the LED flash is long, the time
delay has only just started; if the
250VAC
CONTACTS
A
K
PICAXE refrigerator
timer for cafes
RLY1
K
3
IC1
7
5
P0 PICAXE P2
-08
22k
10k
P4
B
E
GND
IN
C
GND
OUT
minutes for each subsequent press
of S1. As during start up, indication
of the time selected is provided by
LED2 flashing once for every 10
minutes of time delay.
When the setting of 180 minutes
(18 flashes) is exceeded, the delay
rolls over to 10 minutes (one flash).
The delay is written to EEPROM so
that the setting is retained even with
power disconnected. The set-up
mode is completed by powering off,
waiting a few seconds (for the power
supply capacitors to discharge) and
then powering on again.
The delay selected (in 10 minuteincrements) is again indicated by the
number of flashes of LED2.
The PICAXE program can be
adjusted to suit the timing application required. Accuracy of the timer
depends on the internal PICAXE08M
clock and was found to be about 40
seconds slow per hour. This can be
adjusted in the software if more accuracy is required.
The software, CafeTimerV4.bas,
can be downloaded from the SILICON
CHIP website.
Philip Webb,
Hope Valley, SA. ($40)
siliconchip.com.au
ON/OFF
10k
S4
RESET
10k
LED1
λ
PIEZO
SPEAKER
4
RUN
7
PROG
PROGRAMMING
SOCKET
P3
P0
2 SER
IN
22k
1
Vdd
P4
3
IC1
5
PICAXE P2
-08
P1
Vss
8
6
10k
LED2
λ
10k
LED3
λ
S5
S1 RIGHT
330Ω
S2 CENTRE
330Ω
100nF
10 µF
16V
4.5V
(3 CELLS)
S3 LEFT
330Ω
10k
PICAXE I/O
demonstrator circuit
SILICON CHIP has published many
projects based on the PICAXE-08M
microcontroller and they have all
had one thing in common: the inputs are inputs and the outputs are
outputs. The bi-directional input/
output (I/O) pins are not used as
both inputs and outputs in the same
program.
This circuit has been devised to
demonstrate how this may be done.
Three of the PICAXE pins are fitted
with pushbuttons as input devices
and LEDs as output devices.
In each case, input current flows
through the pushbutton and a 10kΩ
resistor while the output current
passes through the LED and a 330Ω
resistor. When operating as an input,
the LED is reverse-biased by having
its cathode connected to the positive rail each time the pushbutton
is pressed and the input is pulled
high via the 10kΩ resistor.
Current also flows through the
330Ω resistor to the 0V rail and while
this resistor places extra load on the
battery supply, it has no effect on the
way the input operates.
When operating as an output, the
10kΩ resistor can be ignored, with
the current passing through the
forward-biased LED and the 330Ω
resistor to the 0V rail. One other possibility is for someone to operate the
pushbutton while the output is being driven. Once again the LED will
be reverse-biased and any current
will be limited by the 10kΩ resistor
to prevent damage to the PICAXE
output. While the button remains
pressed, the LED will also turn off.
This should not cause a problem in
most programs.
These concepts could be extended, with the output LEDs being part
of an optocoupler and by adding
driver components there is the possibility of controlling relays, horns
and various other devices while still
retaining the combined I/O circuit
concept.
As far as programming is concerned, note that when a PICAXE
08M powers up, the bi-directional
pins are set as inputs. If outputs are
needed, these must be set up by the
program.
The program can also restore the
pin to an input if needed.
When setting up an output, you
have a choice of setting it high (on) or
low (off). This is not necessary with
inputs where the logic state is determined by the voltage on the pin.
Three demo programs have been
written to give examples. The listing
is 3demogames_pgm.bas and will
be available for download from the
SILICON CHIP website.
Ian Robertson,
Engadine, NSW. ($40)
Contribute And Choose Your Prize
As you can see, we pay good money
for each of the “Circuit Notebook”
items published in SILICON CHIP. But
there are four more reasons to send
in your circuit idea. Each month, at
the discretion of the editor, the best
contribution published will entitle
the author to choose the prize: an
LCR40 LCR meter, a DCA55 Semiconductor Component Analyser, an
ESR60 Equivalent Series Resistance
Analyser or an SCR100 Thyristor &
Triac Analyser, with the compliments
siliconchip.com.au
of Peak Electronic Design Ltd – see
www.peakelec.co.uk
So now you have even more reasons
to send that brilliant circuit in. Send it to
SILICON CHIP and you could be a winner.
You can either email your idea to
silchip<at>siliconchip.com.au or post it
to PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097.
September 2010 91
Circuit Notebook – Continued
S1
Magnetic pole & flux
strength indicator
This circuit can identify whether a magnet’s North
or South pole is placed against it and gives a rough
indication of the magnetic flux density and hence the
strength of the magnet. It is based around a ratiometric
linear Hall Effect sensor (IC1 – UGN3503U, Jaycar ZD1902). This will run from 4.5-6V but for convenience
the meter has been designed to run from a 9V battery.
IC1 draws 8-12mA depending on its supply voltage
and manufacturing variations. The series 470Ω resistor ensures that even at the lowest current level, the
voltage at pin 1 does not exceed 6V.
A 5V linear regulator (eg, 78L05) could be included
for extended battery life. This should be used to power
the whole circuit (including VR1), in which case the
470Ω resistor is replaced with a link. A low dropout,
low quiescent current regulator (eg, LP2981) would
be even better.
Power is applied via pushbutton switch S1. Since it
is not a latching switch, the meter cannot be accidentally left on. The 10µF capacitor bypasses the supply
and smooths out any voltage spikes which might occur
initially when the meter is switched on.
IC1’s output is around half-supply (typically 2.5V) in
the absence of a magnetic field and the output voltage
increases or decreases with the detected field, depending on its polarity. Potentiometer VR1 is adjusted so
Automatic
exterior light
This circuit switches on an outdoor light for an adjustable time period when light from other sources,
such as car headlights, is detected
during the night.
There are three light sensors:
LDRs1-3 (ORP12 or a similar type).
They are mounted in weatherproof
housings, each with a magnifier lens
orientated in the appropriate direction. LDR1 and LDR2 are used to
trigger the lamp in response to light
while LDR3 monitors the ambient
light level, to avoid turning on the
light during the day.
Power is derived from a 9V mains
transformer. Its output is rectified
with a full-wave voltage doubler,
providing roughly 24V which is then
regulated to around 12V by a discrete
regulator comprising NPN transistor
Q1 and 13V zener diode ZD1.
Each LDR is used as half of a
voltage divider with the other half
92 Silicon Chip
470
IC1
UGN3503U
METER
1
3
10 µF
16V
2
22k
VR1
2k
25T
+
9V
BATTERY
100 – 0 –100 A
BRANDED
SIDE
1
2
3
UGN3503U
that no current flows through the moving-coil meter
in the quiescent state. The 22kΩ resistor, in combination with VR1, converts IC1’s output from a voltage to
a current that so it can drive the meter.
If a south magnetic pole is placed near the branded
face of the sensor, its output will go positive and the
meter will deflect to the right. A north magnetic pole
will cause it to deflect to the left. The meter is not
calibrated so it can only give an indication of relative
field strength. For use with very strong magnets, the
22kΩ resistor may need to be increased in value (eg, to
33kΩ) if the meter range is insufficient. Alternatively,
better resolution can be achieved for weak magnets
with a lower-value series resistor.
Brett Cupitt,
Ashfield, NSW. ($30)
consisting of a fixed and a variable
resistor. The resulting voltage is
compared to a half-supply level
(about 6.2V) formed by fixed voltage
dividers made up of 47kΩ resistors.
Op amps IC1-IC3 are used as comparators. By adjusting trimpot VR1,
LDR1’s sensitivity to light can be
varied and similarly with VR2 and
VR3 for the other two LDRs.
When light falls on an LDR its
resistance drops. When the light
is bright enough (as determined by
its associated potentiometer), the
voltage at the associated op amp’s
non-inverting input voltage becomes
lower than that of its inverting input.
As a result, the op amp’s output
swings low, switching off the driven
NPN transistor (Q2, Q3 or Q4). This
turns off the indicator LED (LED1,
LED2 or LED3).
Op amps IC1 & IC2 control 555
timer IC4. It is configured as a
monostable oscillator with its timeconstant set by trimpot VR4. Its
trigger input is normally held high
by a 1kΩ pull-up resistor but when
light falls on either LDR1 or LDR2
and the associated op amp output
goes low, the trigger pin is pulled
low via either diodes D3 or D4, triggering the timer.
When triggered, pin 3 of IC4 goes
high, lighting LED4. If it is night
time, current will also flow from this
output through the internal LED of
optocoupler OPTO1, then through
Q4 to ground. During the day, Q4
is switched off so OPTO1 will not
be activated.
When OPTO1’s LED is powered,
the gate of TRIAC1 is connected to
the mains Active line via a 220Ω
resistor, triggering the TRIAC and
turning on the external 230V AC
lamp. When IC4 is triggered, the paralleled 220µF and 330µF capacitors
are discharged but they then slowly
charge via VR4 and after the chosen
time period the timer switches off
the lamp, ready to be triggered again.
Rob Leplaw,
Oatley, NSW. ($45)
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
September 2010 93
LDR3
100k
VR3
1M
LDR2
51k
VR2
50k
LDR1
51k
VR1
50k
47k
47k
47k
47k
47k
47k
3
2
3
2
3
2
4
IC3
741
7
4
IC2
741
7
4
IC1
741
7
6
47nF
6
47nF
6
47nF
1k
6.8k
1k
6.8k
1k
6.8k
B
K
A
510
B
K
A
510
B
K
A
510
E
Q4
BC337
LED3
C
E
Q3
BC337
LED2
C
E
Q2
BC337
C
LED1
D4
D3
A
A
A
K
D3, D4: 1N4148
K
K
330 F
ADJUST
ON TIME
1k
A
5
3
K
10nF
4
ZD1
1
IC4
555
8
A
K
D1, D2: 1N4004
220 F
2
6
7
VR4
500k
K
A
100nF
E
K
A
LEDS
LED4
2
1
220
510
ZD1
13V
510
A
K
B
C
Q1 BC337
6
1
K
A
K
A
3
220
MOC3021
4
6
OPTO1
MOC3021
100 F
100 F
This automatic exterior light circuit uses three LDRs to sense the light conditions and control comparators IC1-IC3. IC1
& IC2 control 555 timer IC4 which in turn drives optocoupler OPTO1 and TRIAC1 to switch the lamp. LDR3 & IC3 turn
Q4 off during the day, so OPTO 1 will not be activated.
AMBIENT
SENSE
SENSITIVITY
SENSE 2
SENSITIVITY
SENSE 1
SENSITIVITY
+12.4V
E
G
B
F1
230VAC
TRIAC1
BT137/600V
C
BC337
A1
T1
A2
A1
G
BT137
230V
LAMP
A
N
N
E
230VAC INPUT
A
10nF
275VAC
X2
WARNING: ALL PARTS
IN THIS SECTION
OPERATE AT 230VAC
100 H
A2
D2
9VAC
D1
K
K
A
LEDS
13
A
1k
IC1f
5.6k
12
G
SCR1-7: 2N5060
100nF
G
K
SCR7 A
5.6k
10
1k
G
K
SCR6 A
1k
G
5.6k
8
1k
G
5.6k
6
K
5.6k
3
7
1k
G
K
SCR1 A
0V
START
S1
100 F
+9V
S2
5.6k
560
K
LED1
A
1
5.6k
2
1k
G
K
SCR2 A
IC1a
560
R1
150k C2
100nF
C1
10 F
Are your SILICON CHIP copies
getting damaged or dogeared just lying around in
a cupboard or on a shelf?
Can you quickly find a
particular issue that you
need to refer to?
IC1a - IC1f = 4584
1k
G
4
560
R2
150k C4
100nF
SCR3 A
5
IC1c
100nF
560
150k
K
SCR4 A
9
IC1d
100nF
150k
K
SCR5 A
11
IC1e
150k
560
K
K
K
K
LED2
A
PLUS P
&P
94 Silicon Chip
IC1b
Issues Getting $14.95
Dog-Eared?
Available Aust, only. Price: $A14.95 plus $10.00 p&p per
order (includes GST). Just fill in and mail the handy order
form in this issue; or fax (02) 9939 2648; or call (02) 9939
3295 and quote your credit card number.
100nF
560
K
A
LED6
10 F
A
LED5
10 F
A
LED4
10 F
A
LED3
C3
10 F
REAL
VALUE
AT
Keep your copies of SILICON CHIP
safe, secure and always available
with these handy binders
14
150k
10 F
This circuit turns on six LEDs in turn with each one
lighting for a preset time. With relays in place of the
LEDs, it could be used to control six separate functions
such as lights on a model railway layout.
Each LED or relay is switched via a 2N5060 SCR and
there are essentially six identical SCR sections which
are cascaded. The first SCR is triggered on by pressing
start switch S1 which applies voltage to the gate.
When each SCR switches on its LED or relay load,
it also applies the supply voltage to an RC network
consisting of a 10µF capacitor and 150kΩ resistor. This
causes the voltage at the junction of the RC network to
drop slowly as the capacitor is charged. This voltage is
fed to one input of a 4584 CMOS hex Schmitt trigger
inverter, IC1.
So after SCR1 has been triggered on, the voltage
at the pin 1 input of 1C1a will eventually drop to its
threshold voltage and the pin 2 output will go high,
triggering SCR2 and thereby turning on its LED (or
relay). SCR2 also turns off SCR1 by pulling its anode
low via 100nF capacitor C2.
SCR2’s RC network is then brought into play and
it turns on SCR3 after the associated 10µF capacitor
C2 has charged sufficiently for IC2a to change state.
SCR3 turns off SCR2 via C4 and so the process goes
on until SCR7 is turned on. It stays on until switch S1
is pressed to trigger SCR1. SCR1 then turns off SCR7
via the associated 100nF capacitor and then the whole
timing process is repeated.
The time delay for each LED, except LED7, can be
varied by changing value of the resistors or capacitors
in the RC networks.
A. J. Lowe,
Bardon. Qld. ($40)
100nF
560
K
LED7
6-stage cascaded timer
uses SCRs
A
Circuit Notebook – Continued
siliconchip.com.au
ASK SILICON CHIP
Got a technical problem? Can’t understand a piece of jargon or some technical principle? Drop us a line
and we’ll answer your question. Write to: Ask Silicon Chip, PO Box 139, Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097 or
send an email to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
GPS Car Computer
enhancements
I am writing in relation to the GPS
Car Computer featured in the January 2010 issue. Unless I have missed
something in the article, it appears
that the basic “GPS Car Computer”
has no on-board memory in which to
store collected data for later analysis
on a desktop PC via the USB port. The
article seems to suggest that a laptop
computer has to be connected to the
GPS-CC when the vehicle is being
driven in order to be of any value.
So my question is could a future
project be designed that adds a nonvolatile memory component to this
very useful device and software provided for installing on any PC, so that
a full trip profile can be obtained at the
conclusion of the trip? In the interest
of road safety it would obviously be
impractical to use the device connected to a laptop if the driver were
to be the sole occupant of the vehicle.
It could only be used in this configuration when there is a passenger and
as such, couldn’t be used as a satnav
replacement at all times.
Although the GPS-CC device is obviously not a replacement for the “Davis
Instruments CarChip”, a version of
which was reviewed in SILICON CHIP
sometime ago, the DICC does allow for
data to be downloaded at the completion of a journey for later analysis. (P.
M., Karabar, NSW).
• We put your questions to the designer, Geoffrey Graham and this is
his reply:
You certainly have a high level of
requirements! Regarding tracking a
journey: it could be done but it would
take a redesign, the main difference being that a microcontroller with much
more flash memory would be required.
This type of chip is cheap enough
but they are mostly only available in
surface-mount TQFP packages with
0.2mm between the pins (three times
the width of a human hair!). They can
be soldered (I have done it) but you do
need to be adventurous and prepared
to ruin a chip or board or two.
Also, you are right. It is not a replacement for the “Davis Instruments
CarChip”. That was a completely different beast and much, much more
complex.
Fuel mixture display
needs air-flow input
I purchased a Smart Fuel Mixture
Display kit (SILICON CHIP, April 2004).
On installing it into the original set-up
in car with an oxygen sensor and airflow meter all works fine. My problem
arose when I removed the air-flow
meter, due to fitting a set of throttle
bodies which have no air-flow meter.
Is it possible to use the throttle position
sensor instead of the air-flow meter?
(J. W., via email).
• As the name suggests, “throttle position sensor” indicates throttle position rather than engine load. However,
it could be used instead of the air-flow
meter with the understanding that
the throttle position does not always
match the engine load, especially in
low gear.
Comparing electricity
and gas for heating
Over recent months, you have been
discussing various forms of energy and
their relative properties, advantages
and disadvantages. This question may
not be within the parameters you generally answer but I thought that SILICON
CHIP was a good place to start.
I have heard in the past that reverse
cycle air-conditioning is the cheapest
form of heating. In our lounge room we
have a gas room heater (fan assisted) as
well as reverse cycle A/C. Is it better
Upgrading The 12V Battery Charge Controller
I have just read a reply in “Ask
SILICON CHIP” for May 2010 about a
24V modification for the 12V Battery
Charge Controller published in the
April 2008 issue. It occurred to me
that this could possibly solve my
problem with a 48V golf-cart charging system.
The bank has six 8V Trojan T-875
wet cell, deep-cycle batteries which
I am charging with a standard 48V
centre-tap transformer/twin-diode
type charger. However, I would like
to upgrade it to the battery charge
controller system.
Would this be possible? As far as
siliconchip.com.au
I can determine the RC for these batteries is 295 (295 minutes <at> 25A), or
a 125Ah rating. My charger supplies
up to 20A on start up.
If what I ask is not viable can you
suggest an alternative or, better still,
can you describe a golf cart charger
with dual voltage 36V and 48V outputs? (J. N., Mt. Maunganui, NZ).
• The 24V modification for the
float charger as described in the May
2010 issue was for the March 2003
charger. However, the April 2008
charger design could be modified
for 36V and 48V.
For 36V, use a 330Ω 0.5W resistor
for the feed resistor from diode D1 to
24V zener diode ZD1. Also for 36V,
the divider at pin 2 needs changing – use an 82kΩ resistor instead
of 22kΩ for R1.
For 48V, use a 2.2kΩ 5W resistor
for the feed resistor from diode D1
to the 24V zener diode ZD1. Also
for 48V, use 120kΩ for R1. Mosfet
Q1 will require changing to a 100V
type such as the IRFB59N10DPBF
(100V 60A). This is available from
Farnell, Cat. 864-8786.
Use 20A wire and a 25A fuse. You
may also wish to thicken the current
carrying tracks with solder.
September 2010 95
Dual-Purpose Battery May Not Be The Best
The battery in my vehicle is possibly approaching the end of its life as
its open-cell voltage is around 12.3V,
although it still starts the vehicle reliably. I was considering purchasing
an all-rounder type which claims to
be both a deep-cycle type and to have
a good cold-cranking characteristic.
This would suit me on camping trips
for the occasional use of my Waeco
compressor fridge overnight.
My Subaru Forester does not have
space for an extra battery under
the bonnet so I thought this idea
has some merit. The fridge has a
low voltage cut-out feature so overdischarging the battery is unlikely.
I vaguely remember some articles
some years ago in SILICON CHIP indicating that car charging systems
never charged the vehicle battery
beyond 70% of its capacity.
Is this correct and would I be
deluding myself buying this type of
battery for a dual-purpose use? (M.
T., Donvale, Vic).
• The open-circuit voltage does not
indicate whether a battery is nearing
the end of its life. A battery’s voltage is dependent on its charge state,
temperature and the time since it
was last charged or used. Its voltage
will drop with load and the fact that
the car starts reliably suggests the
battery is still OK.
Conditions for a battery in a ve(read cheaper) for us to use electricity
(A/C) or gas to obtain winter warmth?
(K. J., via email).
• That’s a very interesting question.
There are a number of factors to be considered. The first of these is the energy
hicle are not ideal because it operates at high temperatures and the
battery is charged to its end-point
voltage (that does not appear to have
temperature compensation in most
cars) and it is not brought back to
float charge voltage (lower than the
end-point voltage) after full charge.
In addition, a car battery needs to
be designed for the heavy cranking
current required by the starter motor
and this means that it has thin plates
that allow rapid current delivery.
A deep-cycle battery on the other
hand may not have sufficient cold
cranking capability since the plates
in these batteries are heavier. It’s
unlikely that a battery that’s claimed
to have a high cold-cranking current
would also be a deep-cycle type. Instead, it’s likely to be a compromise
construction for both applications.
The state of charge for a car battery
really depends on the alternator current that can charge the battery and
drive the battery load. Battery load
can be higher than the alternator
current if the lights and accessories
like the sound system are all on and
the engine is idling.
It may be more advantageous to
use a larger battery designed for cars
(with the cold-cranking capability)
rather than opt for a compromise
design battery that may be better for
deep-cycle applications.
tariffs for gas and electricity. Depending on where you live in Australia and
how much you consume each quarter
(three months), the domestic electricity tariff can be anywhere between 16
and 20 cents per kilowatt-hour + GST.
If you are unfortunate enough to have
opted for a Smart Energy Meter (Smart
for the Electricity Retailers; really
dumb for the consumer!), your tariff in
peak periods could be up to 40 cents/
kilowatt-hour or in some special cases,
up to $2/kilowatt-hour. But for most
people, the rate is around 20 cents/
kilowatt-hour.
By comparison, after do you the conversion from gas units to megajoules,
to kilowatt-hours, the typical rate for
gas is 7 cents/kilowatt-hour (including
GST). In Sydney, this is comparable
to the rate for off-peak electricity (for
hot water systems). All of the above
information can be gleaned from your
quarterly bills for gas and electricity
(3.6kWh = 1 megajoule and the gas rate
is 1.95 cents/megajoule).
The second factor to be considered
is the efficiency of reverse-cycle
air-conditioning. Typical domestic
air-conditioners have a coefficient of
performance (COP) of around three
which means that they will pump
3kW of heat while consuming 1kW of
electricity. However, they are not so efficient when they are used for heating
and the outside air must be reasonably
warm. By the time the outside air drops
to 4°C or below, air-conditioners no
longer work. Commercial units have
electrical booster elements so they can
still maintain comfortable conditions
but that means their efficiency is the
same as for electrical heating.
By the way, the Star rating used for
air-conditioners in Australia is effectively useless in trying to make these
comparisons.
Gas heating is typically more than
90% efficient and can be higher in the
case of some flued gas heaters (see the
Publisher’s Letter, June 2010).
So what is the answer? If you live
in an area where you have lots of
WARNING!
SILICON CHIP magazine regularly describes projects which employ a mains power supply or produce high voltage. All such
projects should be considered dangerous or even lethal if not used safely.
Readers are warned that high voltage wiring should be carried out according to the instructions in the articles. When
working on these projects use extreme care to ensure that you do not accidentally come into contact with mains AC voltages
or high voltage DC. If you are not confident about working with projects employing mains voltages or other high voltages,
you are advised not to attempt work on them. Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd disclaims any liability for damages should
anyone be killed or injured while working on a project or circuit described in any issue of SILICON CHIP magazine.
Devices or circuits described in SILICON CHIP may be covered by patents. SILICON CHIP disclaims any liability for the infringement of such patents by the manufacturing or selling of any such equipment. SILICON CHIP also disclaims any liability
for projects which are used in such a way as to infringe relevant government regulations and by-laws.
Advertisers are warned that they are responsible for the content of all advertisements and that they must conform to the
Trade Practices Act 1974 or as subsequently amended and to any governmental regulations which are applicable.
96 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
FM Transmitter For Christmas Lights Display
I am hoping you may be able to
assist me. I am after a small FM transmitter that could transmit Christmas
Carols to cars driving past our light
display. The plan is to have a sign
with the frequency on the fence, then
if people choose they can listen to
our carols. This will mean we don’t
need to have the speaker volume
as loud.
I am wondering if there are any
stores in Victoria that sell something
like this? (C. H., Chadstone, Vic).
• Great idea, Colin. We published
FM stereo transmitter projects in
frosts and the outside air temperature
is often below 10°C, the chances are
that your gas heater is more efficient
and cheaper to run than reverse-cycle
air-conditioning.
A practical way to test this would be
to heat your room or house for several
nights with gas and then do the same
thing with the aircon. Compare the
electric and gas consumption in both
cases to get the answer.
One final aspect to consider is greenhouse gas emissions. In the case of the
gas heater, all the chemical energy of
the gas is consumed in the heater and
it is a relatively efficient process. In
the case of the air-conditioner, most
of the electricity it uses comes from
coal-fired power stations in Australia
and so the thermodynamic efficiency
of that process must be considered as
well as the transmission losses from
the power station to your home. We
would estimate the overall conversion
efficiency from coal to electricity in
your home to be not much more than
30%. When all that is considered, gas
is probably the best way.
Power window time
delay wanted
I was wondering if you have ever
designed a kit which allows the power
windows to be operated without the
ignition being on in cars with ECU’s
controlling the windows? It was easy
in the good old days when all that
was involved was a relay and the door
switches. Even a method of extending
the “power on” delay after turning off
the ignition would be a big improvesiliconchip.com.au
April 2001 and December 2002 but
they have now been discontinued.
You could probably still build one
of them provided you could still
obtain the relevant transmitter IC.
However, you can buy these units
as audio accessories from places like
JB Hifi or eBay.
Just coincidentally, we are working on a Christmas Lights Controller
which will be able to provide programming of multiple light channels
synchronised with music stored on
an SD card. We hope to publish the
first article next month.
ment. I would like to modify my Lexus
RX330. (N. S., Hamilton, NZ).
• Unfortunately, with central locking
and power windows being controlled
via the car’s ECU (or more correctly,
the Body Computer), there is no easy
way of extending the power window
use when the ignition is off. Some cars
allow the windows to be operated for a
limited time after the ignition is turned
off but before any doors are opened.
We have not developed a project
that would do the modification you
require. The Turbo Timer projects from
August 2007 or November 1998 could
perhaps be used to maintain power to
the window motors after the ignition
is switched off for a period of time.
However, whether the window actuating switches would work depends on
the car and how these are connected.
They may be monitored via the Body
Computer instead of just controlling
the window mechanism itself.
Wrong readings from
digital thermometer
I have finished building the High
Temperature Digital Thermometer
from “Performance Electronics for
Cars”. I believe I have done everything
correctly but the issue I have with this
unit is that the display reads in negative figures. The figures are still valid,
ie, 30° is still 30° and 20° is 20° and so
on, it’s just that it reads negative when
it should be positive.
I have tried reversing the thermocouple connections but as described
in the construction notes, temperature
readings go down when they should
NATIONAL
HRSA
RADIO and
PHONO
FEST
CANBERRA
Events
include
Bumper
Market
Sunday
Sept 19
Details:
www.hrsa.net.au
Richard Begbie
(02) 6238 2246
Sponsored by
Silicon Chip
Magazine
September 2010 97
Monster Class-A Amplifier Is Not Practical
I recently purchased two Studio
350 Amplifier modules (S ILICON
CHIP, January & February 2004) and
have been looking at the circuit. I
was wondering whether it was possible to lower the supply rails to
±55V and to increase the quiescent
current to 1.8A. This would run
the amplifier in Class-A up to 50W
before running in Class-B.
The amplifier would need to dissipate about 200W of heat so I would
need a large heatsink, possibly
forced air-cooling. I would obviously
need to increase the value of VR2 in
the Vbe multiplier.
Would there need to be any other
component value changes made to
the circuit? Any suggestions would
be greatly appreciated. (S. H., via
email).
• What you propose is certainly feasible and no circuit changes should
be necessary. Just reduce the supply
rails to ±55V and adjust trimpot VR2
go up etc. As it is the CX101b model,
the digital readout is wired as per Fig.4
on page 63.
It calibrates correctly and setting the
trip point works if I set it to a negative
temperature but then remains tripped
if I set to a positive number (as it would
because if it is reading backwards, then
to give a quiescent current of 1.8A.
However, we would not do it. For
a start, your modifications will mean
that you only get class-A operation
up to about 25W, not 50W into an
8-ohm load. Into a 4-ohm load you
would only get about 12.5W.
Second, you will need more filter
capacitors to get the hum on the supply rails down to reasonable levels.
You might need 40,000µF or more
on each supply rail and you would
need to incorporate the supply rail
modifications featured in our 20W
Class-A design described in May
2007.
Even if that is satisfactory, the
transformer will radiate a much
bigger hum field and will probably
buzz quite audibly. In fact, you might
need to put the power supply in its
own enclosure.
You will also need a fan-cooled
tunnel heatsink and the fan will
need to run continuously; another
ambient temperature would be far
above the trip point and so would not
become “untripped” until the ambient
temperature reaches minus whatever
you set it to).
After reversing the thermocouple
connections I set VR3 so that the reading was the same as ambient. However,
Notes & Errata
Dual Tracking ±0-19V Power Supply (June-July 2010): there are two
errors in the circuit diagram of Fig.2
in the June issue. The 820Ω resistor
connected to pin 1 of IC4a should
be 68Ω while the 100kΩ resistor
from Vout- to the top of VR7 should
be 10kΩ.
The layout diagram (Fig.8) in the
July 2010 issue is correct.
In addition, the wiring diagram
(Fig.11) shows the top and bottom
connections to the VOLT ADJ header
(CON6) transposed. Also, the leads
to pins 5 & 6 on the panel meter
must be transposed for the Altronics display.
Remote Controlled Digital Up/Down
98 Silicon Chip
Timer (August 2010): the relay contacts are incorrectly shown by the
screened overlay on the PC board.
The parts layout diagram of Fig.2
is correct. In addition, the LED
display part numbers are incorrect.
These should be 7DR8021BS and
7DR5621BS.
A couple of minor issues have
also surfaced in the software. First,
the alarm period is skipped if the
external trigger is active when the
countdown ends. Second, the device
ignores infrared signals if the reset
and trigger inputs are on simultaneously. The updated firmware
(1910810B.hex) fixes both issues
and has been forwarded to the kit
retailers.
source of noise. You will also substantially reduce the maximum power output by dint of reducing the
supply rails – from 200W down to
about 125W into 8-ohm loads and
from 350W down to about 215W into
4-ohm loads, although that will not
make a big audible difference.
Frankly, the more we think about
it, the less we like the idea. You
will be significantly compromising
the performance just to get the supposed “ideal” of Class-A operation.
Just because an amplifier is running
in Class-A does not make its performance above reproach.
If we wanted to improve on the
Studio 350 design, we would simply
try upgrading the output transistors
from MJL21193/4 to MJL1302A
and MJL3281A types, respectively.
These latter output transistors are
significantly more linear and should
give lower distortion at the higher
frequencies.
on checking calibration with the probe
removed and the wire from the positive thermocouple terminal to TP2 (as
per the calibration instructions), it is
some 50°C out. Have you any ideas?
(R. S., Lake Grace, WA).
• Try swapping the connections to
INHI and INLO on the LCD module
so that the negative readings are correctly showing a positive value. The
thermocouple probes need to be correct, with the positive and negative
leads oriented correctly, otherwise the
compensation circuit will be incorrect
and this would probably account for
the 50°C error.
Single-phase to 3-phase
converter wanted
I have a suggestion for a possible
SILICON CHIP project. I bought some
secondhand machines that have
3-phase 415V motors but I only have
a single-phase 230VAC supply to
my house and workshop. Variable
frequency drives (VFDs) are available
to allow 3-phase motors to run from
single-phase power but these seem
more elaborate than they need to be.
I can’t find anything that will keep
. . . continued on page 103
siliconchip.com.au
SILICON
SILIC
CHIP
siliconchip.com.au
YOUR DETAILS
6 MONTH SUBS
AND
AUTO RENEWAL
NOW
AVAILABLE
Your Name_________________________________________________________
Order Form/Tax Invoice
Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd
ABN 49 003 205 490
PO BOX 139, COLLAROY NSW 2097
email: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Phone (02) 9939 3295 Fax (02) 9939 2648
This form may be photocopied without infringing copyright.
(PLEASE PRINT)
Address____________________________________________________________________________________________________
Postcode__________
Daytime Phone No. (
)____________________ Email address ________________________________
Method of Payment: q EFT (ring or email for details) q Cheque/Money Order q PayPal
q Visa Card
q Master Card
Card No. Card expiry date:
Signature_________________________________________________
YOUR ORDER (SILICON CHIP PRINTED EDITION SUBSCRIBERS# QUALIFY FOR 10% DISCOUNT (except on subscriptions!)
SIMPLY TICK THE ITEMS REQUIRED – DON'T FORGET TO FILL IN DETAILS ABOVE. WE'LL WORK THE TOTAL OUT FOR YOU AND SEND YOU A RECEIPT WITH YOUR ORDER
SILICON CHIP SUBSCRIPTIONS (all prices include P&P)
SILICON CHIP BOOKSHOP (P&P additional – See below)
q AUSTRALIA 6 MONTHS (INC. GST) (NEW!).......................................................$49.50
q AUSTRALIA 12 MONTHS (INC. GST)..................................................................$94.50
q AUSTRALIA 12 MONTHS WITH BINDER (INC. GST) .......................................$111.00
q AUSTRALIA 24 MONTHS (INC. GST)................................................................$182.00
q AUSTRALIA 24 MONTHS WITH 2 BINDERS (INC. GST) .................................$215.00
q NEW ZEALAND 6 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) (NEW!)............................................ $AU55.00
q NEW ZEALAND 12 MONTHS (AIR MAIL)....................................................... $AU99.00
q NEW ZEALAND 24 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) ................................................... $AU196.00
q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 6 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) (NEW!)............................. $AU75.00
q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 12 MONTHS (AIR MAIL)...................................... $AU135.00
q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 24 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) .................................... $AU260.00
NEW! CONVENIENT AUTOMATIC SUBSCRIPTION RENEWAL:
q Tick here if you'd like us to automatically renew your subscription when it elapses
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
(ie, 6 month, 12 month or 24 month). We'll renew until you tell us to stop!
BACK ISSUES/ARTICLE PHOTOCOPIES
q
SILICON CHIP BACK ISSUES*; SC/EA/ETI PHOTOCOPIES
– includes P&P – $12.00 within Australia; $15.00 overseas
*where in stock - photocopy of article supplied where issue is out of stock. EA/ETI: no back
issues left, only photocopies available. Price is for each back issue or each article photocopy.
Nominate issue and article required: Month:...................................... Year:.........................
Article required:....................................................................................................................
Please attach list if more than one back issue or photocopy required. There is a 10%
discount for ten or more back issues and/or photocopies (no further discount applies).
SILICON CHIP MAGAZINE BINDERS
q
Embossed "SILICON CHIP", securely holds 12 months+ of issues
Available in Australia only.......................................................................................$14.95
(P&P is $10.00 per order; buy five or more in one order for FREE P&P)
P&P RATES:
Subscriptions, back issues and project reprints: P&P included
Binders (available Australia only): $10.00 per order; for 5 or more P&P is free.
Books: Aust. $10 per order; NZ: $AU12 per book; Elsewhere $AU18 per book
To
eMAIL (24/7)
Place
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Your
with order & credit card details
siliconchip.com.au
Order:
OR
FAX (24/7)
This form (or a photocopy) to
(02) 9939 2648 with all details
AC MACHINES................................................................................................ $66.00
AMATEUR SCIENTIST CD NEW! Version 4.0................................................. $62.00
AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN – SELF (NEW 5th EDITION) ..............$130.00
BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE (NEW)....................................$47.95
DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES ........................................................................ $95.00
ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES.................................................................. $60.00
ELECTRONIC PROJECTS FOR CARS (2003) – last few, shop-soiled – now... $2.95
HANDS-ON ZIGBEE ....................................................................................... $96.50
NEWNES GUIDE TO TELEVISION AND VIDEO TECHNOLOGY........................ $70.00
OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE.......................................................................... $120. 00
PERFORMANCE ELECTRONICS FOR CARS.................................................... $19.80
PIC IN PRACTICE........................................................................................... $65.00
PIC MICROCONTROLLERS - KNOW IT ALL................................................... $90.00
PIC MICROCONTROLLER - PERSONAL INTRO COURSE............................... $60.00
PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV (7th edition)...................................... $49.00
PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK .......................................................................... $90.00
PRACT. VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES/POWER ELECT...................................... $105.00
PROGRAMMING 16-BIT MICROCONTROLLERS IN C.................................... $90.00
RADIO, TV AND HOBBIES ON DVD-ROM ...................................................... $62.00
RF CIRCUIT DESIGN...................................................................................... $75.00
SELF ON AUDIO (2nd edition)........................................................................ $90.00
SOLAR SUCCESS - GETTING IT RIGHT EVERY TIME..................................... $47.50
SOLAR THAT REALLY WORKS ...................................................................... $42.50
SWITCHING POWER SUPPLIES A-Z (inc CD-ROM)..................................... $115.00
TV ACROSS AUSTRALIA ............................................................................... $49.95
USING UBUNTU LINUX.................................................................................. $27.00
#10% discount offer does not apply to online edition subscribers nor to website orders
OR
PAYPAL (24/7)
OR
Use PayPal to pay
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
*ALL ITEMS SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
MAIL
OR This form to PO Box 139,
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
your credit card details
Collaroy NSW 2097
September 2010 99
09/10
WANT TO SAVE 10%? S
C (PRINT EDITION)
AUTOMATICALLY QUALIFY FOR
REFERENCE $ave SUBSCRIBERS*
CHIP BOOKSHOP 10% A 10% DISCOUNT ON ALL BOOK PURCHASES!
SILICON
ILICON HIP
(*Does not apply to website orders)
SELF ON AUDIO
by Douglas Self 2nd Edition 2006 $69.00
PROGRAMMING and CUSTOMIZING THE
PICAXE By David Lincoln (2nd Ed, 2011) $65.00
See
Review
A great aid when wrestling with applications for the PICAXE
series of microcontrollers, at beginner, intermediate and advanced April
2011
levels. Every electronics class, school and library should have a copy,
A collection of 35 classic magazine articles offering a dependable methodology for designing audio power amplifiers to improve performance at every
point without significantly increasing cost. Includes compressors/limiters,
hybrid bipolar/FET amps, electronic switching and more. 474 pages in paperback.
along with anyone who works with PICAXEs. 300 pages in paperback
SMALL SIGNAL AUDIO DESIGN
By Douglas Self – First Edition 2010 $88.00
PIC IN PRACTICE
The latest from the Guru of audio. Explains audio concepts in easy-to-understand language with plenty of examples and reasoning. Inspiration for audio
designers, superb background for audio enthusiasts and especially where it comes to
component peculiarities and limitations. Expensive? Yes. Value for money? YES! Highly
recommended. 558 pages in paperback.
by D W Smith. 2nd Edition - published 2006 $60.00
Based on popular short courses on the PIC, for professionals, students and
teachers. Can be used at a variety of levels. An ideal introduction to the world
of microcontrollers. 255 pages in paperback.
AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN HANDBOOK
PIC MICROCONTROLLER – your personal introduc-
by Douglas Self – 5th Edition 2009 $81.00
tory course By John Morton 3rd edition 2005. $60.00
"The Bible" on audio power amplifiers. Many revisions and
updates to the previous edition and now has an extra three
chapters covering Class XD, Power Amp Input Systems and
Input Processing and Auxiliarly Subsystems. Not cheap and not a book
for the beginner but if you want the best reference on Audio Power Amps,
you want this one! 463 pages in paperback.
A unique and practical guide to getting up and running with the PIC. It assumes no knowledge of microcontrollers – ideal introduction for students,
teachers, technicians and electronics enthusiasts. Revised 3rd edition
focuses entirely on re-programmable flash PICs such as 16F54, 16F84 12F508 and
12F675. 226 pages in paperback.
PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV
OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE
By Garry Cratt – Latest (7th) Edition 2008 $49.00
By Carter & Mancini – 3RD EDITION $100.00
Written in Australia, for Australian conditions by one of Australia's foremost
satellite TV experts. If there is anything you wanted to know about setting
up a satellite TV system, (including what you can't do!) it's sure to be covered in this
176-page paperback book.
Substantially updates coverage for low-speed and high-speed applications,
and provides step-by-step walk-throughs for design and selection of op
amps. Huge 648 pages!
PROGRAMMING 32-bit MICROCONTROLLERS
IN C By Luci di Jasio (2008) $79.00
NEWNES GUIDE TO TV & VIDEO TECHNOLOGY
By KF Ibrahim 4th Edition (Published 2007) $49.00
Subtitled Exploring the PIC32, a Microchip insider tells all on this powerful
PIC! Focuses on examples and exercises that show how to solve common,
real-world design problems quickly. Includes handy checklists. FREE CD-ROM includes
source code in C, the Microchip C30 compiler, and MPLAB SIM. 400 pages paperback.
It's back! Provides a full and comprehensive coverage of video and television technology including HDTV and DVD. Starts with fundamentals so is
ideal for students but covers in-depth technologies such as Blu-ray, DLP,
Digital TV, etc so is also perfect for engineers. 600+ pages in paperback.
USING UBUNTU LINUX
RF CIRCUIT DESIGN
by J Rolfe & A Edney – published 2007 $27.00
by Chris Bowick, Second Edition, 2008. $63.00
Ubuntu Linux is a free and easy-to-use operating system, a viable alternative to Windows and Mac OS. Introduces Ubuntu, tells how to set it up,
covers the various Open Office applications and gives troubleshooting
hints and tips. Highly recommended. 222 pages in paperback
DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES
by K.F. Ibrahim. Published 2003. $71.00
A guide to DVD technology and applications, with particular focus on design issues and pitfalls, maintenance and repair. Ideal
for engineers, technicians, students of consumer electronics
and sales and installation staff. 319 pages in paperback.
The classic RF circuit design book. RF circuit design is now more important
that ever in the wireless world. In most of the wireless devices that we use
there is an RF component – this book tells how to design and integrate in a very practical fashion. 244 pages in paperback.
PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK
See
Review
Feb
2004
by Ian Hickman. 4th edition 2006 $61.00
A guide to RF design for engineers, technicians, students and enthusiasts.
Covers key topics in RF: analog design principles, transmission lines,
couplers, transformers, amplifiers, oscillators, modulation, transmitters
and receivers, propagation and antennas. 279 pages in paperback.
ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES
PRACTICAL VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES &
POWER ELECTRONICS
Se
By Austin Hughes - Third edition 2006 $51.00
Intended for non-specialist users of electric motors and drives,
filling the gap between academic texts and general "handbooks".
Explores all of the widely-used modern types of motor and drive
including conventional & brushless DC, induction motors, steppers, servos, synchronous and reluctance. 384 pages, soft cover.
e
Review
Feb
An essential reference for engineers and anyone who wishes
2003
to design or use variable speed drives for induction motors.
by Malcolm Barnes. 1st Ed, Feb 2003. $73.00
286 pages in soft cover.
BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE
AC MACHINES
by Carl Vogel. Published 2009. $40.00
By Jim Lowe Published 2006 $66.00
Applicable to Australian trades-level courses including NE10 AC Machines,
NE12 Synchronous Machines and the AC part of NE30 Electric Motor Control
and Protection. Covering polyphase induction motors, single-phase motors,
synchronous machines and polyphase motor starting. 160 pages in paperback.
Alternative fuel expert Carl Vogel gives you a hands-on guide with
the latest technical information and easy-to-follow instructions
for building a two-wheeled electric vehicle – from a streamlined
scooter to a full-sized motorcycle. 384 pages in soft cover.
NOTE: ALL PRICES ARE PLUS P&P – AUSTRALIA ONLY: $10.00 per order;
OR
FAX (24/7)
OR
NZ – $12.00 PER BOOK;
PAYPAL (24/7)
REST OF WORLD $18.00 PER BOOK
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
eMAIL (24/7)
OR
To
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
Your order and card details to
Use your PayPal account
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Place
100 S
ilicon
C
hip
with order & credit card details
(02) 9939 2648 with all details
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
with order & credit card details
Your
Or use the handy order form on P105 of this issue
Order:
1-13
See
Review
March
2010
OR
MAIL
Your order to PO Box 139
siliconchip.com.au
Collaroy NSW 2097
*ALL TITLES SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST
WANT TO SAVE 10%? S
C (PRINT EDITION)
AUTOMATICALLY QUALIFY FOR
REFERENCE $ave SUBSCRIBERS*
CHIP BOOKSHOP 10% A 10% DISCOUNT ON ALL BOOK PURCHASES!
SILICON
ILICON
HIP
(*Does not apply to website orders)
SELF ON AUDIO
PROGRAMMING and CUSTOMIZING THE
PICAXE By David Lincoln (2nd Ed, 2011) $65.00
by Douglas Self 2nd Edition 2006 $69.00
See
A collection of 35 classic magazine articles offering a dependable methodology for designing audio power amplifiers to improve performance at every
point without significantly increasing cost. Includes compressors/limiters,
hybrid bipolar/FET amps, electronic switching and more. 474 pages in paperback.
Review
A great aid when wrestling with applications for the PICAXE
series of microcontrollers, at beginner, intermediate and advanced April
2011
levels. Every electronics class, school and library should have a copy,
along with anyone who works with PICAXEs. 300 pages in paperback
SMALL SIGNAL AUDIO DESIGN
PIC IN PRACTICE
By Douglas Self – First Edition 2010 $88.00
by D W Smith. 2nd Edition - published 2006 $60.00
The latest from the Guru of audio. Explains audio concepts in easy-to-understand language with plenty of examples and reasoning. Inspiration for audio
designers, superb background for audio enthusiasts and especially where it comes to
component peculiarities and limitations. Expensive? Yes. Value for money? YES! Highly
recommended. 558 pages in paperback.
Based on popular short courses on the PIC, for professionals, students and
teachers. Can be used at a variety of levels. An ideal introduction to the world
of microcontrollers. 255 pages in paperback.
PIC MICROCONTROLLER – your personal introduc-
AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN HANDBOOK
tory course By John Morton 3rd edition 2005. $60.00
by Douglas Self – 5th Edition 2009 $81.00
A unique and practical guide to getting up and running with the PIC. It assumes no knowledge of microcontrollers – ideal introduction for students,
teachers, technicians and electronics enthusiasts. Revised 3rd edition
focuses entirely on re-programmable flash PICs such as 16F54, 16F84 12F508 and
12F675. 226 pages in paperback.
"The Bible" on audio power amplifiers. Many revisions and
updates to the previous edition and now has an extra three
chapters covering Class XD, Power Amp Input Systems and
Input Processing and Auxiliarly Subsystems. Not cheap and not a book
for the beginner but if you want the best reference on Audio Power Amps,
you want this one! 463 pages in paperback.
OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE
PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV
By Carter & Mancini – 3RD EDITION $100.00
Substantially updates coverage for low-speed and high-speed applications,
and provides step-by-step walk-throughs for design and selection of op
amps. Huge 648 pages!
By Garry Cratt – Latest (7th) Edition 2008 $49.00
Written in Australia, for Australian conditions by one of Australia's foremost
satellite TV experts. If there is anything you wanted to know about setting
up a satellite TV system, (including what you can't do!) it's sure to be covered in this
176-page paperback book.
PROGRAMMING 32-bit MICROCONTROLLERS
IN C By Luci di Jasio (2008) $79.00
NEWNES GUIDE TO TV & VIDEO TECHNOLOGY
Subtitled Exploring the PIC32, a Microchip insider tells all on this powerful
PIC! Focuses on examples and exercises that show how to solve common,
real-world design problems quickly. Includes handy checklists. FREE CD-ROM includes
source code in C, the Microchip C30 compiler, and MPLAB SIM. 400 pages paperback.
By KF Ibrahim 4th Edition (Published 2007) $49.00
It's back! Provides a full and comprehensive coverage of video and television technology including HDTV and DVD. Starts with fundamentals so is
ideal for students but covers in-depth technologies such as Blu-ray, DLP,
Digital TV, etc so is also perfect for engineers. 600+ pages in paperback.
USING UBUNTU LINUX
by J Rolfe & A Edney – published 2007 $27.00
RF CIRCUIT DESIGN
Ubuntu Linux is a free and easy-to-use operating system, a viable alternative to Windows and Mac OS. Introduces Ubuntu, tells how to set it up,
covers the various Open Office applications and gives troubleshooting
hints and tips. Highly recommended. 222 pages in paperback
DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES
by K.F. Ibrahim. Published 2003. $71.00
A guide to DVD technology and applications, with particular focus on design issues and pitfalls, maintenance and repair. Ideal
for engineers, technicians, students of consumer electronics
and sales and installation staff. 319 pages in paperback.
by Chris Bowick, Second Edition, 2008. $63.00
The classic RF circuit design book. RF circuit design is now more important
that ever in the wireless world. In most of the wireless devices that we use
there is an RF component – this book tells how to design and integrate in a very practical fashion. 244 pages in paperback.
See
Review
Feb
2004
PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK
by Ian Hickman. 4th edition 2006 $61.00
A guide to RF design for engineers, technicians, students and enthusiasts.
Covers key topics in RF: analog design principles, transmission lines,
couplers, transformers, amplifiers, oscillators, modulation, transmitters
and receivers, propagation and antennas. 279 pages in paperback.
ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES
By Austin Hughes - Third edition 2006 $51.00
PRACTICAL VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES &
POWER ELECTRONICS
Se
Intended for non-specialist users of electric motors and drives,
filling the gap between academic texts and general "handbooks".
Explores all of the widely-used modern types of motor and drive
including conventional & brushless DC, induction motors, steppers, servos, synchronous and reluctance. 384 pages, soft cover.
e
Review
Feb
An essential reference for engineers and anyone who wishes
2003
to design or use variable speed drives for induction motors.
by Malcolm Barnes. 1st Ed, Feb 2003. $73.00
286 pages in soft cover.
AC MACHINES
BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE
By Jim Lowe Published 2006 $66.00
Applicable to Australian trades-level courses including NE10 AC Machines,
NE12 Synchronous Machines and the AC part of NE30 Electric Motor
Control and Protection. Covering polyphase induction motors, singlephase motors, synchronous machines and polyphase motor starting. 160
pages in paperback.
by Carl Vogel. Published 2009. $40.00
Alternative fuel expert Carl Vogel gives you a hands-on guide with
the latest technical information and easy-to-follow instructions
for building a two-wheeled electric vehicle – from a streamlined
scooter to a full-sized motorcycle. 384 pages in soft cover.
NOTE: ALL PRICES ARE PLUS P&P – AUSTRALIA ONLY: $10.00 per order;
eMAIL (24/7)
To
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Place
siliconchip.com.au
with order & credit card details
Your
Order:
1-13
See
Review
March
2010
OR
FAX (24/7)
Your order and card details to
(02) 9939 2648 with all details
OR
NZ – $12.00 PER BOOK;
PAYPAL (24/7)
Use your PayPal account
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
OR
REST OF WORLD $18.00 PER BOOK
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
OR
MAIL
Your order to PO Box 139
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
SeptemberCollaroy
2010 101
NSW 2097
with order & credit card details
Or use the handy order form on P85 of this issue
*ALL TITLES SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST
MARKET CENTRE
Cash in your surplus gear. Advertise it here in SILICON CHIP
ELNEC IC PROGRAMMERS
High quality
Realistic prices
Free software updates
Large range of adaptors
Windows 95/98/Me/NT/2k/XP
C O N T R O L S
Tough times
demand innovative solutions!
ANSI C compilers, Windows IDE
AVR, TMS430, ARM7/ARM9
68HC08, 68HC11, 68HC12
GRANTRONICS PTY LTD
www.grantronics.com.au
FOR SALE
SPEAKERWORKS: technically qualified
specialist (45 years) vintage, professional, hifi speaker repairs. Original/
custom-made re-cones, diaphragms,
modifications and upgrades. swa<at>
speakerworks.com.au
RCS RADIO/DESIGN is at 41 Arlewis
St, Chester Hill 2162, NSW Australia
and has all the published PC boards
from SC, EA, ETI, HE, AEM & others. Ph
(02) 9738 0330. sales<at>rcsradio.com.
au; www.rcsradio.com.au
PCBs MADE, ONE OR MANY. Any
format, hobbyists welcome. Sesame
Electronics Phone (02) 9593 1025.
sesame<at>sesame.com.au
www.sesame.com.au
KINSTEN: Make your own PCBs. Presensitised PCBs, chemicals, tools and
Kynar wire. Phone 08 6465 9799 or order
at www.kinsten.com.au
LEDs! Nichia, Cree and other brand
102 Silicon Chip
Hurry - stocks are limited. Call
Avcomm now - (02) 9939 4377
SPK360
3/5/06used1:10
PM world-wide
Page 1
Made in Australia,
by OEMs
splat-sc.com
For more details visit www.avcomm.com.au
Battery Packs & Chargers
20 years experience!
HI-FISPEAKER REPAIRS
YOUR EXPERT SPEAKER REPAIR SPECIALISTS
Specialising in UK, US and Danish brands.
Speakerbits are your vintage, rare and collectable speaker
repair experts. Foam surrounds, voice coils, complete
recone kits and more. Original OEM parts for Scan-Speak,
Dynaudio, Tannoy, JBL, ElectroVoice and others!
Siomar Battery Engineering
SPK360
IMAGECRAFT C COMPILERS
YYes,
es, it’s
it’s ttrue!
rue! DDon’t
on’t llet
et iits
ts ttiny
iny ssize
ize ffool
ool yyou.
ou. TThis
his ppowerhouse
owerhouse
receiver
receiver ccovers
overs tthe
he AAM,
M, FFM,
M, LLW
W aand
nd eentire
ntire SSW
W bbands
ands ffrom
rom 33.5
5 to to3030MHz
MHz – –anand
d hahas
s gegenuine
nuine digdigital
ital sigsignal
nal prprocessing!
ocessing!
Exclusive to Avcomm,
the Tecsun PL-310
normally sells for
$90.00 but if you
say you saw it in
SILICON CHIP, Avcomm
will give you 10% off
(June/July only)!
CLEVERSCOPE
USB OSCILLOSCOPES
2 x 100MSa/s 10bit inputs + trigger
100MHz bandwidth
8 x digital inputs
4M samples/input
Sig-gen + spectrum analyser
Windows 98/Me/NT/2k/XP
WOW! A QUALITY
WOW!
QUALITY DSP
DSP
HFF C
H
COMMUNICATIONS
OMMUNICATIONS
R
ECEIVER FFOR
OR 1
0% O
FF?
RECEIVER
10%
OFF?
www.batterybook.com
Phone (08) 9302 5444
tel: 03 9647 7000 www.speakerbits.com
name LEDs at excellent prices. LED
drivers, including ultra-reliable linear
driver options. Many other interesting
and hard-to-find electronic items!
www.ledsales.com.au
terrystransistors.com.au: genuine
MJE15030/31 BD139/40 2SA970
BF469/470 MJE340/50 MJL4302A MJL4281A ON<at>$9.20 MJL21193/4 MJL1302A MJL3281A 2SA1085 MPSA42
Cheap postage.
HMI and PLC in One! Comfile Technologies CuTouch (CT1721-C). Also
available in Black and White screen
for viewing outdoors. The CuTOUCH
comes integrated with industrial con-
troller, Blue & White Graphic LCD,
touch-input processor, opto-isolated
I/O boards, analog inputs & outputs,
and Plug-n-Play support for Relay
boards. 64 I/O plus 6 channels PWM
or DAC, 4 external interrupts, and 2
16-bit counters.
The CuTOUCH units can be programmed in BASIC or Relay Ladder
Logic using the Cubloc Studio Software
available from our website. Applications can range anywhere from home
automation to industrial gas monitoring.
By providing easy-to-use GUI tools,
Comfile Technology guarantees you a
competitive edge over any other touch
screen products on the market today.
siliconchip.com.au
VIDEO - AUDIO - PC
distribution amps - splitters
digital standards converters - tbc's
switchers - cables - adaptors
genlockers - scan converters
bulk vga cable - wallplates
DVS5c & DVS5s
High Performance
Video / S-Video
and Audio Splitters
MD12 Media Distribution Amplifier
QUEST
®
Quest AV®
VGA Splitter
VGS2
HQ VGA
Cables
AWP1
A-V Wallplate
Come to the
specialists...
QUESTRONIX
®
Quest Electronics® Pty Limited abn 83 003 501 282 t/a Questronix
Products, Specials & Pricelist at www.questronix.com.au
fax (02) 4341 2795
phone (02) 4343 1970
email: questav<at>questronix.com.au
Ask SILICON CHIP –
continued from page 98
the frequency as is and just provide
three phases so that the motors will
operate at only one speed.
The machines have their own
arrangements for varying speed mechanically; all that I really need. I
don’t even need reversing capability.
Also, commercial VFDs all seem to
have displays and multiple switches
for speed variation and these add to
the complexity and cost which is not
insubstantial.
I am wondering if there is scope for
a DIY project that can provide for a
simpler solution to the need for operating 3-phase motors from a single
phase supply? I understand that there
is a variable – delta or star wiring –
that needs addressing. But assuming
a motor is configurable either way, a
230V 3-phase output should be all
that’s needed. (J. P., via email).
• Back in April 2000 we featured an
article on how to run 3-phase motors
from a single-phase 230VAC supply.
It involves using some 440VAC capacitors but no electronics.
3-speed fan
controller capacitors
Allocating radio frequencies for industry:
• Two way radio
• Fixed radio links
• Wireless broadband
• Studio – Transmitter links
• Broadcasting
ACMA accredited
Phone 08 9448 1995; Fax 08 9448 8140
Email: frequency<at>commsws.com.au
Replace outdated PLC, push-buttons,
small LCD combo with 1 single CuTOUCH™.
Many other Windows CE & XP PLCs,
core modules and accessories. Call for
info: sales<at>ozcomfile.com.au or 1300
208 570. www.ozcomfile.com.au
WANTED
CUSTOMERS WANTED: Truscotts
Electronic World – large range of semisiliconchip.com.au
I wish to know if it is possible to
purchase the capacitor module that
controls the speed of ceiling fans.
I have six fans that need attention,
mainly with the second speed setting.
I have checked the capacitance of
some units and found that the value
conductors and passive components for
industry, hobbyist and amateur projects
including Drew Diamond. 27 The Mall,
South Croydon, Melbourne. Phone (03)
9723 3860. sales<at>electronicworld.
com.au
WANTED: EARLY HIFIs, AMPLIFIERS,
Speakers, Turntables, Valves, Books,
Quad, Leak, Pye, Lowther, Ortofon,
SME, Western Electric, Altec, Marantz,
McIntosh, Tannoy, Goodmans, Wharf-
of the unit in some cases is half of
what it should be, eg, 2.5µF reads
1.2µF. I have checked the fan motor
capacitors and they are within 5% of
their rated value.
I visited a couple of electrical
stores here and they want to sell me
a complete controller for nearly the
price of a new fan. There is nothing wrong with the fans or control
switch, only the capacitor block is
faulty, so is it possible to just buy
the capacitor module? The values
required are 1.8µF and 2.5µF.
I know that there are other values
of capacitance for other fans. The
type of fan I have is a Wattmaster
3-speed ceiling fan. I have checked
on the web at Wattmaster but can’t
seem to find any information regarding capacitors. (B. H., Mackay, Qld).
• Depending on the size of the fan,
motor start capacitors could be used
for large fans or mains-rated polypropylene X2 capacitors can be used for
smaller fans. Ideally, use the same
type of capacitor that is already in
the fan speed controller.
Polypropylene X2 capacitors are
available from Farnell (www.farnell.
com.au) – Cat. 111-2847 for 1.5µF
and 111-2849 for 2.2µF. You can add
330nF across each to make up the
values to 1.8µF and 2.5µF. A 330nF
X2 capacitor is Cat. 111-2844.
For motor start capacitors, see Cat.
119-0561 for 1.5µF, 119-0562 for 2µF
SC
and 119-0563 and 3µF.
SC
edale, radio and wireless. Collector/
Hobbyist will pay cash. (07) 5471 1062.
johnmurt<at>highprofile.com.au
KIT ASSEMBLY
KEITH RIPPON KIT ASSEMBLY &
REPAIR:
* Australia & New Zealand;
* Small production runs.
Phone Keith 0409 662 794.
keith.rippon<at>gmail.com
Advertising rates for these pages: Classified ads: $29.50 (incl. GST) for up to
20 words plus 85 cents for each additional word. Display ads: $54.50 (incl. GST)
per column centimetre (max. 10cm). Closing date: 5 weeks prior to month of sale.
To book, email the text to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au and include your name,
address & credit card details, or fax (02) 9939 2648, or phone (02) 9939 3295.
September 2010 103
Do you eat,
breathe
and sleep
TECHNOLOGY?
Opportunities exist for
experienced Sales Professionals
& Store Management across
Australia & NZ
Jaycar Electronics is a rapidly growing, Australian owned, international
retailer with more than 60 stores in Australia and New Zealand. Due
to our aggressive expansion program we are seeking dedicated sales
professionals to join our retail team to assist us in achieving our goals. We
pride ourselves on technical expertise from our staff. Do you think that the
following statements describe you? Please put a tick in the boxes that do:
Knowledge of core electronics, particularly at a component level
Retail experience, highly regarded
Assemble projects or kits yourself for your car, computer, audio etc
Have energy, enthusiasm and a personality that enjoys helping people
Opportunities for future advancement and development
Why not do something you love and get paid for it?
Please email us your applicaton & CV in PDF format, including location
preference. We offer a competitive salary, sales incentive and have a
generous staff purchase policy. Applications should be emailed to
jobs <at> jaycar.com.au
Jaycar Electronics is an Equal Opportunity Employer
& actively promotes staff from within the organisation.
into
RF?
DOWNLOAD OUR CATALOG at
www.iinet.net.au/~worcom
There’s something to suit every
radio frequency fan in the
SILICON CHIP reference bookshop
RF Circuit Design
– by Chris Bowick
A new edition of this classic RF
design text - tells how to design
and integrate RF components into
virtually any circuitry.
$
75
Practical RF H’book
WORLDWIDE ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS
PO Box 631, Hillarys, WA 6923
Ph: (08) 9307 7305 Fax: (08) 9307 7309
Email: worcom<at>iinet.net.au
Silicon Chip
Circuit Ideas
Wanted
– by Ian Hickman
A reference work for technicians,
engineers, students and the more
specialised enthusiast. Covers all
the key topics in RF that you
$
need to understand
90
Do you have a good
circuit idea? If so,
sketch it out, write
a brief description
of its operation & send it to us.
Practical Guide To
Satellite TV
Provided your idea is workable
& original, we’ll publish it in
Circuit Notebook & you’ll make
some money. We pay up to $100
for a good circuit idea or you
could win some test gear.
– by Garry Cratt
The reference written by an Aussie
for Aussie conditions.Everything
you need to know.
$
49
You’ll find many more technical
titles in the SILICON CHIP
reference bookshop – see
elsewhere in this issue
104 Silicon Chip
Silicon Chip Publications,
PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097.
Advertising Index
Altronics..................................... 80-83
Amalgamated Instrument Co............ 8
Aust. Valve Audio Transformers..... 102
Av-Comm...................................... 102
Com. & Wireless Services............. 103
Dick Smith Electronics............... 20-21
Electrolube........................................ 9
Emona Instruments......................... 61
Front Panel Express.......................... 6
Fusion Electronics........................... 13
Grantronics................................... 102
Hare & Forbes..............................OBC
High Profile Communications........ 103
Instant PCBs................................. 102
Jaycar............................IFC,49-56,104
Keith Rippon................................. 103
Kinsten Pty Ltd.............................. 102
Kitstop........................................... 103
LED Sales..................................... 102
Microchip Technology...................... 33
Microzed......................................... 17
Oatley Electronics......................... IBC
Ocean Controls............................... 69
OzComfile..................................... 102
PCBCART......................................... 6
Quest Electronics.......................... 103
RCS Radio.................................... 102
RF Modules................................... 104
Rohde & Schwarz............................. 5
Roland DG Australia....................... 77
RSDC.............................................. 10
Screenscope..................................... 3
Sesame Electronics...................... 102
Silicon Chip Binders........................ 94
Silicon Chip Bookshop........... 100-101
Silicon Chip Order Form................. 99
Siomar Battery Engineering..... 11,102
Soundlabs Group.............................. 9
Speakerbits................................... 102
Speakerworks............................... 102
Splat Controls............................... 102
Tenrod............................................. 19
Terry’s Transistors......................... 102
Truscotts Electronic World............. 103
Wagner Electronics......................... 59
Wiltronics.......................................... 7
Worldwide Elect. Components...... 104
PC Boards
Printed circuit boards for SILICON CHIP
designs can be obtained from RCS
Radio Pty Ltd. Phone (02) 9738 0330.
Fax (02) 9738 0331.
siliconchip.com.au
OOP PUR
LEAD WITH FITTED PLUGS [LEDC] $2ea
LED STRIP [LEDST ] $10ea or 3 for $24
C
S E!
A RA
E
SC
HA
R
12V - 2.4W SUPER-BRIGHT LED STRIPS
WATERPROOF - FLEXIBLE - SELF ADHESIVE
NOTE: connectors would need sealant or glue to be made waterproof.
12V AC/DC 3 LED MR16 REPLACEMENT KIT
Replace those power
hungry lights with energy
efficient LED downlights.
Save money and do it
yourself, Just solder two
wires to the PCB inside
the lamp.
[K293] $15 or 5 for $60
BACK IN STOCK!
2nd WEEK SEPTEMBER - ELECTRIC
EX-MILITARY GAMMA RAY
BIKE KITS! - LARGE DC MOTORS
RADIOACTIVITY
DETECTORS
(GEARED & DIRECT DRIVE) - SPEED
CONTROLLERS - WHEELS THROTTLES - SPROCKETS AND
CHAINS - SEE OUR WEB SITE.
SOLAR BARGAINS
HIGH QUALITY SOLAR PANELS WITH
ALUMINUM FRAMES & TOUGHENED GLASS
34W (1X 34W solar panel) [SP34] $190.
102W (3X 34W solar array) [SP102] $550.
204W (6X 34W solar array) [SP102] $1000.
Ever wondered about the radiation around
your home or workplace?
These are new, never used, they have been in a military
warehouse since the 1960s. These units come with a bag
and carry strap. We have designed a kit that fits into the
original battery box and replaces the original batteries
that are no longer available. Unlike the Geiger muller
tube based detectors, the low voltage Ionization
Chambers (1.34V) used in them do not deteriorate with
age. [GRD1] includes kit $39
8W SOLAR ARRAY + K251A REGULATOR
12V - 8W output. [2XSP4W6] $55.00
MONOCRYSTALLINE UNFRAMED
6W SOLAR PANELS
These panels are fully
sealed but have no
aluminum frame. [SP6UF] $50
CHECK OUT OUR WEB SITE FOR MORE INFO
AND SOLAR BARGAINS.
LET THERE BE LIGHT!
BOX OF 10
MR16
DOWN LIGHT
lamps, 60Deg.
50W [MR1610]
$20
This package includes two 10W LED's (Clusters)
NEW K275 and K275A HIGH POWER
& a K286 switched mode inverter kit.
Operates from 5-15V DC.
Extra heat-sinking PWM DC MOTOR SPEED CONTROLLERS
required for LED's. These two kits can be used for controlling the speed of
[K286L] $29
TUBE BASED 5/10W POWER AMPLIFIER KIT
This kit uses a Raytheon
JAN6418 tube and a LM1875T IC to produce that
rich warm tube sound.
It will deliver 5W into an [K281] $29.00
8 Ohm load or 10W into
a 4 Ohm load.
Kit includes a
suitable power
supply (110-240V
AC to 24VDC <at>
1A) & all onboard
parts. A heatsink
is now supplied
in the kit.
DISLIKE THE POWER UP PLOP WITH K281?
NOW AVAILABLE K281R PLOP STOPPER KIT
This small kit will stop the plop when the K281 is
powered up. The kit comes with 2 relays and is suitable
for use with 2 K281 kits at the same time. [K281R] $4
12, 24, 36 & 48V Motors. A Hall Effect device based
Motorcycle style Throttle, or a simple potentiometer can
be used to control the speed. Both of the kits have
identical speed control circuitry, but K275 has
additional circuitry that enables the direction of the
motor to be reversed. Kit K275A
is a PWM speed controller
without the reversing circuitry.
The reversing
circuitry employs
small high current
30A relays.
K275 is a
complete
combination of PWM
speed controller and the
reversing circuitry that employs
2 sets of relay contacts that are connected in parallel.
This kit will not change direction until the motor has
stopped allowing switching only when there is no
current flowing as relays can carry more current than
they can switch.
allowing control of higher motor
currents.
K248 - INVERTER + 5 MR16 14V/1W LED LAMPS
This simple inverter kit will power 5 of these lamps
from a 12V lighting transformer or 12V battery. Req. 8V
- 15V, 3mA <at> 12V quiescent, 340mA with 5 lamps.
The kit includes PCB, all onboard parts inc, pre-wound
inductors. Great for use with the SPPK solar system.
See our web site for more information.
[K248] $49.00
8Kgs OF GERMAN
ENGINEERING
UNIVERSAL MOTOR
27VDC - 20A - 0.5kW 12500RPM.
$24
a lot of
[K275A] Draws
current almost
$39
[K275]
[VM500]
only$15
regardless of
voltage, around
20A from 12V
or 24V. These
220mm X 135mmdia.
motors were
part of a high
power vacuum pump and
still have the impeller attached.
HIGH POWER - 0.5W / 150mA / 10mm WHITE LED
25 Lumens <at> 150mA / 80,000 mcd <at> 20mA.
Vf min <at> 20mA = 3.0
Vf max <at> 20mA = 3.6
No additional heatsinking needed.
Water clear lens.
[L10W] $2.40
www.oatleyelectronics.com Suppliers
of kits and surplus electronics to hobbyists, experimenters, industry & professionals.
Orders: Ph ( 02 ) 9584 3563, Fax 9584 3561, sales<at>oatleyelectronics.com,SPO
Box 89 Oatley
NSW 2223
eptember
2010 105
major credit cards accepted, Post & Pack typically $7 Prices subject to change without notice ACN 068 740 081 ABN18068 740 081
OR www.oatleye.com
siliconchip.com.au
SC_SEP_09
|